merge from trunk
[bpt/emacs.git] / doc / misc / org.texi
1
2 \input texinfo
3 @c %**start of header
4 @setfilename ../../info/org
5 @settitle The Org Manual
6
7 @set VERSION 7.01
8 @set DATE July 2010
9
10 @c Use proper quote and backtick for code sections in PDF output
11 @c Cf. Texinfo manual 14.2
12 @set txicodequoteundirected
13 @set txicodequotebacktick
14
15 @c Version and Contact Info
16 @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
17 @set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
18 @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
19 @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
20 @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
21 @c %**end of header
22 @finalout
23
24 @c Macro definitions
25 @iftex
26 @c @hyphenation{time-stamp time-stamps time-stamp-ing time-stamp-ed}
27 @end iftex
28 @macro Ie {}
29 I.e.,
30 @end macro
31 @macro ie {}
32 i.e.,
33 @end macro
34 @macro Eg {}
35 E.g.,
36 @end macro
37 @macro eg {}
38 e.g.,
39 @end macro
40
41 @c Subheadings inside a table.
42 @macro tsubheading{text}
43 @ifinfo
44 @subsubheading \text\
45 @end ifinfo
46 @ifnotinfo
47 @item @b{\text\}
48 @end ifnotinfo
49 @end macro
50
51 @copying
52 This manual is for Org version @value{VERSION}.
53
54 Copyright @copyright{} 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation
55
56 @quotation
57 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
58 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
59 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
60 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
61 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
62 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
63
64 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
65 modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
66 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
67
68 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
69 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
70 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
71 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
72 @end quotation
73 @end copying
74
75 @dircategory Emacs
76 @direntry
77 * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
78 @end direntry
79
80 @titlepage
81 @title The Org Manual
82
83 @subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
84 @author by Carsten Dominik
85 with contributions by David O'Toole, Bastien Guerry, Philip Rooke, Dan Davison, Eric Schulte, and Thomas Dye
86
87 @c The following two commands start the copyright page.
88 @page
89 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
90 @insertcopying
91 @end titlepage
92
93 @c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
94 @contents
95
96 @ifnottex
97 @node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
98 @top Org Mode Manual
99
100 @insertcopying
101 @end ifnottex
102
103 @menu
104 * Introduction:: Getting started
105 * Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
106 * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
107 * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
108 * TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
109 * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
110 * Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
111 * Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
112 * Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects
113 * Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
114 * Markup:: Prepare text for rich export
115 * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
116 * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
117 * Working With Source Code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks
118 * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
119 * Hacking:: How to hack your way around
120 * MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device
121 * History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
122 * Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
123 * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
124 * Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual
125
126 @detailmenu
127 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
128
129 Introduction
130
131 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
132 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
133 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
134 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
135 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
136
137 Document structure
138
139 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
140 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
141 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
142 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
143 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
144 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
145 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
146 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
147 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
148 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
149 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
150
151 Tables
152
153 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
154 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
155 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
156 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
157 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
158 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
159
160 The spreadsheet
161
162 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
163 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
164 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
165 * Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
166 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
167 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
168 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
169 * Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
170
171 Hyperlinks
172
173 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
174 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
175 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
176 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
177 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
178 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
179 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
180 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
181
182 Internal links
183
184 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
185
186 TODO items
187
188 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
189 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
190 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
191 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
192 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
193 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
194
195 Extended use of TODO keywords
196
197 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
198 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
199 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
200 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
201 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
202 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
203 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
204
205 Progress logging
206
207 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
208 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
209 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
210
211 Tags
212
213 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
214 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
215 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
216
217 Properties and columns
218
219 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
220 * Special properties:: Access to other Org-mode features
221 * Property searches:: Matching property values
222 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
223 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
224 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
225
226 Column view
227
228 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
229 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
230 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
231
232 Defining columns
233
234 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
235 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
236
237 Dates and times
238
239 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
240 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
241 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
242 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
243 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time if you've been idle
244 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
245 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
246
247 Creating timestamps
248
249 * The date/time prompt:: How Org-mode helps you entering date and time
250 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
251
252 Deadlines and scheduling
253
254 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
255 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
256
257 Capture - Refile - Archive
258
259 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
260 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
261 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
262 * Protocols:: External (e.g. Browser) access to Emacs and Org
263 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
264 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
265
266 Capture
267
268 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
269 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
270 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
271
272 Capture templates
273
274 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
275 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
276
277 Archiving
278
279 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
280 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
281
282 Agenda views
283
284 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
285 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
286 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
287 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
288 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
289 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
290 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
291 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
292
293 The built-in agenda views
294
295 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
296 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
297 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
298 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
299 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
300 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
301
302 Presentation and sorting
303
304 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
305 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
306 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
307
308 Custom agenda views
309
310 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
311 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
312 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
313
314 Markup for rich export
315
316 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
317 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
318 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
319 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
320 * Index entries:: Making an index
321 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
322 * Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
323
324 Structural markup elements
325
326 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
327 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
328 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
329 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
330 * Lists:: Lists
331 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
332 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
333 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
334 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
335 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
336
337 Embedded La@TeX{}
338
339 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
340 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
341 * LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
342 * Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
343 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
344
345 Exporting
346
347 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
348 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
349 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
350 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
351 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
352 * LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to La@TeX{}, and processing to PDF
353 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
354 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
355 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
356 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
357 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
358
359 HTML export
360
361 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
362 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org-mode
363 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
364 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
365 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
366 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
367 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
368 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
369
370 La@TeX{} and PDF export
371
372 * LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
373 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
374 * Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal La@TeX{} code
375 * Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to La@TeX{}
376 * Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into La@TeX{} output
377 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
378
379 DocBook export
380
381 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
382 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
383 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
384 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
385 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
386 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
387
388 Publishing
389
390 * Configuration:: Defining projects
391 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
392 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
393 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
394
395 Configuration
396
397 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
398 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
399 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
400 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
401 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
402 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
403 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
404 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
405
406 Sample configuration
407
408 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
409 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
410
411 Working with source code
412
413 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
414 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
415 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
416 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
417 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org-mode buffer
418 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
419 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
420 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
421 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
422 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org-mode
423 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
424 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
425
426 Header arguments
427
428 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
429 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
430
431 Using header arguments
432
433 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
434 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
435 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
436 * Header arguments in Org-mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
437 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
438
439 Specific header arguments
440
441 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
442 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will be collected and handled
443 * file:: Specify a path for file output
444 * dir:: Specify the default directory for code block execution
445 * exports:: Export code and/or results
446 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
447 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb expansion during tangling
448 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
449 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
450 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
451 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
452 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
453 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
454 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
455
456 Miscellaneous
457
458 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
459 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
460 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
461 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
462 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
463 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
464 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
465 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
466 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
467
468 Interaction with other packages
469
470 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
471 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
472
473 Hacking
474
475 * Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
476 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
477 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
478 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
479 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for La@TeX{} and other programs
480 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
481 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
482 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
483 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
484 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
485
486 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
487
488 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
489 * A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
490 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
491 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
492
493 MobileOrg
494
495 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
496 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
497 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
498
499 @end detailmenu
500 @end menu
501
502 @node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
503 @chapter Introduction
504 @cindex introduction
505
506 @menu
507 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
508 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
509 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
510 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
511 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
512 @end menu
513
514 @node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
515 @section Summary
516 @cindex summary
517
518 Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
519 project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
520
521 Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
522 lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
523 implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
524 content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
525 structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
526 with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
527 timestamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
528 agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
529 and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
530 Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
531 For printing and sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a
532 structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
533 iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
534 linked web pages.
535
536 As a project planning environment, Org works by adding metadata to outline
537 nodes. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted in queries and
538 create dynamic @i{agenda views}.
539
540 Org mode contains the Org Babel environment which allows to work with
541 embedded source code block in a file, to facilitate code evaluation,
542 documentation, and tangling.
543
544 Org's automatic, context-sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
545 capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
546 minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
547 tables in arbitrary file types, for example in La@TeX{}. The structure
548 editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
549 the minor Orgstruct mode.
550
551 Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
552 feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
553 imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
554 it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways and for different
555 ends, for example:
556
557 @example
558 @r{@bullet{} an outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
559 @r{@bullet{} an ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
560 @r{@bullet{} a TODO list editor}
561 @r{@bullet{} a full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
562 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
563 @r{@bullet{} an environment in which to implement David Allen's GTD system}
564 @r{@bullet{} a simple hypertext system, with HTML and La@TeX{} export}
565 @r{@bullet{} a publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages}
566 @r{@bullet{} an environment for literate programming}
567 @end example
568
569
570 @cindex FAQ
571 There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
572 version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
573 questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc@. This page is located at
574 @uref{http://orgmode.org}.
575
576 @page
577
578
579 @node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
580 @section Installation
581 @cindex installation
582 @cindex XEmacs
583
584 @b{Important:} @i{If you are using a version of Org that is part of the Emacs
585 distribution or an XEmacs package, please skip this section and go directly
586 to @ref{Activation}.}
587
588 If you have downloaded Org from the Web, either as a distribution @file{.zip}
589 or @file{.tar} file, or as a Git archive, you must take the following steps
590 to install it: go into the unpacked Org distribution directory and edit the
591 top section of the file @file{Makefile}. You must set the name of the Emacs
592 binary (likely either @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths to the
593 directories where local Lisp and Info files are kept. If you don't have
594 access to the system-wide directories, you can simply run Org directly from
595 the distribution directory by adding the @file{lisp} subdirectory to the
596 Emacs load path. To do this, add the following line to @file{.emacs}:
597
598 @example
599 (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp" load-path))
600 @end example
601
602 @noindent
603 If you plan to use code from the @file{contrib} subdirectory, do a similar
604 step for this directory:
605
606 @example
607 (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" load-path))
608 @end example
609
610 @sp 2
611 @cartouche
612 XEmacs users now need to install the file @file{noutline.el} from
613 the @file{xemacs} sub-directory of the Org distribution. Use the
614 command:
615
616 @example
617 make install-noutline
618 @end example
619 @end cartouche
620 @sp 2
621
622 @noindent Now byte-compile the Lisp files with the shell command:
623
624 @example
625 make
626 @end example
627
628 @noindent If you are running Org from the distribution directory, this is
629 all. If you want to install Org into the system directories, use (as
630 administrator)
631
632 @example
633 make install
634 @end example
635
636 Installing Info files is system dependent, because of differences in the
637 @file{install-info} program. In Debian it copies the info files into the
638 correct directory and modifies the info directory file. In many other
639 systems, the files need to be copied to the correct directory separately, and
640 @file{install-info} then only modifies the directory file. Check your system
641 documentation to find out which of the following commands you need:
642
643 @example
644 make install-info
645 make install-info-debian
646 @end example
647
648 Then add the following line to @file{.emacs}. It is needed so that
649 Emacs can autoload functions that are located in files not immediately loaded
650 when Org-mode starts.
651 @lisp
652 (require 'org-install)
653 @end lisp
654
655 Do not forget to activate Org as described in the following section.
656 @page
657
658 @node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
659 @section Activation
660 @cindex activation
661 @cindex autoload
662 @cindex global key bindings
663 @cindex key bindings, global
664
665 Add the following lines to your @file{.emacs} file. The last three lines
666 define @emph{global} keys for the commands @command{org-store-link},
667 @command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb}---please choose suitable
668 keys yourself.
669
670 @lisp
671 ;; The following lines are always needed. Choose your own keys.
672 (add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
673 (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
674 (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
675 (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
676 @end lisp
677
678 Furthermore, you must activate @code{font-lock-mode} in Org
679 buffers, because significant functionality depends on font-locking being
680 active. You can do this with either one of the following two lines
681 (XEmacs users must use the second option):
682 @lisp
683 (global-font-lock-mode 1) ; for all buffers
684 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock) ; Org buffers only
685 @end lisp
686
687 @cindex Org-mode, turning on
688 With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
689 into Org-mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
690 like this:
691
692 @example
693 MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
694 @end example
695
696 @vindex org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file
697 @noindent which will select Org-mode for this buffer no matter what
698 the file's name is. See also the variable
699 @code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
700
701 Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is @i{active}. To make
702 use of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode}
703 (@code{zmacs-regions} in XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default,
704 in Emacs 22 you need to do this yourself with
705 @lisp
706 (transient-mark-mode 1)
707 @end lisp
708 @noindent If you do not like @code{transient-mark-mode}, you can create an
709 active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing
710 @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} twice before moving the cursor.
711
712 @node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
713 @section Feedback
714 @cindex feedback
715 @cindex bug reports
716 @cindex maintainer
717 @cindex author
718
719 If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
720 about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
721 If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the
722 list after a moderator has approved it.
723
724 For bug reports, please provide as much information as possible, including
725 the version information of Emacs (@kbd{M-x emacs-version @key{RET}}) and Org
726 (@kbd{M-x org-version @key{RET}}), as well as the Org related setup in
727 @file{.emacs}. The easiest way to do this is to use the command
728 @example
729 @kbd{M-x org-submit-bug-report}
730 @end example
731 @noindent which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so
732 that you only need to add your description. If you re not sending the Email
733 from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program.
734
735 If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to
736 create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear information
737 about:
738
739 @enumerate
740 @item What exactly did you do?
741 @item What did you expect to happen?
742 @item What happened instead?
743 @end enumerate
744 @noindent Thank you for helping to improve this mode.
745
746 @subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
747
748 @cindex backtrace of an error
749 If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
750 understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
751 providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{backtrace}.
752 This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
753 error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
754
755 @enumerate
756 @item
757 Reload uncompiled versions of all Org-mode Lisp files. The backtrace
758 contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code.
759 To do this, use
760 @example
761 C-u M-x org-reload RET
762 @end example
763 @noindent
764 or select @code{Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled} from the
765 menu.
766 @item
767 Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
768 (XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
769 @item
770 Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
771 document the steps you take.
772 @item
773 When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
774 screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
775 attach it to your bug report.
776 @end enumerate
777
778 @node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
779 @section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
780
781 Org uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags, and property
782 names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
783
784 @table @code
785 @item TODO
786 @itemx WAITING
787 TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
788 user-defined.
789 @item boss
790 @itemx ARCHIVE
791 User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
792 meaning are written with all capitals.
793 @item Release
794 @itemx PRIORITY
795 User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
796 special meaning are written with all capitals.
797 @end table
798
799 @node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
800 @chapter Document structure
801 @cindex document structure
802 @cindex structure of document
803
804 Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to
805 edit the structure of the document.
806
807 @menu
808 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
809 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
810 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
811 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
812 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
813 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
814 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
815 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
816 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
817 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
818 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
819 @end menu
820
821 @node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
822 @section Outlines
823 @cindex outlines
824 @cindex Outline mode
825
826 Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
827 document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
828 for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
829 of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
830 document to show only the general document structure and the parts
831 currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
832 outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
833 command, @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
834
835 @node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
836 @section Headlines
837 @cindex headlines
838 @cindex outline tree
839 @vindex org-special-ctrl-a/e
840 @vindex org-special-ctrl-k
841 @vindex org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree
842
843 Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in Org
844 start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See the variables
845 @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e}, @code{org-special-ctrl-k}, and
846 @code{org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree} to configure special behavior of @kbd{C-a},
847 @kbd{C-e}, and @kbd{C-k} in headlines.}. For example:
848
849 @example
850 * Top level headline
851 ** Second level
852 *** 3rd level
853 some text
854 *** 3rd level
855 more text
856
857 * Another top level headline
858 @end example
859
860 @noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
861 outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
862 starters. @ref{Clean view}, describes a setup to realize this.
863
864 @vindex org-cycle-separator-lines
865 An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
866 will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
867 least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
868 the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
869 variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
870
871 @node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
872 @section Visibility cycling
873 @cindex cycling, visibility
874 @cindex visibility cycling
875 @cindex trees, visibility
876 @cindex show hidden text
877 @cindex hide text
878
879 Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
880 Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
881 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
882
883 @cindex subtree visibility states
884 @cindex subtree cycling
885 @cindex folded, subtree visibility state
886 @cindex children, subtree visibility state
887 @cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
888 @table @kbd
889 @kindex @key{TAB}
890 @item @key{TAB}
891 @emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
892
893 @example
894 ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
895 '-----------------------------------'
896 @end example
897
898 @vindex org-cycle-emulate-tab
899 @vindex org-cycle-global-at-bob
900 The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
901 the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
902 beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
903 @key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
904 option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
905 argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
906
907 @cindex global visibility states
908 @cindex global cycling
909 @cindex overview, global visibility state
910 @cindex contents, global visibility state
911 @cindex show all, global visibility state
912 @kindex S-@key{TAB}
913 @item S-@key{TAB}
914 @itemx C-u @key{TAB}
915 @emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
916
917 @example
918 ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
919 '--------------------------------------'
920 @end example
921
922 When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
923 CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
924 tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
925
926 @cindex show all, command
927 @kindex C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB}
928 @item C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB}
929 Show all, including drawers.
930 @kindex C-c C-r
931 @item C-c C-r
932 Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
933 and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
934 exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
935 (@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
936 level, all sibling headings. With double prefix arg, also show the entire
937 subtree of the parent.
938 @kindex C-c C-k
939 @item C-c C-k
940 Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENT view for just one subtree.
941 @kindex C-c C-x b
942 @item C-c C-x b
943 Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
944 buffer
945 @ifinfo
946 (@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
947 @end ifinfo
948 @ifnotinfo
949 (see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
950 @end ifnotinfo
951 will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
952 tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
953 but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
954 prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
955 negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
956 the previously used indirect buffer.
957 @end table
958
959 @vindex org-startup-folded
960 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
961 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
962 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
963 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
964
965 When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
966 OVERVIEW, i.e. only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
967 configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a
968 per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
969 buffer:
970
971 @example
972 #+STARTUP: overview
973 #+STARTUP: content
974 #+STARTUP: showall
975 #+STARTUP: showeverything
976 @end example
977
978 @cindex property, VISIBILITY
979 @noindent
980 Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
981 and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
982 for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
983 @code{all}.
984 @table @kbd
985 @kindex C-u C-u @key{TAB}
986 @item C-u C-u @key{TAB}
987 Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e. whatever is
988 requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
989 entries.
990 @end table
991
992 @node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
993 @section Motion
994 @cindex motion, between headlines
995 @cindex jumping, to headlines
996 @cindex headline navigation
997 The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
998
999 @table @kbd
1000 @kindex C-c C-n
1001 @item C-c C-n
1002 Next heading.
1003 @kindex C-c C-p
1004 @item C-c C-p
1005 Previous heading.
1006 @kindex C-c C-f
1007 @item C-c C-f
1008 Next heading same level.
1009 @kindex C-c C-b
1010 @item C-c C-b
1011 Previous heading same level.
1012 @kindex C-c C-u
1013 @item C-c C-u
1014 Backward to higher level heading.
1015 @kindex C-c C-j
1016 @item C-c C-j
1017 Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
1018 visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
1019 you can use the following keys to find your destination:
1020 @vindex org-goto-auto-isearch
1021 @example
1022 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
1023 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1024 @key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
1025 @kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
1026 @r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
1027 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1028 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
1029 u @r{One level up.}
1030 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
1031 q @r{Quit}
1032 @end example
1033 @vindex org-goto-interface
1034 @noindent
1035 See also the variable @code{org-goto-interface}.
1036 @end table
1037
1038 @node Structure editing, Sparse trees, Motion, Document Structure
1039 @section Structure editing
1040 @cindex structure editing
1041 @cindex headline, promotion and demotion
1042 @cindex promotion, of subtrees
1043 @cindex demotion, of subtrees
1044 @cindex subtree, cut and paste
1045 @cindex pasting, of subtrees
1046 @cindex cutting, of subtrees
1047 @cindex copying, of subtrees
1048 @cindex sorting, of subtrees
1049 @cindex subtrees, cut and paste
1050
1051 @table @kbd
1052 @kindex M-@key{RET}
1053 @item M-@key{RET}
1054 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1055 Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a
1056 plain list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force
1057 creation of a new headline, use a prefix argument, or first press @key{RET}
1058 to get to the beginning of the next line. When this command is used in
1059 the middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes
1060 the new headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split,
1061 customize the variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If the
1062 command is used at the beginning of a headline, the new headline is
1063 created before the current line. If at the beginning of any other line,
1064 the content of that line is made the new heading. If the command is
1065 used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e. behind the ellipses at the end
1066 of a headline), then a headline like the current one will be inserted
1067 after the end of the subtree.
1068 @kindex C-@key{RET}
1069 @item C-@key{RET}
1070 Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
1071 current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
1072 it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
1073 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1074 @item M-S-@key{RET}
1075 @vindex org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change
1076 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the
1077 variable @code{org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change}.
1078 @kindex C-S-@key{RET}
1079 @item C-S-@key{RET}
1080 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
1081 @kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
1082 subtree.
1083 @kindex @key{TAB}
1084 @item @key{TAB} @r{in new, empty entry}
1085 In a new entry with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the entry to
1086 become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1087 and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you are back
1088 to the initial level.
1089 @kindex M-@key{left}
1090 @item M-@key{left}
1091 Promote current heading by one level.
1092 @kindex M-@key{right}
1093 @item M-@key{right}
1094 Demote current heading by one level.
1095 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1096 @item M-S-@key{left}
1097 Promote the current subtree by one level.
1098 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1099 @item M-S-@key{right}
1100 Demote the current subtree by one level.
1101 @kindex M-S-@key{up}
1102 @item M-S-@key{up}
1103 Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
1104 level).
1105 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
1106 @item M-S-@key{down}
1107 Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
1108 @kindex C-c C-x C-w
1109 @item C-c C-x C-w
1110 Kill subtree, i.e. remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
1111 With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
1112 @kindex C-c C-x M-w
1113 @item C-c C-x M-w
1114 Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
1115 sequential subtrees.
1116 @kindex C-c C-x C-y
1117 @item C-c C-x C-y
1118 Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
1119 make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
1120 also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
1121 headline marker like @samp{****}.
1122 @kindex C-y
1123 @item C-y
1124 @vindex org-yank-adjusted-subtrees
1125 @vindex org-yank-folded-subtrees
1126 Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
1127 @code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
1128 paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
1129 C-x C-y}. With the default settings, no level adjustment will take place,
1130 but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing so would swallow text
1131 previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal
1132 @code{yank} to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to
1133 force a normal yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a
1134 yank, it will yank previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and
1135 folding.
1136 @kindex C-c C-x c
1137 @item C-c C-x c
1138 Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You will be
1139 prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any
1140 timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example,
1141 to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For
1142 more details, see the docstring of the command
1143 @code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}.
1144 @kindex C-c C-w
1145 @item C-c C-w
1146 Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refiling notes}.
1147 @kindex C-c ^
1148 @item C-c ^
1149 Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
1150 region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
1151 sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
1152 alphabetically, numerically, by time (first timestamp with active preferred,
1153 creation time, scheduled time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword
1154 (in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the value
1155 of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply
1156 your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
1157 sorting will be case-sensitive. With two @kbd{C-u C-u} prefixes, duplicate
1158 entries will also be removed.
1159 @kindex C-x n s
1160 @item C-x n s
1161 Narrow buffer to current subtree.
1162 @kindex C-x n w
1163 @item C-x n w
1164 Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
1165 @kindex C-c *
1166 @item C-c *
1167 Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
1168 subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by
1169 removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the
1170 region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn
1171 only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a
1172 headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
1173 @end table
1174
1175 @cindex region, active
1176 @cindex active region
1177 @cindex transient mark mode
1178 When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and
1179 demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
1180 headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
1181 line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
1182 just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
1183 inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
1184 functionality.
1185
1186
1187 @node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Structure editing, Document Structure
1188 @section Sparse trees
1189 @cindex sparse trees
1190 @cindex trees, sparse
1191 @cindex folding, sparse trees
1192 @cindex occur, command
1193
1194 @vindex org-show-hierarchy-above
1195 @vindex org-show-following-heading
1196 @vindex org-show-siblings
1197 @vindex org-show-entry-below
1198 An important feature of Org-mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
1199 trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
1200 document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
1201 visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
1202 variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
1203 @code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
1204 control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
1205 and you will see immediately how it works.
1206
1207 Org-mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
1208 commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
1209
1210 @table @kbd
1211 @kindex C-c /
1212 @item C-c /
1213 This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
1214 @kindex C-c / r
1215 @item C-c / r
1216 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
1217 Occur. Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
1218 the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
1219 the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
1220 provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
1221 is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
1222 highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
1223 editing command@footnote{This depends on the option
1224 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
1225 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
1226 so several calls to this command can be stacked.
1227 @end table
1228
1229 @noindent
1230 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
1231 For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
1232 use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
1233 keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
1234 accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
1235 For example:
1236
1237 @lisp
1238 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
1239 '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
1240 @end lisp
1241
1242 @noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
1243 a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
1244
1245 The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
1246 tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
1247
1248 @kindex C-c C-e v
1249 @cindex printing sparse trees
1250 @cindex visible text, printing
1251 To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
1252 @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
1253 of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
1254 XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
1255 Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible
1256 part of the document and print the resulting file.
1257
1258 @node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
1259 @section Plain lists
1260 @cindex plain lists
1261 @cindex lists, plain
1262 @cindex lists, ordered
1263 @cindex ordered lists
1264
1265 Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
1266 additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of
1267 checkboxes (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists,
1268 and the HTML exporter (@pxref{Exporting}) parses and formats them.
1269
1270 Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
1271 @itemize @bullet
1272 @item
1273 @emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
1274 @samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
1275 they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
1276 stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star are
1277 visually indistinguishable from true headlines. In short: even though
1278 @samp{*} is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.}
1279 as bullets.
1280 @item
1281 @emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
1282 a right parenthesis, such as @samp{1.} or @samp{1)}. If you want a list to
1283 start a different value (e.g. 20), start the text of the item with
1284 @code{[@@start:20]}.
1285 @item
1286 @emph{Description} list items are unordered list items, and contain the
1287 separator @samp{ :: } to separate the description @emph{term} from the
1288 description.
1289 @end itemize
1290
1291 @vindex org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists
1292 Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
1293 line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
1294 2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
1295 list. Indentation also determines the end of a list item. It ends before
1296 the next line that is indented like the bullet/number, or less. Empty lines
1297 are part of the previous item, so you can have several paragraphs in one
1298 item. If you would like an empty line to terminate all currently open plain
1299 lists, configure the variable @code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.
1300 Here is an example:
1301
1302 @example
1303 @group
1304 ** Lord of the Rings
1305 My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1306 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
1307 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
1308 + this was already my favorite scene in the book
1309 + I really like Miranda Otto.
1310 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
1311 - on DVD only
1312 He makes a really funny face when it happens.
1313 But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
1314 Important actors in this film are:
1315 - @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays Frodo
1316 - @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
1317 him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in @i{The Goonies}.
1318 @end group
1319 @end example
1320
1321 Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with
1322 them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling settings for Emacs. For
1323 XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones' @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on,
1324 put into @file{.emacs}: @code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them
1325 properly (@pxref{Exporting}). Since indentation is what governs the
1326 structure of these lists, many structural constructs like @code{#+BEGIN_...}
1327 blocks can be indented to signal that they should be part of a list item.
1328
1329 @vindex org-list-demote-modify-bullet
1330 If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list (than that used for
1331 the current list-level) improves readability, customize the variable
1332 @code{org-list-demote-modify-bullet}.
1333
1334 The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line
1335 of an item (the line with the bullet or number).
1336
1337 @table @kbd
1338 @kindex @key{TAB}
1339 @item @key{TAB}
1340 @vindex org-cycle-include-plain-lists
1341 Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if
1342 the cursor is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable
1343 @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. to @code{integrate}, plain list items
1344 will be treated like low-level. The level of an item is then given by the
1345 indentation of the bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real
1346 headlines, however; the hierarchies remain completely separated.
1347
1348 If @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists} has not been set, @key{TAB}
1349 fixes the indentation of the current line in a heuristic way.
1350 @kindex M-@key{RET}
1351 @item M-@key{RET}
1352 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1353 Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
1354 heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
1355 of a line, the line is @emph{split} and the rest of the line becomes the new
1356 item@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split, customize the variable
1357 @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed in the
1358 @emph{whitespace before a bullet or number}, the new item is created
1359 @emph{before} the current item. If the command is executed in the white
1360 space before the text that is part of an item but does not contain the
1361 bullet, a bullet is added to the current line.
1362 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1363 @item M-S-@key{RET}
1364 Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
1365 @kindex @key{TAB}
1366 @item @key{TAB} @r{in new, empty item}
1367 In a new item with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the item to
1368 become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1369 and so on, all the way to the left margin. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you
1370 are back to the initial level.
1371 @kindex S-@key{up}
1372 @kindex S-@key{down}
1373 @item S-@key{up}
1374 @itemx S-@key{down}
1375 @cindex shift-selection-mode
1376 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1377 Jump to the previous/next item in the current list, but only if
1378 @code{org-support-shift-select} is off. If not, you can still use paragraph
1379 jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{up}} and @kbd{C-@key{down}} to quite
1380 similar effect.
1381 @kindex M-S-@key{up}
1382 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
1383 @item M-S-@key{up}
1384 @itemx M-S-@key{down}
1385 Move the item including subitems up/down (swap with previous/next item
1386 of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering is
1387 automatic.
1388 @kindex M-@key{left}
1389 @kindex M-@key{right}
1390 @item M-@key{left}
1391 @itemx M-@key{right}
1392 Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children alone.
1393 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1394 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1395 @item M-S-@key{left}
1396 @itemx M-S-@key{right}
1397 Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
1398 Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation.
1399 When these commands are executed several times in direct succession,
1400 the initially selected region is used, even if the new indentation
1401 would imply a different hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break
1402 the command chain with a cursor motion or so.
1403 @kindex C-c C-c
1404 @item C-c C-c
1405 If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
1406 state of the checkbox. If not, this command makes sure that all the
1407 items on this list level use the same bullet. Furthermore, if this is
1408 an ordered list, make sure the numbering is OK.
1409 @kindex C-c -
1410 @item C-c -
1411 Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
1412 (@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}). With a numeric prefix
1413 argument N, select the Nth bullet from this list. If there is an active
1414 region when calling this, all lines will be converted to list items. If the
1415 first line already was a list item, any item markers will be removed from the
1416 list. Finally, even without an active region, a normal line will be
1417 converted into a list item.
1418 @kindex C-c *
1419 @item C-c *
1420 Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at
1421 its location). @xref{Structure editing}, for a detailed explanation.
1422 @kindex S-@key{left}
1423 @kindex S-@key{right}
1424 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
1425 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1426 This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or
1427 anywhere in an item line, details depending on
1428 @code{org-support-shift-select}.
1429 @kindex C-c ^
1430 @item C-c ^
1431 Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method:
1432 numerically, alphabetically, by time, or by custom function.
1433 @end table
1434
1435 @node Drawers, Blocks, Plain lists, Document Structure
1436 @section Drawers
1437 @cindex drawers
1438 @cindex #+DRAWERS
1439 @cindex visibility cycling, drawers
1440
1441 @vindex org-drawers
1442 Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
1443 normally don't want to see it. For this, Org-mode has @emph{drawers}.
1444 Drawers need to be configured with the variable
1445 @code{org-drawers}@footnote{You can define drawers on a per-file basis
1446 with a line like @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN PROPERTIES STATE}}. Drawers
1447 look like this:
1448
1449 @example
1450 ** This is a headline
1451 Still outside the drawer
1452 :DRAWERNAME:
1453 This is inside the drawer.
1454 :END:
1455 After the drawer.
1456 @end example
1457
1458 Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will hide and
1459 show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to
1460 look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the drawer line and
1461 press @key{TAB} there. Org-mode uses the @code{PROPERTIES} drawer for
1462 storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and you can also arrange
1463 for state change notes (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}) and clock times
1464 (@pxref{Clocking work time}) to be stored in a drawer @code{LOGBOOK}. If you
1465 want to store a quick note in the LOGBOOK drawer, in a similar way as this is
1466 done by state changes, use
1467
1468 @table @kbd
1469 @kindex C-c C-z
1470 @item C-c C-z
1471 Add a time-stamped note to the LOGBOOK drawer.
1472 @end table
1473
1474 @node Blocks, Footnotes, Drawers, Document Structure
1475 @section Blocks
1476
1477 @vindex org-hide-block-startup
1478 @cindex blocks, folding
1479 Org-mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including source
1480 code examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) to capturing time logging
1481 information (@pxref{Clocking work time}). These blocks can be folded and
1482 unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also get all blocks
1483 folded at startup by configuring the variable @code{org-hide-block-startup}
1484 or on a per-file basis by using
1485
1486 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1487 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1488 @example
1489 #+STARTUP: hideblocks
1490 #+STARTUP: nohideblocks
1491 @end example
1492
1493 @node Footnotes, Orgstruct mode, Blocks, Document Structure
1494 @section Footnotes
1495 @cindex footnotes
1496
1497 Org-mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
1498 @file{footnote.el} package, Org-mode's footnotes are designed for work on a
1499 larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails. The basic
1500 syntax is similar to the one used by @file{footnote.el}, i.e. a footnote is
1501 defined in a paragraph that is started by a footnote marker in square
1502 brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. If you need a paragraph break
1503 inside a footnote, use the La@TeX{} idiom @samp{\par}. The footnote reference
1504 is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. For example:
1505
1506 @example
1507 The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
1508 ...
1509 [fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
1510 @end example
1511
1512 Org-mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
1513 optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
1514 @file{footnote.el} does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
1515 encouraged because of possible conflicts with La@TeX{} snippets (@pxref{Embedded
1516 LaTeX}). Here are the valid references:
1517
1518 @table @code
1519 @item [1]
1520 A plain numeric footnote marker. Compatible with @file{footnote.el}, but not
1521 recommended because something like @samp{[1]} could easily be part of a code
1522 snippet.
1523 @item [fn:name]
1524 A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
1525 simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
1526 @item [fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]
1527 A La@TeX{}-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
1528 reference point.
1529 @item [fn:name: a definition]
1530 An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
1531 Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use
1532 @code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
1533 @end table
1534
1535 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
1536 Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself.
1537 This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
1538 corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords, see the docstring of that variable
1539 for details.
1540
1541 @noindent The following command handles footnotes:
1542
1543 @table @kbd
1544 @kindex C-c C-x f
1545 @item C-c C-x f
1546 The footnote action command.
1547
1548 When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
1549 is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
1550
1551 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
1552 @vindex org-footnote-section
1553 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
1554 Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
1555 @code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
1556 setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
1557 definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
1558 separately into the location determined by the variable
1559 @code{org-footnote-section}.
1560
1561 When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
1562 options is offered:
1563 @example
1564 s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
1565 @r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
1566 @r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
1567 @r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}. Automatic}
1568 @r{sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the}
1569 @r{variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1570 r @r{Renumber the simple @code{fn:N} footnotes. Automatic renumbering}
1571 @r{after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the variable}
1572 @r{@code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1573 S @r{Short for first @code{r}, then @code{s} action.}
1574 n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
1575 @r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
1576 @r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is}
1577 @r{meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g. sending}
1578 @r{off an email). The exporters do this automatically, and so could}
1579 @r{something like @code{message-send-hook}.}
1580 d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
1581 @r{to it.}
1582 @end example
1583 Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}@footnote{the
1584 corresponding in-buffer options are @code{fnadjust} and @code{nofnadjust}.},
1585 renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or
1586 deletion.
1587
1588 @kindex C-c C-c
1589 @item C-c C-c
1590 If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
1591 the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
1592 location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
1593 @kindex C-c C-o
1594 @kindex mouse-1
1595 @kindex mouse-2
1596 @item C-c C-o @r{or} mouse-1/2
1597 Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
1598 you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
1599 @end table
1600
1601 @node Orgstruct mode, , Footnotes, Document Structure
1602 @section The Orgstruct minor mode
1603 @cindex Orgstruct mode
1604 @cindex minor mode for structure editing
1605
1606 If you like the intuitive way the Org-mode structure editing and list
1607 formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes like
1608 Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode @code{orgstruct-mode} makes
1609 this possible. Toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x orgstruct-mode}, or
1610 turn it on by default, for example in Mail mode, with one of:
1611
1612 @lisp
1613 (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
1614 (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++)
1615 @end lisp
1616
1617 When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to Org like a
1618 headline or the first line of a list item, most structure editing commands
1619 will work, even if the same keys normally have different functionality in the
1620 major mode you are using. If the cursor is not in one of those special
1621 lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in the shadow. When you use
1622 @code{orgstruct++-mode}, Org will also export indentation and autofill
1623 settings into that mode, and detect item context after the first line of an
1624 item.
1625
1626 @node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
1627 @chapter Tables
1628 @cindex tables
1629 @cindex editing tables
1630
1631 Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
1632 calculations are supported in connection with the Emacs @file{calc}
1633 package
1634 @ifinfo
1635 (@pxref{Top,Calc,,Calc,Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
1636 @end ifinfo
1637 @ifnotinfo
1638 (see the Emacs Calculator manual for more information about the Emacs
1639 calculator).
1640 @end ifnotinfo
1641
1642 @menu
1643 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
1644 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
1645 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
1646 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
1647 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
1648 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
1649 @end menu
1650
1651 @node Built-in table editor, Column width and alignment, Tables, Tables
1652 @section The built-in table editor
1653 @cindex table editor, built-in
1654
1655 Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII. Any line with
1656 @samp{|} as the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a
1657 table. @samp{|} is also the column separator. A table might look like
1658 this:
1659
1660 @example
1661 | Name | Phone | Age |
1662 |-------+-------+-----|
1663 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
1664 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
1665 @end example
1666
1667 A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
1668 @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
1669 the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
1670 at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
1671 of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
1672 @samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
1673 expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
1674 create the above table, you would only type
1675
1676 @example
1677 |Name|Phone|Age|
1678 |-
1679 @end example
1680
1681 @noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
1682 fields. Even faster would be to type @code{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by
1683 @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.
1684
1685 @vindex org-enable-table-editor
1686 @vindex org-table-auto-blank-field
1687 When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
1688 @key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
1689 inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
1690 typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
1691 with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
1692 field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
1693 unpredictable for you, configure the variables
1694 @code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
1695
1696 @table @kbd
1697 @tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
1698 @kindex C-c |
1699 @item C-c |
1700 Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
1701 TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
1702 If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
1703 If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
1704 argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
1705 C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
1706 consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
1707 @*
1708 If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
1709 table. But it's easier just to start typing, like
1710 @kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
1711
1712 @tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
1713 @kindex C-c C-c
1714 @item C-c C-c
1715 Re-align the table without moving the cursor.
1716 @c
1717 @kindex @key{TAB}
1718 @item @key{TAB}
1719 Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
1720 necessary.
1721 @c
1722 @kindex S-@key{TAB}
1723 @item S-@key{TAB}
1724 Re-align, move to previous field.
1725 @c
1726 @kindex @key{RET}
1727 @item @key{RET}
1728 Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
1729 necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
1730 NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
1731 @c
1732 @kindex M-a
1733 @item M-a
1734 Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field.
1735 @kindex M-e
1736 @item M-e
1737 Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
1738
1739 @tsubheading{Column and row editing}
1740 @kindex M-@key{left}
1741 @kindex M-@key{right}
1742 @item M-@key{left}
1743 @itemx M-@key{right}
1744 Move the current column left/right.
1745 @c
1746 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1747 @item M-S-@key{left}
1748 Kill the current column.
1749 @c
1750 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1751 @item M-S-@key{right}
1752 Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
1753 @c
1754 @kindex M-@key{up}
1755 @kindex M-@key{down}
1756 @item M-@key{up}
1757 @itemx M-@key{down}
1758 Move the current row up/down.
1759 @c
1760 @kindex M-S-@key{up}
1761 @item M-S-@key{up}
1762 Kill the current row or horizontal line.
1763 @c
1764 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
1765 @item M-S-@key{down}
1766 Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
1767 created below the current one.
1768 @c
1769 @kindex C-c -
1770 @item C-c -
1771 Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
1772 is created above the current line.
1773 @c
1774 @kindex C-c @key{RET}
1775 @item C-c @key{RET}
1776 Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row
1777 below that line.
1778 @c
1779 @kindex C-c ^
1780 @item C-c ^
1781 Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
1782 column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
1783 between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
1784 point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
1785 column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
1786 and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
1787 included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
1788 (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
1789 argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
1790
1791 @tsubheading{Regions}
1792 @kindex C-c C-x M-w
1793 @item C-c C-x M-w
1794 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and
1795 mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region,
1796 copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines.
1797 @c
1798 @kindex C-c C-x C-w
1799 @item C-c C-x C-w
1800 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
1801 blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
1802 @c
1803 @kindex C-c C-x C-y
1804 @item C-c C-x C-y
1805 Paste a rectangular region into a table.
1806 The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
1807 will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
1808 the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
1809 lines.
1810 @c
1811 @kindex M-@key{RET}
1812 @itemx M-@kbd{RET}
1813 Wrap several fields in a column like a paragraph. If there is an active
1814 region, and both point and mark are in the same column, the text in the
1815 column is wrapped to minimum width for the given number of lines. A numeric
1816 prefix argument may be used to change the number of desired lines. If there
1817 is no region, the current field is split at the cursor position and the text
1818 fragment to the right of the cursor is prepended to the field one line
1819 down. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument, the current
1820 field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field above.
1821
1822 @tsubheading{Calculations}
1823 @cindex formula, in tables
1824 @cindex calculations, in tables
1825 @cindex region, active
1826 @cindex active region
1827 @cindex transient mark mode
1828 @kindex C-c +
1829 @item C-c +
1830 Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
1831 the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
1832 be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
1833 @c
1834 @kindex S-@key{RET}
1835 @item S-@key{RET}
1836 @vindex org-table-copy-increment
1837 When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
1838 empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
1839 Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
1840 values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
1841 be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the
1842 increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes
1843 (@pxref{Conflicts}).
1844
1845 @tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
1846 @kindex C-c `
1847 @item C-c `
1848 Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that
1849 are not fully visible (@pxref{Column width and alignment}). When called with
1850 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
1851 edited in place.
1852 @c
1853 @item M-x org-table-import
1854 Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
1855 separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
1856 from a database, because these programs generally can write
1857 TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
1858 the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
1859 argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
1860 separator.
1861 @item C-c |
1862 Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
1863 buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
1864 @kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
1865 @c
1866 @item M-x org-table-export
1867 @vindex org-table-export-default-format
1868 Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data
1869 exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
1870 used to export the file can be configured in the variable
1871 @code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
1872 @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
1873 name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
1874 general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
1875 format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions}, for a
1876 detailed description.
1877 @end table
1878
1879 If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
1880 way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
1881 it off with
1882
1883 @lisp
1884 (setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
1885 @end lisp
1886
1887 @noindent Then the only table command that still works is
1888 @kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
1889
1890 @node Column width and alignment, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
1891 @section Column width and alignment
1892 @cindex narrow columns in tables
1893 @cindex alignment in tables
1894
1895 The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. And
1896 also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction
1897 of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
1898
1899 Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, leading to
1900 inconveniently wide columns. Or maybe you want to make a table with several
1901 columns having a fixed width, regardless of content. To set@footnote{This
1902 feature does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere
1903 in the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
1904 integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next re-align
1905 will then set the width of this column to this value.
1906
1907 @example
1908 @group
1909 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
1910 | | | | | <6> |
1911 | 1 | one | | 1 | one |
1912 | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
1913 | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
1914 | 4 | four | | 4 | four |
1915 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
1916 @end group
1917 @end example
1918
1919 @noindent
1920 Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
1921 Note that the full text is still in the buffer, it is only invisible.
1922 To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field---a tool-tip window
1923 will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
1924 @kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
1925 open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
1926 C-c}.
1927
1928 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
1929 When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
1930 necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
1931 be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
1932 @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
1933 upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
1934 on a per-file basis with:
1935
1936 @example
1937 #+STARTUP: align
1938 #+STARTUP: noalign
1939 @end example
1940
1941 If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns
1942 to the right and of string-rich column to the left, you and use @samp{<r>} or
1943 @samp{<l>} in a similar fashion. You may also combine alignment and field
1944 width like this: @samp{<l10>}.
1945
1946 Lines which only contain these formatting cookies will be removed
1947 automatically when exporting the document.
1948
1949 @node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Column width and alignment, Tables
1950 @section Column groups
1951 @cindex grouping columns in tables
1952
1953 When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
1954 lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
1955 however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
1956 of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
1957 order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
1958 first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
1959 contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
1960 @samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} to make a column
1961 a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
1962 marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
1963
1964 @example
1965 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
1966 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
1967 | / | < | | > | < | > |
1968 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
1969 | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
1970 | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
1971 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
1972 #+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1)))
1973 @end example
1974
1975 It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
1976 every vertical line you would like to have:
1977
1978 @example
1979 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
1980 |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
1981 | / | < | | | < | |
1982 @end example
1983
1984 @node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
1985 @section The Orgtbl minor mode
1986 @cindex Orgtbl mode
1987 @cindex minor mode for tables
1988
1989 If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
1990 might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
1991 The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
1992 the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for
1993 example in mail mode, use
1994
1995 @lisp
1996 (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
1997 @end lisp
1998
1999 Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
2000 in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
2001 construct La@TeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
2002 Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
2003 @ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
2004
2005 @node The spreadsheet, Org-Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
2006 @section The spreadsheet
2007 @cindex calculations, in tables
2008 @cindex spreadsheet capabilities
2009 @cindex @file{calc} package
2010
2011 The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
2012 spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
2013 derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's implementation
2014 is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, Org knows the concept
2015 of a @emph{column formula} that will be applied to all non-header fields in a
2016 column without having to copy the formula to each relevant field. There is
2017 also a formula debugger, and a formula editor with features for highlighting
2018 fields in the table corresponding to the references at the point in the
2019 formula, moving these references by arrow keys
2020
2021 @menu
2022 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
2023 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
2024 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
2025 * Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
2026 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
2027 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
2028 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
2029 * Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
2030 @end menu
2031
2032 @node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
2033 @subsection References
2034 @cindex references
2035
2036 To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
2037 reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
2038 by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
2039 out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
2040 field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
2041
2042 @subsubheading Field references
2043 @cindex field references
2044 @cindex references, to fields
2045
2046 Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
2047 any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
2048 combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
2049 @c Such references are always fixed to that field, they don't change
2050 @c when you copy and paste a formula to a different field. So
2051 @c Org's @code{B3} behaves like @code{$B$3} in other spreadsheets.
2052
2053 @noindent
2054 Org also uses another, more general operator that looks like this:
2055 @example
2056 @@@var{row}$@var{column}
2057 @end example
2058
2059 @noindent
2060 Column references can be absolute like @samp{1}, @samp{2},...@samp{@var{N}},
2061 or relative to the current column like @samp{+1} or @samp{-2}.
2062
2063 The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal
2064 separator lines (hlines). You can use absolute row numbers
2065 @samp{1}...@samp{@var{N}}, and row numbers relative to the current row like
2066 @samp{+3} or @samp{-1}. Or specify the row relative to one of the
2067 hlines: @samp{I} refers to the first hline@footnote{Note that only
2068 hlines are counted that @emph{separate} table lines. If the table
2069 starts with a hline above the header, it does not count.}, @samp{II} to
2070 the second, etc@. @samp{-I} refers to the first such line above the
2071 current line, @samp{+I} to the first such line below the current line.
2072 You can also write @samp{III+2} which is the second data line after the
2073 third hline in the table.
2074
2075 @samp{0} refers to the current row and column. Also, if you omit
2076 either the column or the row part of the reference, the current
2077 row/column is implied.
2078
2079 Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
2080 in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
2081 different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
2082 Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
2083 references because the same reference operator can reference different
2084 fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
2085
2086 As a special case, references like @samp{$LR5} and @samp{$LR12} can be used
2087 to refer in a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the
2088 table.
2089
2090 Here are a few examples:
2091
2092 @example
2093 @@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column}
2094 C2 @r{same as previous}
2095 $5 @r{column 5 in the current row}
2096 E& @r{same as previous}
2097 @@2 @r{current column, row 2}
2098 @@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
2099 @@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
2100 @end example
2101
2102 @subsubheading Range references
2103 @cindex range references
2104 @cindex references, to ranges
2105
2106 You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
2107 references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
2108 current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
2109 is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
2110 format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
2111 @samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
2112
2113 @example
2114 $1..$3 @r{First three fields in the current row.}
2115 $P..$Q @r{Range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
2116 @@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields.}
2117 A2..C4 @r{Same as above.}
2118 @@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{3 numbers from the column to the left, 2 up to current row}
2119 @end example
2120
2121 @noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
2122 into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally
2123 suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but
2124 see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields,
2125 @samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
2126
2127 @subsubheading Field coordinates in formulas
2128 @cindex field coordinates
2129 @cindex coordinates, of field
2130 @cindex row, of field coordinates
2131 @cindex column, of field coordinates
2132
2133 For Calc formulas and Lisp formulas @code{@@#} and @code{$#} can be used to
2134 get the row or column number of the field where the formula result goes.
2135 The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are @code{org-table-current-dline}
2136 and @code{org-table-current-column}. Examples:
2137
2138 @example
2139 if(@@# % 2, $#, string("")) @r{column number on odd lines only}
2140 $3 = remote(FOO, @@@@#$2) @r{copy column 2 from table FOO into}
2141 @r{column 3 of the current table}
2142 @end example
2143
2144 @noindent For the second example, table FOO must have at least as many rows
2145 as the current table. Inefficient@footnote{The computation time scales as
2146 O(N^2) because table FOO is parsed for each field to be copied.} for large
2147 number of rows.
2148
2149 @subsubheading Named references
2150 @cindex named references
2151 @cindex references, named
2152 @cindex name, of column or field
2153 @cindex constants, in calculations
2154 @cindex #+CONSTANTS
2155
2156 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
2157 @samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
2158 constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable
2159 @code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
2160 line like
2161
2162 @example
2163 #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
2164 @end example
2165
2166 @noindent
2167 @vindex constants-unit-system
2168 @pindex constants.el
2169 Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
2170 constants in table formulas: for a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
2171 @samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
2172 outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
2173 @file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
2174 including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
2175 units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{constants.el} can
2176 supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
2177 and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
2178 @code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
2179 @code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
2180 buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
2181 lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
2182 names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
2183 numbers.
2184
2185 @subsubheading Remote references
2186 @cindex remote references
2187 @cindex references, remote
2188 @cindex references, to a different table
2189 @cindex name, of column or field
2190 @cindex constants, in calculations
2191 @cindex #+TBLNAME
2192
2193 You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table,
2194 either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is
2195
2196 @example
2197 remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
2198 @end example
2199
2200 @noindent
2201 where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
2202 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
2203 entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first
2204 table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as
2205 described above for example @code{@@3$3} or @code{$somename}, valid in the
2206 referenced table.
2207
2208 @node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
2209 @subsection Formula syntax for Calc
2210 @cindex formula syntax, Calc
2211 @cindex syntax, of formulas
2212
2213 A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
2214 @file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the
2215 non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
2216 @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before
2217 evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from
2218 Your Programs,calc-eval,Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs,Calc,GNU
2219 Emacs Calc Manual}),
2220 @c FIXME: The link to the Calc manual in HTML does not work.
2221 variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above.
2222 @cindex vectors, in table calculations
2223 The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
2224 like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
2225
2226 @cindex format specifier
2227 @cindex mode, for @file{calc}
2228 @vindex org-calc-default-modes
2229 A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
2230 string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
2231 execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
2232 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
2233 format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 8)} to keep tables
2234 compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
2235 @code{org-calc-default-modes}.
2236
2237 @example
2238 p20 @r{set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits}
2239 n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{Normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed}
2240 @r{format of the result of Calc passed back to Org.}
2241 @r{Calc formatting is unlimited in precision as}
2242 @r{long as the Calc calculation precision is greater.}
2243 D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians}
2244 F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes}
2245 N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers}
2246 T @r{force text interpretation}
2247 E @r{keep empty fields in ranges}
2248 L @r{literal}
2249 @end example
2250
2251 @noindent
2252 Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision-calculation
2253 and -display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a
2254 @code{printf} format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been
2255 passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the
2256 formatting@footnote{The @code{printf} reformatting is limited in precision
2257 because the value passed to it is converted into an @code{integer} or
2258 @code{double}. The @code{integer} is limited in size by truncating the
2259 signed value to 32 bits. The @code{double} is limited in precision to 64
2260 bits overall which leaves approximately 16 significant decimal digits.}.
2261 A few examples:
2262
2263 @example
2264 $1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
2265 $1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
2266 exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
2267 $0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
2268 ($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
2269 $c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
2270 tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
2271 sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
2272 vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, using vector function}
2273 vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0}
2274 taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
2275 @end example
2276
2277 Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
2278
2279 @example
2280 if($1<20,teen,string("")) @r{``teen'' if age $1 less than 20, else empty}
2281 @end example
2282
2283 @node Formula syntax for Lisp, Field formulas, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
2284 @subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
2285 @cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
2286
2287 It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp; this can be useful
2288 for string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's
2289 functionality is not enough. If a formula starts with a single-quote
2290 followed by an opening parenthesis, then it is evaluated as a Lisp form.
2291 The evaluation should return either a string or a number. Just as with
2292 @file{calc} formulas, you can specify modes and a printf format after a
2293 semicolon. With Emacs Lisp forms, you need to be conscious about the way
2294 field references are interpolated into the form. By default, a
2295 reference will be interpolated as a Lisp string (in double-quotes)
2296 containing the field. If you provide the @samp{N} mode switch, all
2297 referenced elements will be numbers (non-number fields will be zero) and
2298 interpolated as Lisp numbers, without quotes. If you provide the
2299 @samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated literally, without quotes.
2300 I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted as a string by the Lisp
2301 form, enclose the reference operator itself in double-quotes, like
2302 @code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated fields, so you can
2303 embed them in list or vector syntax. A few examples, note how the
2304 @samp{N} mode is used when we do computations in Lisp.
2305
2306 @example
2307 @r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1}
2308 '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
2309 @r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @code{$1+$2}}
2310 '(+ $1 $2);N
2311 @r{Compute the sum of columns 1-4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}}
2312 '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
2313 @end example
2314
2315 @node Field formulas, Column formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
2316 @subsection Field formulas
2317 @cindex field formula
2318 @cindex formula, for individual table field
2319
2320 To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the
2321 field, preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=$1+$2}. When you
2322 press @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in
2323 the field, the formula will be stored as the formula for this field,
2324 evaluated, and the current field replaced with the result.
2325
2326 @cindex #+TBLFM
2327 Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:}
2328 directly below the table. If you typed the equation in the 4th field of
2329 the 3rd data line in the table, the formula will look like
2330 @samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows
2331 with the appropriate commands, @i{absolute references} (but not relative
2332 ones) in stored formulas are modified in order to still reference the
2333 same field. Of course this is not true if you edit the table structure
2334 with normal editing commands---then you must fix the equations yourself.
2335 The left-hand side of a formula may also be a named field (@pxref{Advanced
2336 features}), or a last-row reference like @samp{$LR3}.
2337
2338 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2339 following command
2340
2341 @table @kbd
2342 @kindex C-u C-c =
2343 @item C-u C-c =
2344 Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
2345 formula with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
2346 it to the current field, and stores it.
2347 @end table
2348
2349 @node Column formulas, Editing and debugging formulas, Field formulas, The spreadsheet
2350 @subsection Column formulas
2351 @cindex column formula
2352 @cindex formula, for table column
2353
2354 Often in a table, the same formula should be used for all fields in a
2355 particular column. Instead of having to copy the formula to all fields
2356 in that column, Org allows you to assign a single formula to an entire
2357 column. If the table contains horizontal separator hlines, everything
2358 before the first such line is considered part of the table @emph{header}
2359 and will not be modified by column formulas.
2360
2361 To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
2362 column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
2363 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2364 the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated
2365 and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only
2366 @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each
2367 column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In the
2368 @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like @samp{$4=$1+$2}. The left-hand
2369 side of a column formula cannot currently be the name of column, it
2370 must be the numeric column reference.
2371
2372 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2373 following command:
2374
2375 @table @kbd
2376 @kindex C-c =
2377 @item C-c =
2378 Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
2379 the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
2380 taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
2381 stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g. @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
2382 will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
2383 @end table
2384
2385 @node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
2386 @subsection Editing and debugging formulas
2387 @cindex formula editing
2388 @cindex editing, of table formulas
2389
2390 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2391 You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
2392 field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active
2393 formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org
2394 converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&})
2395 if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like
2396 @code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable
2397 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
2398
2399 @table @kbd
2400 @kindex C-c =
2401 @kindex C-u C-c =
2402 @item C-c =
2403 @itemx C-u C-c =
2404 Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
2405 minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas}, and @ref{Field formulas}.
2406 @kindex C-u C-u C-c =
2407 @item C-u C-u C-c =
2408 Re-insert the active formula (either a
2409 field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
2410 can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
2411 minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
2412 @kindex C-c ?
2413 @item C-c ?
2414 While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
2415 referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
2416 @kindex C-c @}
2417 @item C-c @}
2418 Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using
2419 overlays. These are updated each time the table is aligned; you can
2420 force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2421 @kindex C-c @{
2422 @item C-c @{
2423 Toggle the formula debugger on and off. See below.
2424 @kindex C-c '
2425 @item C-c '
2426 Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
2427 formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
2428 active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
2429 While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
2430 any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
2431 remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
2432 @table @kbd
2433 @kindex C-c C-c
2434 @kindex C-x C-s
2435 @item C-c C-c
2436 @itemx C-x C-s
2437 Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
2438 prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
2439 @kindex C-c C-q
2440 @item C-c C-q
2441 Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
2442 @kindex C-c C-r
2443 @item C-c C-r
2444 Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
2445 @code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
2446 @kindex @key{TAB}
2447 @item @key{TAB}
2448 Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
2449 a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
2450 Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
2451 formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2452 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
2453 @item M-@key{TAB}
2454 Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2455 @kindex S-@key{up}
2456 @kindex S-@key{down}
2457 @kindex S-@key{left}
2458 @kindex S-@key{right}
2459 @item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
2460 Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
2461 @code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
2462 This also works for relative references and for hline references.
2463 @kindex M-S-@key{up}
2464 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
2465 @item M-S-@key{up}/@key{down}
2466 Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
2467 down.
2468 @kindex M-@key{up}
2469 @kindex M-@key{down}
2470 @item M-@key{up}/@key{down}
2471 Scroll the window displaying the table.
2472 @kindex C-c @}
2473 @item C-c @}
2474 Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
2475 @end table
2476 @end table
2477
2478 Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
2479 the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{#+TBLFM}
2480 line)---during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
2481 To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
2482 prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
2483
2484 @kindex C-c C-c
2485 You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
2486 equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line or with the normal
2487 recalculation commands in the table.
2488
2489 @subsubheading Debugging formulas
2490 @cindex formula debugging
2491 @cindex debugging, of table formulas
2492 When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
2493 becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
2494 on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
2495 turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
2496 calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
2497 field. Detailed information will be displayed.
2498
2499 @node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
2500 @subsection Updating the table
2501 @cindex recomputing table fields
2502 @cindex updating, table
2503
2504 Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
2505 triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features}, for a way to make
2506 recalculation at least semi-automatic.
2507
2508 In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
2509 following commands:
2510
2511 @table @kbd
2512 @kindex C-c *
2513 @item C-c *
2514 Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
2515 from left to right, and all field formulas in the current row.
2516 @c
2517 @kindex C-u C-c *
2518 @item C-u C-c *
2519 @kindex C-u C-c C-c
2520 @itemx C-u C-c C-c
2521 Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
2522 hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
2523 @c
2524 @kindex C-u C-u C-c *
2525 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-c
2526 @item C-u C-u C-c *
2527 @itemx C-u C-u C-c C-c
2528 Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
2529 This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
2530 fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
2531 @item M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2532 Recompute all tables in the current buffer.
2533 @item M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2534 Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge table-to-table
2535 dependencies.
2536 @end table
2537
2538 @node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
2539 @subsection Advanced features
2540
2541 If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if
2542 you want to be able to assign @i{names} to fields and columns, you need
2543 to reserve the first column of the table for special marking characters.
2544 @table @kbd
2545 @kindex C-#
2546 @item C-#
2547 Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{ },
2548 @samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
2549 change all marks in the region.
2550 @end table
2551
2552 Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
2553 makes use of these features:
2554
2555 @example
2556 @group
2557 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2558 | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
2559 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2560 | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
2561 | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
2562 | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
2563 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2564 | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
2565 | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
2566 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2567 | | Average | | | | 29.7 | |
2568 | ^ | | | | | at | |
2569 | $ | max=50 | | | | | |
2570 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2571 #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
2572 @end group
2573 @end example
2574
2575 @noindent @b{Important}: please note that for these special tables,
2576 recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
2577 are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
2578 to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
2579 empty first field.
2580
2581 @cindex marking characters, tables
2582 The marking characters have the following meaning:
2583 @table @samp
2584 @item !
2585 The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
2586 refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
2587 @item ^
2588 This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
2589 a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
2590 the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
2591 will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
2592 @item _
2593 Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
2594 @emph{below}.
2595 @item $
2596 Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
2597 example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
2598 formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
2599 Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
2600 a per-table basis.
2601 @item #
2602 Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
2603 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
2604 is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
2605 lines will be left alone by this command.
2606 @item *
2607 Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
2608 not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
2609 recalculation slows down editing too much.
2610 @item
2611 Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
2612 All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
2613 or @samp{*}.
2614 @item /
2615 Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
2616 @samp{<N>} markers or column group markers.
2617 @end table
2618
2619 Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
2620 fantastic @file{calc.el} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
2621 series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
2622 functions.
2623
2624 @example
2625 @group
2626 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2627 | | Func | n | x | Result |
2628 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2629 | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
2630 | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
2631 | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
2632 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
2633 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
2634 | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
2635 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2636 #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
2637 @end group
2638 @end example
2639
2640 @node Org-Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
2641 @section Org-Plot
2642 @cindex graph, in tables
2643 @cindex plot tables using Gnuplot
2644 @cindex #+PLOT
2645
2646 Org-Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
2647 using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
2648 @uref{http://cars9.uchicago.edu/~ravel/software/gnuplot-mode.html}. To see
2649 this in action, ensure that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed
2650 on your system, then call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
2651
2652 @example
2653 @group
2654 #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
2655 | Sede | Max cites | H-index |
2656 |-----------+-----------+---------|
2657 | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
2658 | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
2659 | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
2660 | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
2661 | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
2662 @end group
2663 @end example
2664
2665 Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels.
2666 Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
2667 be exercised through the @code{#+PLOT:} lines preceding a table. See below
2668 for a complete list of Org-plot options. For more information and examples
2669 see the Org-plot tutorial at
2670 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.php}.
2671
2672 @subsubheading Plot Options
2673
2674 @table @code
2675 @item set
2676 Specify any @command{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
2677
2678 @item title
2679 Specify the title of the plot.
2680
2681 @item ind
2682 Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
2683
2684 @item deps
2685 Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses
2686 and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
2687 fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the @code{ind}
2688 column).
2689
2690 @item type
2691 Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
2692
2693 @item with
2694 Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
2695 (e.g. @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
2696 Defaults to @code{lines}.
2697
2698 @item file
2699 If you want to plot to a file, specify @code{"@var{path/to/desired/output-file}"}.
2700
2701 @item labels
2702 List of labels to be used for the deps (defaults to the column headers if
2703 they exist).
2704
2705 @item line
2706 Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
2707
2708 @item map
2709 When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
2710 flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
2711
2712 @item timefmt
2713 Specify format of Org-mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot.
2714 Defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S}.
2715
2716 @item script
2717 If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place the file name
2718 between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
2719 instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
2720 the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you
2721 may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
2722 the data file.
2723 @end table
2724
2725 @node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
2726 @chapter Hyperlinks
2727 @cindex hyperlinks
2728
2729 Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
2730 other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
2731
2732 @menu
2733 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
2734 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
2735 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
2736 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
2737 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
2738 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
2739 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
2740 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
2741 @end menu
2742
2743 @node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
2744 @section Link format
2745 @cindex link format
2746 @cindex format, of links
2747
2748 Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
2749 clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
2750
2751 @example
2752 [[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
2753 @end example
2754
2755 @noindent
2756 Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
2757 will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
2758 of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
2759 @samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
2760 which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
2761 visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
2762 part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
2763 edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
2764 cursor on the link.
2765
2766 If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
2767 displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
2768 (invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
2769 and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
2770 missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
2771 internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
2772 @code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
2773
2774 @node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
2775 @section Internal links
2776 @cindex internal links
2777 @cindex links, internal
2778 @cindex targets, for links
2779
2780 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
2781 If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in the
2782 current file. The most important case is a link like
2783 @samp{[[#my-custom-id]]} which will link to the entry with the
2784 @code{CUSTOM_ID} property @samp{my-custom-id}. Such custom IDs are very good
2785 for HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}) where they produce pretty section
2786 links. You are responsible yourself to make sure these custom IDs are unique
2787 in a file.
2788
2789 Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My Target][Find my target]]}
2790 lead to a text search in the current file.
2791
2792 The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the link,
2793 or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). Links to custom IDs will
2794 point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for a text link is
2795 a @i{dedicated target}: the same string in double angular brackets. Targets
2796 may be located anywhere; sometimes it is convenient to put them into a
2797 comment line. For example
2798
2799 @example
2800 # <<My Target>>
2801 @end example
2802
2803 @noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become
2804 named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note that
2805 text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the first such
2806 target should be after the first headline, or in the line directly before the
2807 first headline.}.
2808
2809 If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for the words in the link. In
2810 the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}. Links starting
2811 with a star like @samp{*My Target} restrict the search to
2812 headlines@footnote{To insert a link targeting a headline, in-buffer
2813 completion can be used. Just type a star followed by a few optional letters
2814 into the buffer and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current
2815 buffer will be offered as completions. @xref{Handling links}, for more
2816 commands creating links.}. When searching, Org-mode will first try an
2817 exact match, but then move on to more and more lenient searches. For
2818 example, the link @samp{[[*My Targets]]} will find any of the following:
2819
2820 @example
2821 ** My targets
2822 ** TODO my targets are bright
2823 ** my 20 targets are
2824 @end example
2825
2826
2827 Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
2828 return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
2829 several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
2830 earlier.
2831
2832 @menu
2833 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
2834 @end menu
2835
2836 @node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
2837 @subsection Radio targets
2838 @cindex radio targets
2839 @cindex targets, radio
2840 @cindex links, radio targets
2841
2842 Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
2843 in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
2844 text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
2845 enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
2846 Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
2847 become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
2848 for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
2849 update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
2850 cursor on or at a target.
2851
2852 @node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
2853 @section External links
2854 @cindex links, external
2855 @cindex external links
2856 @cindex links, external
2857 @cindex Gnus links
2858 @cindex BBDB links
2859 @cindex IRC links
2860 @cindex URL links
2861 @cindex file links
2862 @cindex VM links
2863 @cindex RMAIL links
2864 @cindex WANDERLUST links
2865 @cindex MH-E links
2866 @cindex USENET links
2867 @cindex SHELL links
2868 @cindex Info links
2869 @cindex Elisp links
2870
2871 Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages,
2872 BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their
2873 logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
2874 identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
2875 the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
2876
2877 @example
2878 http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
2879 doi:10.1000/182 @r{DOI for an electronic resource}
2880 file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
2881 /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
2882 file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
2883 ./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
2884 file:/myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{file, path on remote machine}
2885 /myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
2886 file:sometextfile::NNN @r{file with line number to jump to}
2887 file:projects.org @r{another Org file}
2888 file:projects.org::some words @r{text search in Org file}
2889 file:projects.org::*task title @r{heading search in Org file}
2890 docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN @r{open file in doc-view mode at page NNN}
2891 id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 @r{Link to heading by ID}
2892 news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
2893 mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
2894 vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
2895 vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
2896 vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
2897 wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
2898 wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
2899 mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
2900 mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
2901 rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
2902 rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
2903 gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
2904 gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
2905 bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
2906 irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
2907 info:org:External%20links @r{Info node link (with encoded space)}
2908 shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
2909 elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive Elisp command}
2910 elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
2911 @end example
2912
2913 A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
2914 descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link
2915 format}), for example:
2916
2917 @example
2918 [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
2919 @end example
2920
2921 @noindent
2922 If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
2923 export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
2924 button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
2925 image,
2926 that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
2927
2928 @cindex square brackets, around links
2929 @cindex plain text external links
2930 Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
2931 as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
2932 @samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
2933 about the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets.
2934
2935 @node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
2936 @section Handling links
2937 @cindex links, handling
2938
2939 Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
2940 insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
2941
2942 @table @kbd
2943 @kindex C-c l
2944 @cindex storing links
2945 @item C-c l
2946 Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command (you
2947 must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to
2948 create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org
2949 buffer (see below). What kind of link will be created depends on the current
2950 buffer:
2951
2952 @b{Org-mode buffers}@*
2953 For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
2954 to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which will also
2955 be the description.
2956
2957 @vindex org-link-to-org-use-id
2958 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
2959 @cindex property, ID
2960 If the headline has a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property, a link to this custom ID
2961 will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the value of
2962 @code{org-link-to-org-use-id}), a globally unique @code{ID} property will be
2963 created and/or used to construct a link. So using this command in Org
2964 buffers will potentially create two links: a human-readable from the custom
2965 ID, and one that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from
2966 file to file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one
2967 to use.
2968
2969 @b{Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus}@*
2970 Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will point to the
2971 current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the group. The description is
2972 constructed from the author and the subject.
2973
2974 @b{Web browsers: W3 and W3M}@*
2975 Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as description.
2976
2977 @b{Contacts: BBDB}@*
2978 Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry.
2979
2980 @b{Chat: IRC}@*
2981 @vindex org-irc-link-to-logs
2982 For IRC links, if you set the variable @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to
2983 @code{t}, a @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for
2984 the current conversation is created. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to
2985 the user/channel/server under the point will be stored.
2986
2987 @b{Other files}@*
2988 For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
2989 (@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
2990 there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
2991 search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
2992 accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
2993 and to do the search for particular file types---see @ref{Custom searches}.
2994 The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion---see @ref{Installation}.
2995
2996 @b{Agenda view}@*
2997 When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to the
2998 entry referenced by the current line.
2999
3000 @c
3001 @kindex C-c C-l
3002 @cindex link completion
3003 @cindex completion, of links
3004 @cindex inserting links
3005 @item C-c C-l
3006 @vindex org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion
3007 Insert a link@footnote{ Note that you don't have to use this command to
3008 insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them
3009 straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically
3010 enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional
3011 descriptive text.}. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer.
3012 You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
3013 type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link will be inserted
3014 into the buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be
3015 removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use
3016 a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
3017 @code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
3018 If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
3019 becomes the default description.
3020
3021 @b{Inserting stored links}@*
3022 All links stored during the
3023 current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
3024 them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}).
3025
3026 @b{Completion support}@* Completion with @key{TAB} will help you to insert
3027 valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes
3028 defined through link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). If you
3029 press @key{RET} after inserting only the @var{prefix}, Org will offer
3030 specific completion support for some link types@footnote{This works by
3031 calling a special function @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link}.} For
3032 example, if you type @kbd{file @key{RET}}, file name completion (alternative
3033 access: @kbd{C-u C-c C-l}, see below) will be offered, and after @kbd{bbdb
3034 @key{RET}} you can complete contact names.
3035 @kindex C-u C-c C-l
3036 @cindex file name completion
3037 @cindex completion, of file names
3038 @item C-u C-c C-l
3039 When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
3040 a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
3041 the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
3042 directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current
3043 directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
3044 to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
3045 is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
3046 force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
3047 @c
3048 @item C-c C-l @ @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
3049 When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
3050 link and description parts of the link.
3051 @c
3052 @cindex following links
3053 @kindex C-c C-o
3054 @kindex @key{RET}
3055 @item C-c C-o @ @r{(or, if @code{org-return-follows-link} is set, also} @key{RET}
3056 @vindex org-file-apps
3057 Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
3058 @command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
3059 the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
3060 cursor is on an internal link, this command runs the corresponding search.
3061 When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
3062 TAGS view. If the cursor is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that
3063 date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
3064 with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
3065 Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
3066 @code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
3067 visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
3068 opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.@*
3069 If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the
3070 headline and entry text.
3071 @c
3072 @kindex mouse-2
3073 @kindex mouse-1
3074 @item mouse-2
3075 @itemx mouse-1
3076 On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
3077 would. Under Emacs 22, @kbd{mouse-1} will also follow a link.
3078 @c
3079 @kindex mouse-3
3080 @item mouse-3
3081 @vindex org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer
3082 Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
3083 internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
3084 variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
3085 @c
3086 @cindex inlining images
3087 @cindex images, inlining
3088 @kindex C-c C-x C-v
3089 @item C-c C-x C-v
3090 Toggle the inline display of linked images. Normally this will only inline
3091 images that have no description part in the link, i.e. images that will also
3092 be inlined during export. When called with a prefix argument, also display
3093 images that do have a link description.
3094 @cindex mark ring
3095 @kindex C-c %
3096 @item C-c %
3097 Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
3098 easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
3099 @c
3100 @cindex links, returning to
3101 @kindex C-c &
3102 @item C-c &
3103 Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
3104 commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
3105 command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
3106 previously recorded positions.
3107 @c
3108 @kindex C-c C-x C-n
3109 @kindex C-c C-x C-p
3110 @cindex links, finding next/previous
3111 @item C-c C-x C-n
3112 @itemx C-c C-x C-p
3113 Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
3114 the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
3115 bindings for this are really too long, you might want to bind this also
3116 to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
3117 @lisp
3118 (add-hook 'org-load-hook
3119 (lambda ()
3120 (define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
3121 (define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
3122 @end lisp
3123 @end table
3124
3125 @node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
3126 @section Using links outside Org
3127
3128 You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
3129 Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
3130 global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
3131 yourself):
3132
3133 @lisp
3134 (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
3135 (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
3136 @end lisp
3137
3138 @node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
3139 @section Link abbreviations
3140 @cindex link abbreviations
3141 @cindex abbreviation, links
3142
3143 Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
3144 needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
3145 abbreviated link looks like this
3146
3147 @example
3148 [[linkword:tag][description]]
3149 @end example
3150
3151 @noindent
3152 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
3153 where the tag is optional.
3154 The @i{linkword} must be a word, starting with a letter, followed by
3155 letters, numbers, @samp{-}, and @samp{_}. Abbreviations are resolved
3156 according to the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}
3157 that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
3158
3159 @lisp
3160 @group
3161 (setq org-link-abbrev-alist
3162 '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
3163 ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
3164 ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/
3165 nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
3166 @end group
3167 @end lisp
3168
3169 If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
3170 replaced with the tag. Otherwise the tag will be appended to the string
3171 in order to create the link. You may also specify a function that will
3172 be called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
3173
3174 With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
3175 @code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
3176 @code{[[google:OrgMode]]} and find out what the Org author is
3177 doing besides Emacs hacking with @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
3178
3179 If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
3180 can define them in the file with
3181
3182 @cindex #+LINK
3183 @example
3184 #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
3185 #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
3186 @end example
3187
3188 @noindent
3189 In-buffer completion (@pxref{Completion}) can be used after @samp{[} to
3190 complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function
3191 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g. completion)
3192 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
3193 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
3194
3195 @node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
3196 @section Search options in file links
3197 @cindex search option in file links
3198 @cindex file links, searching
3199
3200 File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
3201 particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
3202 line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
3203 compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
3204 example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
3205 links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
3206 string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
3207 link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
3208
3209 Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
3210 link, together with an explanation:
3211
3212 @example
3213 [[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
3214 [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
3215 [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
3216 [[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]]
3217 [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
3218 @end example
3219
3220 @table @code
3221 @item 255
3222 Jump to line 255.
3223 @item My Target
3224 Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
3225 @samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
3226 @ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
3227 link will become an HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
3228 the linked file.
3229 @item *My Target
3230 In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
3231 @item #my-custom-id
3232 Link to a heading with a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property
3233 @item /regexp/
3234 Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
3235 command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
3236 target file is in Org-mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
3237 sparse tree with the matches.
3238 @c If the target file is a directory,
3239 @c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
3240 @end table
3241
3242 As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
3243 to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
3244 a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
3245 @samp{[[find me]]} would.
3246
3247 @node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
3248 @section Custom Searches
3249 @cindex custom search strings
3250 @cindex search strings, custom
3251
3252 The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
3253 actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
3254 cases. For example, Bib@TeX{} database files have many entries like
3255 @samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
3256 because the only unique identification for a Bib@TeX{} entry is the
3257 citation key.
3258
3259 @vindex org-create-file-search-functions
3260 @vindex org-execute-file-search-functions
3261 If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
3262 the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
3263 for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
3264 to be added to the hook variables
3265 @code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
3266 @code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
3267 variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
3268 for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
3269 an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
3270
3271 @node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
3272 @chapter TODO items
3273 @cindex TODO items
3274
3275 Org-mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
3276 course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items,
3277 but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
3278 notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
3279 mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
3280 information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
3281 item emerged is always present.
3282
3283 Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
3284 throughout your notes file. Org-mode compensates for this by providing
3285 methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
3286
3287 @menu
3288 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
3289 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
3290 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
3291 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
3292 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
3293 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
3294 @end menu
3295
3296 @node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
3297 @section Basic TODO functionality
3298
3299 Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
3300 @samp{TODO}, for example:
3301
3302 @example
3303 *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
3304 @end example
3305
3306 @noindent
3307 The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
3308
3309 @table @kbd
3310 @kindex C-c C-t
3311 @cindex cycling, of TODO states
3312 @item C-c C-t
3313 Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
3314
3315 @example
3316 ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
3317 '--------------------------------'
3318 @end example
3319
3320 The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and
3321 agenda buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3322
3323 @kindex C-u C-c C-t
3324 @item C-u C-c C-t
3325 Select a specific keyword using completion or (if it has been set up)
3326 the fast selection interface. For the latter, you need to assign keys
3327 to TODO states, see @ref{Per-file keywords}, and @ref{Setting tags}, for
3328 more information.
3329
3330 @kindex S-@key{right}
3331 @kindex S-@key{left}
3332 @vindex org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change
3333 @item S-@key{right}
3334 @itemx S-@key{left}
3335 Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
3336 mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
3337 extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction
3338 with @code{shift-selection-mode}. See also the variable
3339 @code{org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change}.
3340 @kindex C-c / t
3341 @cindex sparse tree, for TODO
3342 @itemx C-c / t
3343 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3344 View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds the
3345 entire buffer, but shows all TODO items (with not-DONE state) and the
3346 headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument (or by using @kbd{C-c
3347 / T}), search for a specific TODO. You will be prompted for the keyword, and
3348 you can also give a list of keywords like @code{KWD1|KWD2|...} to list
3349 entries that match any one of these keywords. With numeric prefix argument
3350 N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the variable
3351 @code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix arguments, find all TODO states,
3352 both un-done and done.
3353 @kindex C-c a t
3354 @item C-c a t
3355 Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE states)
3356 from all agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new
3357 buffer will be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
3358 manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3359 @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
3360 @kindex S-M-@key{RET}
3361 @item S-M-@key{RET}
3362 Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
3363 @end table
3364
3365 @noindent
3366 @vindex org-todo-state-tags-triggers
3367 Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
3368 option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
3369
3370 @node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
3371 @section Extended use of TODO keywords
3372 @cindex extended TODO keywords
3373
3374 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3375 By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
3376 DONE. Org-mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
3377 with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
3378 special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
3379 files.
3380
3381 Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
3382 TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
3383
3384 @menu
3385 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
3386 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
3387 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
3388 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
3389 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
3390 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
3391 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
3392 @end menu
3393
3394 @node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
3395 @subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
3396 @cindex TODO workflow
3397 @cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
3398
3399 You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
3400 in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
3401 this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org-mode in a
3402 buffer.}:
3403
3404 @lisp
3405 (setq org-todo-keywords
3406 '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
3407 @end lisp
3408
3409 The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
3410 action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
3411 you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
3412 state.
3413 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
3414 With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
3415 to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED. You may
3416 also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
3417 example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY.
3418 Or you can use @kbd{S-@key{left}} to go backward through the sequence. If you
3419 define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
3420 (@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
3421 (@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
3422 buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
3423 @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}, for more information.
3424
3425 @node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
3426 @subsection TODO keywords as types
3427 @cindex TODO types
3428 @cindex names as TODO keywords
3429 @cindex types as TODO keywords
3430
3431 The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
3432 @emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
3433 that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
3434 people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
3435 directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
3436 be set up like this:
3437
3438 @lisp
3439 (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
3440 @end lisp
3441
3442 In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
3443 different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
3444 person, and later to mark it DONE. Org-mode supports this style by adapting
3445 the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
3446 @kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
3447 times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
3448 select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
3449 time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
3450 to DONE. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
3451 name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
3452 by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c / t}. For example, to see all things
3453 Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c / t}. To collect Lucy's items
3454 from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
3455 argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c a t}.
3456
3457 @node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
3458 @subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
3459 @cindex TODO keyword sets
3460
3461 Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
3462 parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
3463 @code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
3464 separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
3465 DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
3466 like this:
3467
3468 @lisp
3469 (setq org-todo-keywords
3470 '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
3471 (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
3472 (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
3473 @end lisp
3474
3475 The keywords should all be different, this helps Org-mode to keep track
3476 of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
3477 @kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
3478 @code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
3479 (nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
3480 select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
3481 keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
3482
3483 @table @kbd
3484 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
3485 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
3486 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t
3487 @item C-u C-u C-c C-t
3488 @itemx C-S-@key{right}
3489 @itemx C-S-@key{left}
3490 These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
3491 @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or
3492 @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to
3493 @code{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with
3494 @code{shift-selection-mode} (@pxref{Conflicts}).
3495 @kindex S-@key{right}
3496 @kindex S-@key{left}
3497 @item S-@key{right}
3498 @itemx S-@key{left}
3499 @kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through @emph{all}
3500 keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} would switch
3501 from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. See also
3502 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
3503 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3504 @end table
3505
3506 @node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
3507 @subsection Fast access to TODO states
3508
3509 If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
3510 instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for
3511 single-letter access to the states. This is done by adding the section
3512 key after each keyword, in parentheses. For example:
3513
3514 @lisp
3515 (setq org-todo-keywords
3516 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
3517 (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
3518 (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
3519 @end lisp
3520
3521 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo
3522 If you then press @code{C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the entry
3523 will be switched to this state. @key{SPC} can be used to remove any TODO
3524 keyword from an entry.@footnote{Check also the variable
3525 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows you to change the TODO
3526 state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you like to
3527 mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with
3528 unique keys across both sets of keywords.}
3529
3530 @node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
3531 @subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
3532 @cindex keyword options
3533 @cindex per-file keywords
3534 @cindex #+TODO
3535 @cindex #+TYP_TODO
3536 @cindex #+SEQ_TODO
3537
3538 It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
3539 different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
3540 to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
3541 only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
3542 need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
3543 file:
3544
3545 @example
3546 #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
3547 @end example
3548 @noindent (you may also write @code{#+SEQ_TODO} to be explicit about the
3549 interpretation, but it means the same as @code{#+TODO}), or
3550 @example
3551 #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
3552 @end example
3553
3554 A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
3555
3556 @example
3557 #+TODO: TODO | DONE
3558 #+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
3559 #+TODO: | CANCELED
3560 @end example
3561
3562 @cindex completion, of option keywords
3563 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
3564 @noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
3565 @samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
3566
3567 @cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
3568 Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
3569 if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
3570 may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
3571 @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
3572 known to Org-mode@footnote{Org-mode parses these lines only when
3573 Org-mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3574 cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org-mode
3575 for the current buffer.}.
3576
3577 @node Faces for TODO keywords, TODO dependencies, Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
3578 @subsection Faces for TODO keywords
3579 @cindex faces, for TODO keywords
3580
3581 @vindex org-todo @r{(face)}
3582 @vindex org-done @r{(face)}
3583 @vindex org-todo-keyword-faces
3584 Org-mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
3585 for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
3586 @code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
3587 you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
3588 special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
3589 @code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
3590
3591 @lisp
3592 @group
3593 (setq org-todo-keyword-faces
3594 '(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow")
3595 ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
3596 @end group
3597 @end lisp
3598
3599 While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED @emph{should}
3600 work, this does not aways seem to be the case. If necessary, define a
3601 special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a color. The variable
3602 @code{org-faces-easy-properties} determines if that color is interpreted as a
3603 foreground or a background color.
3604
3605 @node TODO dependencies, , Faces for TODO keywords, TODO extensions
3606 @subsection TODO dependencies
3607 @cindex TODO dependencies
3608 @cindex dependencies, of TODO states
3609
3610 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
3611 @cindex property, ORDERED
3612 The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO
3613 dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until
3614 all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE. And sometimes
3615 there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task
3616 cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize
3617 the variable @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org will block entries
3618 from changing state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE.
3619 Furthermore, if an entry has a property @code{ORDERED}, each of its children
3620 will be blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE. Here is an
3621 example:
3622
3623 @example
3624 * TODO Blocked until (two) is done
3625 ** DONE one
3626 ** TODO two
3627
3628 * Parent
3629 :PROPERTIES:
3630 :ORDERED: t
3631 :END:
3632 ** TODO a
3633 ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
3634 ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
3635 @end example
3636
3637 @table @kbd
3638 @kindex C-c C-x o
3639 @item C-c C-x o
3640 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
3641 @cindex property, ORDERED
3642 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the current entry. A property is used
3643 for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not
3644 inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of
3645 this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the variable
3646 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
3647 @kindex C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t
3648 @item C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t
3649 Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking.
3650 @end table
3651
3652 @vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
3653 If you set the variable @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries
3654 that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed
3655 font or even made invisible in agenda views (@pxref{Agenda Views}).
3656
3657 @cindex checkboxes and TODO dependencies
3658 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
3659 You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes
3660 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). If you set the variable
3661 @code{org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies}, an entry that has unchecked
3662 checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE.
3663
3664 If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies
3665 between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed
3666 module @file{org-depend.el}.
3667
3668 @page
3669 @node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
3670 @section Progress logging
3671 @cindex progress logging
3672 @cindex logging, of progress
3673
3674 Org-mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when
3675 you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
3676 a TODO item. This system is highly configurable, settings can be on a
3677 per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
3678 information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
3679 work time}.
3680
3681 @menu
3682 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
3683 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
3684 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
3685 @end menu
3686
3687 @node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
3688 @subsection Closing items
3689
3690 The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
3691 item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
3692 in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}.
3693
3694 @lisp
3695 (setq org-log-done 'time)
3696 @end lisp
3697
3698 @noindent
3699 Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
3700 of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted
3701 just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
3702 through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
3703 want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The
3704 corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}}
3705
3706 @lisp
3707 (setq org-log-done 'note)
3708 @end lisp
3709
3710 @noindent
3711 You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
3712 the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
3713
3714 In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
3715 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
3716 display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
3717 giving you an overview of what has been done.
3718
3719 @node Tracking TODO state changes, Tracking your habits, Closing items, Progress logging
3720 @subsection Tracking TODO state changes
3721 @cindex drawer, for state change recording
3722
3723 @vindex org-log-states-order-reversed
3724 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
3725 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
3726 When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow states}), you
3727 might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a
3728 note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a
3729 time-stamped note for a change. These records will be inserted after the
3730 headline as an itemized list, newest first@footnote{See the variable
3731 @code{org-log-states-order-reversed}}. When taking a lot of notes, you might
3732 want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (@pxref{Drawers}).
3733 Customize the variable @code{org-log-into-drawer} to get this
3734 behavior---the recommended drawer for this is called @code{LOGBOOK}. You can
3735 also overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
3736 @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
3737
3738 Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org-mode
3739 expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by
3740 adding special markers @samp{!} (for a timestamp) and @samp{@@} (for a note)
3741 in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the setting
3742
3743 @lisp
3744 (setq org-todo-keywords
3745 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
3746 @end lisp
3747
3748 @noindent
3749 @vindex org-log-done
3750 you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
3751 request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to
3752 DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org-mode will record two timestamps
3753 when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
3754 However, it will never prompt for two notes---if you have configured
3755 both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
3756 the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
3757 WAIT or CANCELED. The setting for WAIT is even more special: the
3758 @samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
3759 entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
3760 WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
3761 logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
3762 to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
3763 when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
3764 setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
3765 configured.
3766
3767 You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
3768 to a buffer:
3769 @example
3770 #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
3771 @end example
3772
3773 @cindex property, LOGGING
3774 In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
3775 single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
3776 LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
3777 on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
3778 @code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
3779 settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
3780
3781 @example
3782 * TODO Log each state with only a time
3783 :PROPERTIES:
3784 :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
3785 :END:
3786 * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
3787 :PROPERTIES:
3788 :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
3789 :END:
3790 * TODO No logging at all
3791 :PROPERTIES:
3792 :LOGGING: nil
3793 :END:
3794 @end example
3795
3796 @node Tracking your habits, , Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging
3797 @subsection Tracking your habits
3798 @cindex habits
3799
3800 Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODOs,
3801 called ``habits''. A habit has the following properties:
3802
3803 @enumerate
3804 @item
3805 You have enabled the @code{habits} module by customizing the variable
3806 @code{org-modules}.
3807 @item
3808 The habit is a TODO, with a TODO keyword representing an open state.
3809 @item
3810 The property @code{STYLE} is set to the value @code{habit}.
3811 @item
3812 The TODO has a scheduled date, with a @code{.+} style repeat interval.
3813 @item
3814 The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the
3815 syntax @samp{.+2d/3d}, which says that you want to do the task at least every
3816 three days, but at most every two days.
3817 @item
3818 You must also have state logging for the @code{DONE} state enabled, in order
3819 for historical data to be represented in the consistency graph. If it's not
3820 enabled it's not an error, but the consistency graphs will be largely
3821 meaningless.
3822 @end enumerate
3823
3824 To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an
3825 actual habit with some history:
3826
3827 @example
3828 ** TODO Shave
3829 SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
3830 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
3831 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
3832 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
3833 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
3834 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
3835 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
3836 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
3837 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
3838 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
3839 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
3840 :PROPERTIES:
3841 :STYLE: habit
3842 :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
3843 :END:
3844 @end example
3845
3846 What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given by the
3847 @code{SCHEDULED} date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. If
3848 today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct 17,
3849 after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19,
3850 after four days have elapsed.
3851
3852 What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a
3853 consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task
3854 done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the
3855 past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are:
3856
3857 @table @code
3858 @item Blue
3859 If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day.
3860 @item Green
3861 If the task could have been done on that day.
3862 @item Yellow
3863 If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
3864 @item Red
3865 If the task was overdue on that day.
3866 @end table
3867
3868 In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterisk if
3869 the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where
3870 the current day falls in the graph.
3871
3872 There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way
3873 habits are displayed in the agenda.
3874
3875 @table @code
3876 @item org-habit-graph-column
3877 The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This will
3878 overwrite any text in that column, so it's a good idea to keep your habits'
3879 titles brief and to the point.
3880 @item org-habit-preceding-days
3881 The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs.
3882 @item org-habit-following-days
3883 The number of days after today that will appear in consistency graphs.
3884 @item org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today
3885 If non-nil, only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set to true by
3886 default.
3887 @end table
3888
3889 Lastly, pressing @kbd{K} in the agenda buffer will cause habits to
3890 temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press @kbd{K} again to
3891 bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits
3892 which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.
3893
3894 @node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
3895 @section Priorities
3896 @cindex priorities
3897
3898 If you use Org-mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items that
3899 it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
3900 placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like this
3901
3902 @example
3903 *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
3904 @end example
3905
3906 @noindent
3907 @vindex org-priority-faces
3908 By default, Org-mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
3909 @samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is
3910 treated as priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only in the
3911 agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they have no
3912 inherent meaning to Org-mode. The cookies can be highlighted with special
3913 faces by customizing the variable @code{org-priority-faces}.
3914
3915 Priorities can be attached to any outline tree entries; they do not need
3916 to be TODO items.
3917
3918 @table @kbd
3919 @kindex @kbd{C-c ,}
3920 @item @kbd{C-c ,}
3921 Set the priority of the current headline. The command prompts for a
3922 priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}. When you press
3923 @key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the headline.
3924 The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline and
3925 agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3926 @c
3927 @kindex S-@key{up}
3928 @kindex S-@key{down}
3929 @item S-@key{up}
3930 @itemx S-@key{down}
3931 @vindex org-priority-start-cycle-with-default
3932 Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the option
3933 @code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default}.}. Note that these keys are
3934 also used to modify timestamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). See also
3935 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
3936 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3937 @end table
3938
3939 @vindex org-highest-priority
3940 @vindex org-lowest-priority
3941 @vindex org-default-priority
3942 You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables
3943 @code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
3944 @code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
3945 these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
3946 the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
3947 priority):
3948
3949 @cindex #+PRIORITIES
3950 @example
3951 #+PRIORITIES: A C B
3952 @end example
3953
3954 @node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
3955 @section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
3956 @cindex tasks, breaking down
3957 @cindex statistics, for TODO items
3958
3959 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
3960 It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
3961 subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
3962 with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
3963 global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
3964 the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
3965 either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
3966 be updated each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing
3967 @kbd{C-c C-c} on the cookie. For example:
3968
3969 @example
3970 * Organize Party [33%]
3971 ** TODO Call people [1/2]
3972 *** TODO Peter
3973 *** DONE Sarah
3974 ** TODO Buy food
3975 ** DONE Talk to neighbor
3976 @end example
3977
3978 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
3979 If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of
3980 the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
3981 @code{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve
3982 this issue.
3983
3984 @vindex org-hierarchical-todo-statistics
3985 If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the
3986 subtree (not just direct children), configure the variable
3987 @code{org-hierarchical-todo-statistics}. To do this for a single subtree,
3988 include the word @samp{recursive} into the value of the @code{COOKIE_DATA}
3989 property.
3990
3991 @example
3992 * Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
3993 :PROPERTIES:
3994 :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
3995 :END:
3996 @end example
3997
3998 If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE
3999 when all children are done, you can use the following setup:
4000
4001 @example
4002 (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
4003 "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
4004 (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
4005 (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
4006
4007 (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
4008 @end example
4009
4010
4011 Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
4012 large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
4013
4014
4015 @node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
4016 @section Checkboxes
4017 @cindex checkboxes
4018
4019 Every item in a plain list (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a
4020 checkbox by starting it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is
4021 similar to TODO items (@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight.
4022 Checkboxes are not included into the global TODO list, so they are often
4023 great to split a task into a number of simple steps. Or you can use
4024 them in a shopping list. To toggle a checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or
4025 use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's @file{org-mouse.el}).
4026
4027 Here is an example of a checkbox list.
4028
4029 @example
4030 * TODO Organize party [2/4]
4031 - [-] call people [1/3]
4032 - [ ] Peter
4033 - [X] Sarah
4034 - [ ] Sam
4035 - [X] order food
4036 - [ ] think about what music to play
4037 - [X] talk to the neighbors
4038 @end example
4039
4040 Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
4041 are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
4042 parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
4043 checked.
4044
4045 @cindex statistics, for checkboxes
4046 @cindex checkbox statistics
4047 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4048 @vindex org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics
4049 The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are cookies
4050 indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off,
4051 and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how
4052 many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can
4053 be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item.
4054 Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the
4055 headline/item on which the cookie appears@footnote{Set the variable
4056 @code{org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics} if you want such cookies to
4057 represent the all checkboxes below the cookie, not just the direct
4058 children.}. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either
4059 @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m}
4060 result, as in the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about
4061 the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
4062 @samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can
4063 count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it
4064 will display whatever was changed last. Set the property @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4065 to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue.
4066
4067 @cindex blocking, of checkboxes
4068 @cindex checkbox blocking
4069 @cindex property, ORDERED
4070 If the current outline node has an @code{ORDERED} property, checkboxes must
4071 be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try to check
4072 off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
4073
4074 @noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
4075
4076 @table @kbd
4077 @kindex C-c C-c
4078 @item C-c C-c
4079 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4080 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4081 intermediate state.
4082 @kindex C-c C-x C-b
4083 @item C-c C-x C-b
4084 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4085 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4086 intermediate state.
4087 @itemize @minus
4088 @item
4089 If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
4090 and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix
4091 arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region.
4092 @item
4093 If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
4094 this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
4095 @item
4096 If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
4097 @end itemize
4098 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
4099 @item M-S-@key{RET}
4100 Insert a new item with a checkbox.
4101 This works only if the cursor is already in a plain list item
4102 (@pxref{Plain lists}).
4103 @kindex C-c C-x o
4104 @item C-c C-x o
4105 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4106 @cindex property, ORDERED
4107 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must
4108 be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because
4109 this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag.
4110 However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of this property with a tag
4111 for better visibility, customize the variable
4112 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4113 @kindex C-c #
4114 @item C-c #
4115 Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with
4116 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are
4117 updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make
4118 new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. TODO statistics cookies update when
4119 changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by
4120 hand, use this command to get things back into sync. Or simply toggle any
4121 entry twice (checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c}).
4122 @end table
4123
4124 @node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
4125 @chapter Tags
4126 @cindex tags
4127 @cindex headline tagging
4128 @cindex matching, tags
4129 @cindex sparse tree, tag based
4130
4131 An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
4132 information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org-mode has extensive
4133 support for tags.
4134
4135 @vindex org-tag-faces
4136 Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
4137 headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
4138 @samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
4139 @samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
4140 Tags will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline.
4141 You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
4142 @code{org-tag-faces}, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
4143 (@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
4144
4145 @menu
4146 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
4147 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
4148 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
4149 @end menu
4150
4151 @node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
4152 @section Tag inheritance
4153 @cindex tag inheritance
4154 @cindex inheritance, of tags
4155 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
4156
4157 @i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
4158 heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
4159 well. For example, in the list
4160
4161 @example
4162 * Meeting with the French group :work:
4163 ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
4164 *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
4165 @end example
4166
4167 @noindent
4168 the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
4169 @samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
4170 explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
4171 a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical
4172 level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this@footnote{As
4173 with all these in-buffer settings, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any
4174 changes in the line.}:
4175
4176 @cindex #+FILETAGS
4177 @example
4178 #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
4179 @end example
4180
4181 @noindent
4182 @vindex org-use-tag-inheritance
4183 @vindex org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance
4184 To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, or to turn it off entirely, use
4185 the variables @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} and
4186 @code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
4187
4188 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4189 When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
4190 on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
4191 as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more
4192 complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
4193 of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
4194 match in a subtree, configure the variable
4195 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended).
4196
4197 @node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags
4198 @section Setting tags
4199 @cindex setting tags
4200 @cindex tags, setting
4201
4202 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
4203 Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
4204 After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
4205 also a special command for inserting tags:
4206
4207 @table @kbd
4208 @kindex C-c C-q
4209 @item C-c C-q
4210 @cindex completion, of tags
4211 @vindex org-tags-column
4212 Enter new tags for the current headline. Org-mode will either offer
4213 completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
4214 below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
4215 to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
4216 tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
4217 things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
4218 demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
4219 @kindex C-c C-c
4220 @item C-c C-c
4221 When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
4222 @end table
4223
4224 @vindex org-tag-alist
4225 Org will support tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
4226 default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
4227 currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
4228 of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
4229 the default tags for a given file with lines like
4230
4231 @cindex #+TAGS
4232 @example
4233 #+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
4234 #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
4235 @end example
4236
4237 If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
4238 variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
4239 in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
4240
4241 @example
4242 #+TAGS:
4243 @end example
4244
4245 @vindex org-tag-persistent-alist
4246 If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file,
4247 in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS option lines, then
4248 you may specify a list of tags with the variable
4249 @code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
4250 by adding a STARTUP option line to that file:
4251
4252 @example
4253 #+STARTUP: noptag
4254 @end example
4255
4256 By default Org-mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
4257 entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
4258 method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
4259 deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
4260 assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
4261 globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
4262 @file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
4263 different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
4264 like:
4265
4266 @lisp
4267 (setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
4268 @end lisp
4269
4270 @noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
4271 can instead set the TAGS option line as:
4272
4273 @example
4274 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
4275 @end example
4276
4277 @noindent The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash
4278 window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert
4279 @samp{\n} into the tag list
4280
4281 @example
4282 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
4283 @end example
4284
4285 @noindent or write them in two lines:
4286
4287 @example
4288 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t)
4289 #+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
4290 @end example
4291
4292 @noindent
4293 You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
4294 braces, as in:
4295
4296 @example
4297 #+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
4298 @end example
4299
4300 @noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
4301 and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
4302
4303 @noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
4304 these lines to activate any changes.
4305
4306 @noindent
4307 To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-tags-alist},
4308 you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
4309 of the braces. Similarly, you can use @code{:newline} to indicate a line
4310 break. The previous example would be set globally by the following
4311 configuration:
4312
4313 @lisp
4314 (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
4315 ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
4316 ("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
4317 (:endgroup . nil)
4318 ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
4319 @end lisp
4320
4321 If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
4322 automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
4323 the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
4324 corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
4325 have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
4326 keys:
4327
4328 @table @kbd
4329 @item a-z...
4330 Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
4331 tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
4332 exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
4333 @kindex @key{TAB}
4334 @item @key{TAB}
4335 Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
4336 list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
4337 @kindex @key{SPC}
4338 @item @key{SPC}
4339 Clear all tags for this line.
4340 @kindex @key{RET}
4341 @item @key{RET}
4342 Accept the modified set.
4343 @item C-g
4344 Abort without installing changes.
4345 @item q
4346 If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
4347 @item !
4348 Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
4349 exception) assign several tags from such a group.
4350 @item C-c
4351 Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
4352 If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
4353 selection window.
4354 @end table
4355
4356 @noindent
4357 This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
4358 the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
4359 @samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
4360 C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
4361 @samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
4362 alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
4363 @samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
4364 @key{RET} @key{RET}}.
4365
4366 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-single-key
4367 If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
4368 modify your list of tags, set the variable
4369 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to
4370 press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection---it will immediately exit
4371 after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press
4372 @kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process
4373 (in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c
4374 C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special
4375 window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only
4376 when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
4377
4378 @node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags
4379 @section Tag searches
4380 @cindex tag searches
4381 @cindex searching for tags
4382
4383 Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
4384 information into special lists.
4385
4386 @table @kbd
4387 @kindex C-c \
4388 @kindex C-c / m
4389 @item C-c \
4390 @itemx C-c / m
4391 Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a
4392 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4393 @kindex C-c a m
4394 @item C-c a m
4395 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files.
4396 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4397 @kindex C-c a M
4398 @item C-c a M
4399 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4400 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4401 only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
4402 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4403 @end table
4404
4405 These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic
4406 like @samp{+boss+urgent-project1}, to find entries with tags @samp{boss} and
4407 @samp{urgent}, but not @samp{project1}, or @samp{Kathy|Sally} to find entries
4408 which are tagged, like @samp{Kathy} or @samp{Sally}. The full syntax of the search
4409 string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels
4410 and properties. For a complete description with many examples, see
4411 @ref{Matching tags and properties}.
4412
4413
4414 @node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
4415 @chapter Properties and columns
4416 @cindex properties
4417
4418 Properties are a set of key-value pairs associated with an entry. There
4419 are two main applications for properties in Org-mode. First, properties
4420 are like tags, but with a value. Second, you can use properties to
4421 implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. For
4422 an example of the first application, imagine maintaining a file where
4423 you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of
4424 using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, one can use a
4425 property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
4426 values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. For an example of the second
4427 application of properties, imagine keeping track of your music CDs,
4428 where properties could be things such as the album, artist, date of
4429 release, number of tracks, and so on.
4430
4431 Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
4432 (@pxref{Column view}).
4433
4434 @menu
4435 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
4436 * Special properties:: Access to other Org-mode features
4437 * Property searches:: Matching property values
4438 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
4439 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
4440 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
4441 @end menu
4442
4443 @node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
4444 @section Property syntax
4445 @cindex property syntax
4446 @cindex drawer, for properties
4447
4448 Properties are key-value pairs. They need to be inserted into a special
4449 drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
4450 is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
4451 first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
4452
4453 @example
4454 * CD collection
4455 ** Classic
4456 *** Goldberg Variations
4457 :PROPERTIES:
4458 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4459 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4460 :Artist: Glen Gould
4461 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4462 :NDisks: 1
4463 :END:
4464 @end example
4465
4466 You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
4467 by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
4468 @emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
4469 the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
4470 corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
4471 errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
4472 publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
4473
4474 @example
4475 * CD collection
4476 :PROPERTIES:
4477 :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
4478 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
4479 :END:
4480 @end example
4481
4482 If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
4483 file, use a line like
4484 @cindex property, _ALL
4485 @cindex #+PROPERTY
4486 @example
4487 #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
4488 @end example
4489
4490 @vindex org-global-properties
4491 Property values set with the global variable
4492 @code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
4493 Org files.
4494
4495 @noindent
4496 The following commands help to work with properties:
4497
4498 @table @kbd
4499 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
4500 @item M-@key{TAB}
4501 After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
4502 in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
4503 @kindex C-c C-x p
4504 @item C-c C-x p
4505 Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
4506 necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
4507 @item M-x org-insert-property-drawer
4508 Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
4509 inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
4510 information like deadlines.
4511 @kindex C-c C-c
4512 @item C-c C-c
4513 With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
4514 @item C-c C-c s
4515 Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
4516 can be inserted using completion.
4517 @kindex S-@key{right}
4518 @kindex S-@key{left}
4519 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
4520 Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
4521 @item C-c C-c d
4522 Remove a property from the current entry.
4523 @item C-c C-c D
4524 Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
4525 @item C-c C-c c
4526 Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
4527 nearest column format definition.
4528 @end table
4529
4530 @node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
4531 @section Special properties
4532 @cindex properties, special
4533
4534 Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org-mode
4535 features, like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the
4536 previous chapters. This interface exists so that you can include
4537 these states in a column view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in
4538 queries. The following property names are special and should not be
4539 used as keys in the properties drawer:
4540
4541 @cindex property, special, TODO
4542 @cindex property, special, TAGS
4543 @cindex property, special, ALLTAGS
4544 @cindex property, special, CATEGORY
4545 @cindex property, special, PRIORITY
4546 @cindex property, special, DEADLINE
4547 @cindex property, special, SCHEDULED
4548 @cindex property, special, CLOSED
4549 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP
4550 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA
4551 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
4552 @cindex property, special, BLOCKED
4553 @c guessing that ITEM is needed in this area; also, should this list be sorted?
4554 @cindex property, special, ITEM
4555 @example
4556 TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
4557 TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
4558 ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
4559 CATEGORY @r{The category of an entry.}
4560 PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
4561 DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
4562 SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets.}
4563 CLOSED @r{When was this entry closed?}
4564 TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry.}
4565 TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive timestamp in the entry.}
4566 CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
4567 @r{must be run first to compute the values.}
4568 BLOCKED @r{"t" if task is currently blocked by children or siblings}
4569 ITEM @r{The content of the entry.}
4570 @end example
4571
4572 @node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
4573 @section Property searches
4574 @cindex properties, searching
4575 @cindex searching, of properties
4576
4577 To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
4578 the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}).
4579 @table @kbd
4580 @kindex C-c \
4581 @kindex C-c / m
4582 @item C-c \
4583 @itemx C-c / m
4584 Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a
4585 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4586 @kindex C-c a m
4587 @item C-c a m
4588 Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files.
4589 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4590 @kindex C-c a M
4591 @item C-c a M
4592 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4593 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4594 only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see variable
4595 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4596 @end table
4597
4598 The syntax for the search string is described in @ref{Matching tags and
4599 properties}.
4600
4601 There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
4602 single property:
4603
4604 @table @kbd
4605 @kindex C-c / p
4606 @item C-c / p
4607 Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
4608 prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
4609 is created with all entries that define this property with the given
4610 value. If you enclose the value into curly braces, it is interpreted as
4611 a regular expression and matched against the property values.
4612 @end table
4613
4614 @node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
4615 @section Property Inheritance
4616 @cindex properties, inheritance
4617 @cindex inheritance, of properties
4618
4619 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
4620 The outline structure of Org-mode documents lends itself for an
4621 inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain
4622 property, the children can inherit this property. Org-mode does not
4623 turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
4624 significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
4625 useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
4626 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t} to make
4627 all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
4628 that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
4629 inherited properties. If a property has the value @samp{nil}, this is
4630 interpreted as an explicit undefine of he property, so that inheritance
4631 search will stop at this value and return @code{nil}.
4632
4633 Org-mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
4634 least for the special applications for which they are used:
4635
4636 @cindex property, COLUMNS
4637 @table @code
4638 @item COLUMNS
4639 The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
4640 (@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
4641 where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
4642 point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
4643 subtree from where columns view is turned on.
4644 @item CATEGORY
4645 @cindex property, CATEGORY
4646 For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
4647 applies to the entire subtree.
4648 @item ARCHIVE
4649 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
4650 For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
4651 location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
4652 @item LOGGING
4653 @cindex property, LOGGING
4654 The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
4655 subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
4656 @end table
4657
4658 @node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
4659 @section Column view
4660
4661 A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
4662 @emph{column view}. In column view, each outline node is turned into a
4663 table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
4664 entries. Org-mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
4665 over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
4666 into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
4667 tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
4668 view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
4669 is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
4670 headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
4671 tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
4672 Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
4673 queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
4674
4675 @menu
4676 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
4677 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
4678 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
4679 @end menu
4680
4681 @node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
4682 @subsection Defining columns
4683 @cindex column view, for properties
4684 @cindex properties, column view
4685
4686 Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
4687 done by defining a column format line.
4688
4689 @menu
4690 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
4691 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
4692 @end menu
4693
4694 @node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
4695 @subsubsection Scope of column definitions
4696
4697 To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
4698
4699 @cindex #+COLUMNS
4700 @example
4701 #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
4702 @end example
4703
4704 To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
4705 @code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
4706
4707 @example
4708 ** Top node for columns view
4709 :PROPERTIES:
4710 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
4711 :END:
4712 @end example
4713
4714 If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
4715 for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
4716 column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
4717 you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
4718 sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
4719 deeper part of the tree.
4720
4721 @node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
4722 @subsubsection Column attributes
4723 A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
4724 definition looks like this:
4725
4726 @example
4727 %[@var{width}]@var{property}[(@var{title})][@{@var{summary-type}@}]
4728 @end example
4729
4730 @noindent
4731 Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
4732 optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
4733
4734 @example
4735 @var{width} @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
4736 @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
4737 @var{property} @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
4738 @r{Special properties representing meta data are allowed here}
4739 @r{as well (@pxref{Special properties})}
4740 (title) @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the}
4741 @r{property name is used.}
4742 @{@var{summary-type}@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
4743 @r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
4744 @r{Supported summary types are:}
4745 @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
4746 @{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
4747 @{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
4748 @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are hours.}
4749 @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[X]} if all children are @samp{[X]}.}
4750 @{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n/m]}.}
4751 @{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n%]}.}
4752 @{min@} @r{Smallest number in column.}
4753 @{max@} @r{Largest number.}
4754 @{mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of numbers.}
4755 @{:min@} @r{Smallest time value in column.}
4756 @{:max@} @r{Largest time value.}
4757 @{:mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of time values.}
4758 @{@@min@} @r{Minimum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
4759 @{@@max@} @r{Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
4760 @{@@mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
4761 @end example
4762
4763 @noindent
4764 Be aware that you can only have one summary type for any property you
4765 include. Subsequent columns referencing the same property will all display the
4766 same summary information.
4767
4768 Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
4769 values.
4770
4771 @example
4772 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line---it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
4773 %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
4774 :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
4775 :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
4776 :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
4777 @end example
4778
4779 @noindent
4780 The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
4781 item itself, i.e. of the headline. You probably always should start the
4782 column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
4783 create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
4784 @samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
4785 field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
4786 character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
4787 to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
4788 modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
4789 be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
4790 expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
4791 an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
4792 @samp{CLOCKSUM} column is special, it lists the sum of CLOCK intervals
4793 in the subtree.
4794
4795 @node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
4796 @subsection Using column view
4797
4798 @table @kbd
4799 @tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
4800 @kindex C-c C-x C-c
4801 @item C-c C-x C-c
4802 @vindex org-columns-default-format
4803 Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline in the file,
4804 column view is turned on for the entire file, using the @code{#+COLUMNS}
4805 definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the outline, this command
4806 searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that
4807 defines a format. When one is found, the column view table is established
4808 for the tree starting at the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
4809 property. If no such property is found, the format is taken from the
4810 @code{#+COLUMNS} line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format},
4811 and column view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
4812 @kindex r
4813 @item r
4814 Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
4815 @kindex g
4816 @item g
4817 Same as @kbd{r}.
4818 @kindex q
4819 @item q
4820 Exit column view.
4821 @tsubheading{Editing values}
4822 @item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
4823 Move through the column view from field to field.
4824 @kindex S-@key{left}
4825 @kindex S-@key{right}
4826 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
4827 Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
4828 have to have specified allowed values for a property.
4829 @item 1..9,0
4830 Directly select the nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
4831 @kindex n
4832 @kindex p
4833 @itemx n / p
4834 Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
4835 @kindex e
4836 @item e
4837 Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
4838 invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
4839 property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
4840 or fast selection interface will pop up.
4841 @kindex C-c C-c
4842 @item C-c C-c
4843 When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
4844 @kindex v
4845 @item v
4846 View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
4847 the column is smaller than that of the value.
4848 @kindex a
4849 @item a
4850 Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
4851 in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
4852 found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
4853 current column view.
4854 @tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
4855 @kindex <
4856 @kindex >
4857 @item < / >
4858 Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
4859 @kindex S-M-@key{right}
4860 @item S-M-@key{right}
4861 Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
4862 @kindex S-M-@key{left}
4863 @item S-M-@key{left}
4864 Delete the current column.
4865 @end table
4866
4867 @node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
4868 @subsection Capturing column view
4869
4870 Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
4871 exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
4872 a @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
4873 of this block looks like this:
4874
4875 @cindex #+BEGIN, columnview
4876 @example
4877 * The column view
4878 #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
4879
4880 #+END:
4881 @end example
4882
4883 @noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
4884
4885 @table @code
4886 @item :id
4887 This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
4888 often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
4889 at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
4890 capture, you can use 4 values:
4891 @cindex property, ID
4892 @example
4893 local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
4894 global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
4895 "file:@var{path-to-file}"
4896 @r{run column view at the top of this file}
4897 "@var{ID}" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
4898 @r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
4899 @r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for}
4900 @r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
4901 @end example
4902 @item :hlines
4903 When @code{t}, insert an hline after every line. When a number @var{N}, insert
4904 an hline before each headline with level @code{<= @var{N}}.
4905 @item :vlines
4906 When set to @code{t}, force column groups to get vertical lines.
4907 @item :maxlevel
4908 When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
4909 @item :skip-empty-rows
4910 When set to @code{t}, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the
4911 column view is @code{ITEM}.
4912
4913 @end table
4914
4915 @noindent
4916 The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
4917
4918 @table @kbd
4919 @kindex C-c C-x i
4920 @item C-c C-x i
4921 Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
4922 for the scope or ID of the view.
4923 @kindex C-c C-c
4924 @item C-c C-c
4925 @kindex C-c C-x C-u
4926 @itemx C-c C-x C-u
4927 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
4928 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
4929 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u
4930 @item C-u C-c C-x C-u
4931 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
4932 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
4933 @end table
4934
4935 You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
4936 instructions in front of the table---these will survive an update of the
4937 block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
4938 actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
4939
4940 An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is
4941 provided by Eric Schulte's @file{org-collector.el} which is a contributed
4942 package@footnote{Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are
4943 distributed with the main distribution of Org (visit
4944 @uref{http://orgmode.org}).}. It provides a general API to collect
4945 properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to
4946 process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block.
4947
4948 @node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
4949 @section The Property API
4950 @cindex properties, API
4951 @cindex API, for properties
4952
4953 There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
4954 be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
4955 features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
4956 property API}.
4957
4958 @node Dates and Times, Capture - Refile - Archive, Properties and Columns, Top
4959 @chapter Dates and times
4960 @cindex dates
4961 @cindex times
4962 @cindex timestamp
4963 @cindex date stamp
4964
4965 To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
4966 a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
4967 information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org-mode. This may be a
4968 little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
4969 something was created or last changed. However, in Org-mode this term
4970 is used in a much wider sense.
4971
4972 @menu
4973 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
4974 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
4975 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
4976 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
4977 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time if you've been idle
4978 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
4979 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
4980 @end menu
4981
4982
4983 @node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
4984 @section Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling
4985 @cindex timestamps
4986 @cindex ranges, time
4987 @cindex date stamps
4988 @cindex deadlines
4989 @cindex scheduling
4990
4991 A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of
4992 times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>} or
4993 @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue
4994 12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is inspired by the standard ISO 8601 date/time
4995 format. To use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time format}.}. A
4996 timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org tree entry.
4997 Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the agenda
4998 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
4999
5000 @table @var
5001 @item Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment
5002 @cindex timestamp
5003 A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
5004 like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
5005 timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
5006 plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that date.
5007
5008 @example
5009 * Meet Peter at the movies <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
5010 * Discussion on climate change <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
5011 @end example
5012
5013 @item Timestamp with repeater interval
5014 @cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
5015 A timestamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
5016 applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
5017 interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The
5018 following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
5019
5020 @example
5021 * Pick up Sam at school <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
5022 @end example
5023
5024 @item Diary-style sexp entries
5025 For more complex date specifications, Org-mode supports using the
5026 special sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
5027 package. For example
5028
5029 @example
5030 * The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
5031 <%%(diary-float t 4 2)>
5032 @end example
5033
5034 @item Time/Date range
5035 @cindex timerange
5036 @cindex date range
5037 Two timestamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
5038 will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
5039 that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
5040
5041 @example
5042 ** Meeting in Amsterdam
5043 <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
5044 @end example
5045
5046 @item Inactive timestamp
5047 @cindex timestamp, inactive
5048 @cindex inactive timestamp
5049 Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
5050 angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do
5051 @emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
5052
5053 @example
5054 * Gillian comes late for the fifth time [2006-11-01 Wed]
5055 @end example
5056
5057 @end table
5058
5059 @node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
5060 @section Creating timestamps
5061 @cindex creating timestamps
5062 @cindex timestamps, creating
5063
5064 For Org-mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
5065 format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
5066 format.
5067
5068 @table @kbd
5069 @kindex C-c .
5070 @item C-c .
5071 Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the cursor is
5072 at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
5073 timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
5074 succession, a time range is inserted.
5075 @c
5076 @kindex C-c !
5077 @item C-c !
5078 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause
5079 an agenda entry.
5080 @c
5081 @kindex C-u C-c .
5082 @kindex C-u C-c !
5083 @item C-u C-c .
5084 @itemx C-u C-c !
5085 @vindex org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes
5086 Like @kbd{C-c .} and @kbd{C-c !}, but use the alternative format which
5087 contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5
5088 minutes, see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
5089 @c
5090 @kindex C-c <
5091 @item C-c <
5092 Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
5093 @c
5094 @kindex C-c >
5095 @item C-c >
5096 Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
5097 timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
5098 instead.
5099 @c
5100 @kindex C-c C-o
5101 @item C-c C-o
5102 Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at
5103 point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
5104 @c
5105 @kindex S-@key{left}
5106 @kindex S-@key{right}
5107 @item S-@key{left}
5108 @itemx S-@key{right}
5109 Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
5110 shift-selection and related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5111 @c
5112 @kindex S-@key{up}
5113 @kindex S-@key{down}
5114 @item S-@key{up}
5115 @itemx S-@key{down}
5116 Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
5117 year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range
5118 like @samp{15:30-16:30}, modifying the first time will also shift the second,
5119 shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify
5120 the second time. Note that if the cursor is in a headline and not at a
5121 timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item.
5122 (@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and
5123 related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5124 @c
5125 @kindex C-c C-y
5126 @cindex evaluate time range
5127 @item C-c C-y
5128 Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
5129 With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
5130 the following column).
5131 @end table
5132
5133
5134 @menu
5135 * The date/time prompt:: How Org-mode helps you entering date and time
5136 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
5137 @end menu
5138
5139 @node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
5140 @subsection The date/time prompt
5141 @cindex date, reading in minibuffer
5142 @cindex time, reading in minibuffer
5143
5144 @vindex org-read-date-prefer-future
5145 When Org-mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
5146 date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
5147 format. But it will in fact accept any string containing some date and/or
5148 time information, and it is really smart about interpreting your input. You
5149 can, for example, use @kbd{C-y} to paste a (possibly multi-line) string
5150 copied from an email message. Org-mode will find whatever information is in
5151 there and derive anything you have not specified from the @emph{default date
5152 and time}. The default is usually the current date and time, but when
5153 modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a
5154 range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in
5155 information, Org-mode assumes that most of the time you will want to enter a
5156 date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is
5157 @i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a future date@footnote{See the
5158 variable @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}. You may set that variable to
5159 the symbol @code{time} to even make a time before now shift the date to
5160 tomorrow.}. If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the
5161 time prompt will show this with @samp{(=>F).}
5162
5163 For example, let's assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
5164 various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org-mode are
5165 in @b{bold}.
5166
5167 @example
5168 3-2-5 --> 2003-02-05
5169 2/5/3 --> 2003-02-05
5170 14 --> @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
5171 12 --> @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
5172 2/5 --> @b{2007}-02-05
5173 Fri --> nearest Friday (default date or later)
5174 sep 15 --> @b{2006}-09-15
5175 feb 15 --> @b{2007}-02-15
5176 sep 12 9 --> 2009-09-12
5177 12:45 --> @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
5178 22 sept 0:34 --> @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
5179 w4 --> ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
5180 2012 w4 fri --> Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
5181 2012-w04-5 --> Same as above
5182 @end example
5183
5184 Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
5185 @emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a
5186 letter ([dwmy]) to indicate change in days, weeks, months, or years. With a
5187 single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
5188 double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
5189 a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
5190 the nth such day. E.g.
5191
5192 @example
5193 +0 --> today
5194 . --> today
5195 +4d --> four days from today
5196 +4 --> same as above
5197 +2w --> two weeks from today
5198 ++5 --> five days from default date
5199 +2tue --> second Tuesday from now.
5200 @end example
5201
5202 @vindex parse-time-months
5203 @vindex parse-time-weekdays
5204 The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
5205 you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
5206 the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
5207
5208 @cindex calendar, for selecting date
5209 @vindex org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt
5210 Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
5211 you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
5212 @code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
5213 prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
5214 @key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
5215 information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
5216 from the minibuffer:
5217
5218 @kindex <
5219 @kindex >
5220 @kindex M-v
5221 @kindex C-v
5222 @kindex mouse-1
5223 @kindex S-@key{right}
5224 @kindex S-@key{left}
5225 @kindex S-@key{down}
5226 @kindex S-@key{up}
5227 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
5228 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
5229 @kindex @key{RET}
5230 @example
5231 @key{RET} @r{Choose date at cursor in calendar.}
5232 mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
5233 S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
5234 S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
5235 M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
5236 > / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
5237 M-v / C-v @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by 3 months.}
5238 @end example
5239
5240 @vindex org-read-date-display-live
5241 The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
5242 will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
5243 way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
5244 on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
5245 minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
5246 @code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
5247
5248 @node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
5249 @subsection Custom time format
5250 @cindex custom date/time format
5251 @cindex time format, custom
5252 @cindex date format, custom
5253
5254 @vindex org-display-custom-times
5255 @vindex org-time-stamp-custom-formats
5256 Org-mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
5257 defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
5258 representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
5259 customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and
5260 @code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
5261
5262 @table @kbd
5263 @kindex C-c C-x C-t
5264 @item C-c C-x C-t
5265 Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
5266 @end table
5267
5268 @noindent
5269 Org-mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
5270 format does not @emph{replace} the default format---instead it is put
5271 @emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
5272 following consequences:
5273 @itemize @bullet
5274 @item
5275 You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before or
5276 after.
5277 @item
5278 The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
5279 each component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
5280 the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
5281 just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
5282 time will be changed by one minute.
5283 @item
5284 If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
5285 will not be overlayed, but remain in the buffer as they were.
5286 @item
5287 When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only
5288 disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
5289 belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
5290 @item
5291 If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are
5292 using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
5293 format is shorter, things do work as expected.
5294 @end itemize
5295
5296
5297 @node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
5298 @section Deadlines and scheduling
5299
5300 A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
5301
5302 @table @var
5303 @item DEADLINE
5304 @cindex DEADLINE keyword
5305
5306 Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
5307 to be finished on that date.
5308
5309 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5310 On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
5311 addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
5312 approaching or missed deadline, starting
5313 @code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
5314 until the entry is marked DONE. An example:
5315
5316 @example
5317 *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
5318 The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
5319 DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
5320 @end example
5321
5322 You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
5323 deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
5324 period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}.
5325
5326 @item SCHEDULED
5327 @cindex SCHEDULED keyword
5328
5329 Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
5330 date.
5331
5332 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done
5333 The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
5334 be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE. If you don't like
5335 this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
5336 addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
5337 in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE.
5338 I.e. the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
5339
5340 @example
5341 *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
5342 SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
5343 @end example
5344
5345 @noindent
5346 @b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org-mode should @i{not} be
5347 understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
5348 Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
5349 mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown
5350 on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by
5351 Org users. In Org-mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
5352 want to start working on an action item.
5353 @end table
5354
5355 You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
5356 entries. Org-mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
5357 assumption that the timestamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
5358 the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
5359 @c
5360 @code{<%%(diary-float t 42)>}
5361 @c
5362 in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org-mode does not
5363 know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
5364 late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
5365 sexp entry matches.
5366
5367 @menu
5368 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
5369 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
5370 @end menu
5371
5372 @node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
5373 @subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
5374
5375 The following commands allow you to quickly insert a deadline or to schedule
5376 an item:
5377
5378 @table @kbd
5379 @c
5380 @kindex C-c C-d
5381 @item C-c C-d
5382 Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will happen
5383 in the line directly following the headline. When called with a prefix arg,
5384 an existing deadline will be removed from the entry. Depending on the
5385 variable @code{org-log-redeadline}@footnote{with corresponding
5386 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline},
5387 and @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5388 deadline.
5389 @c FIXME Any CLOSED timestamp will be removed.????????
5390 @c
5391 @kindex C-c C-s
5392 @item C-c C-s
5393 Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
5394 happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp
5395 will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove the scheduling
5396 date from the entry. Depending on the variable
5397 @code{org-log-reschedule}@footnote{with corresponding @code{#+STARTUP}
5398 keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline}, and
5399 @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5400 scheduling time.
5401 @c
5402 @kindex C-c C-x C-k
5403 @kindex k a
5404 @kindex k s
5405 @item C-c C-x C-k
5406 Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
5407 like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
5408 date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
5409 schedule the marked item.
5410 @c
5411 @kindex C-c / d
5412 @cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
5413 @item C-c / d
5414 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5415 Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
5416 which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
5417 With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
5418 prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
5419 all deadlines due tomorrow.
5420 @c
5421 @kindex C-c / b
5422 @item C-c / b
5423 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date.
5424 @c
5425 @kindex C-c / a
5426 @item C-c / a
5427 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
5428 @end table
5429
5430 @node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
5431 @subsection Repeated tasks
5432 @cindex tasks, repeated
5433 @cindex repeated tasks
5434
5435 Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org-mode helps to
5436 organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
5437 or plain timestamp. In the following example
5438 @example
5439 ** TODO Pay the rent
5440 DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
5441 @end example
5442 @noindent
5443 the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
5444 has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month starting
5445 from that time. If you need both a repeater and a special warning period in
5446 a deadline entry, the repeater should come first and the warning period last:
5447 @code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
5448
5449 @vindex org-todo-repeat-to-state
5450 Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they are
5451 over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as completed
5452 once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE with the TODO
5453 keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the agenda. The problem
5454 with this is, however, that then also the @emph{next} instance of the
5455 repeated entry will not be active. Org-mode deals with this in the following
5456 way: When you try to mark such an entry DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will
5457 shift the base date of the repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and
5458 immediately set the entry state back to TODO@footnote{In fact, the target
5459 state is taken from, in this sequence, the @code{REPEAT_TO_STATE} property or
5460 the variable @code{org-todo-repeat-to-state}. If neither of these is
5461 specified, the target state defaults to the first state of the TODO state
5462 sequence.}. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would actually
5463 switch the date like this:
5464
5465 @example
5466 ** TODO Pay the rent
5467 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
5468 @end example
5469
5470 @vindex org-log-repeat
5471 A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
5472 @code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
5473 @code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
5474 will also be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
5475 a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
5476
5477 As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
5478 visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
5479 will be visible.
5480
5481 With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
5482 month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this
5483 entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
5484 task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
5485 forgot to call you father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
5486 him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
5487 like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
5488 @i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org-mode has
5489 special repeaters markers with @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
5490
5491 @example
5492 ** TODO Call Father
5493 DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
5494 Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
5495 but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
5496 the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
5497 and marked it done on Saturday.
5498 ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
5499 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
5500 Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
5501 today.
5502 @end example
5503
5504 You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
5505 task---just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
5506
5507 An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task
5508 subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command @kbd{C-c C-x c} was
5509 created for this purpose, it is described in @ref{Structure editing}.
5510
5511
5512 @node Clocking work time, Resolving idle time, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
5513 @section Clocking work time
5514
5515 Org-mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a
5516 project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock.
5517 When you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the
5518 clock is stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It
5519 also computes the total time spent on each subtree of a project. And it
5520 remembers a history or tasks recently clocked, to that you can jump quickly
5521 between a number of tasks absorbing your time.
5522
5523 To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use
5524 @lisp
5525 (setq org-clock-persist 'history)
5526 (org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
5527 @end lisp
5528 When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
5529 clock@footnote{To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked
5530 on this task while outside Emacs, use @code{(setq org-clock-persist t)}.}
5531 will be found (@pxref{Resolving idle time}) and you will be prompted about
5532 what to do with it.
5533
5534 @table @kbd
5535 @kindex C-c C-x C-i
5536 @item C-c C-x C-i
5537 @vindex org-clock-into-drawer
5538 Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
5539 keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
5540 this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
5541 @code{:LOGBOOK:} drawer (see also the variable
5542 @code{org-clock-into-drawer}). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
5543 select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
5544 C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task.
5545 The default task will always be available when selecting a clocking task,
5546 with letter @kbd{d}.@*
5547 @cindex property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL
5548 @cindex property: LAST_REPEAT
5549 @vindex org-clock-modeline-total
5550 While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in the mode
5551 line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown will be all
5552 time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort
5553 estimate (@pxref{Effort estimates}), the mode line displays the current
5554 clocking time against it@footnote{To add an effort estimate ``on the fly'',
5555 hook a function doing this to @code{org-clock-in-prepare-hook}.} If the task
5556 is a repeating one (@pxref{Repeated tasks}), only the time since the last
5557 reset of the task @footnote{as recorded by the @code{LAST_REPEAT} property}
5558 will be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised with
5559 the @code{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL} property. It may have the values
5560 @code{current} to show only the current clocking instance, @code{today} to
5561 show all time clocked on this tasks today (see also the variable
5562 @code{org-extend-today-until}), @code{all} to include all time, or
5563 @code{auto} which is the default@footnote{See also the variable
5564 @code{org-clock-modeline-total}.}.@* Clicking with @kbd{mouse-1} onto the
5565 mode line entry will pop up a menu with clocking options.
5566 @kindex C-c C-x C-o
5567 @item C-c C-x C-o
5568 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
5569 Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same
5570 location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
5571 the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
5572 HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
5573 possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
5574 timestamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
5575 @code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
5576 @kindex C-c C-x C-e
5577 @item C-c C-x C-e
5578 Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
5579 @kindex C-c C-y
5580 @kindex C-c C-c
5581 @item C-c C-y @ @ @r{or}@ @ C-c C-c
5582 Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This
5583 is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change
5584 them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
5585 @kindex C-c C-t
5586 @item C-c C-t
5587 Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
5588 if it is running in this same item.
5589 @kindex C-c C-x C-x
5590 @item C-c C-x C-x
5591 Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
5592 mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
5593 @kindex C-c C-x C-j
5594 @item C-c C-x C-j
5595 Jump to the entry that contains the currently running clock. With a
5596 @kbd{C-u} prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked
5597 tasks.
5598 @kindex C-c C-x C-d
5599 @item C-c C-x C-d
5600 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
5601 Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This
5602 puts overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time
5603 recorded under that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You
5604 can use visibility cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear
5605 when you change the buffer (see variable
5606 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press @kbd{C-c C-c}.
5607 @kindex C-c C-x C-r
5608 @item C-c C-x C-r
5609 Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
5610 report as an Org-mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
5611 at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
5612 argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
5613 update it.
5614 @cindex #+BEGIN, clocktable
5615 @example
5616 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
5617 #+END: clocktable
5618 @end example
5619 @noindent
5620 If such a block already exists at point, its content is replaced by the
5621 new table. The @samp{BEGIN} line can specify options:
5622 @example
5623 :maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
5624 :emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items.}
5625 :scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
5626 nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
5627 file @r{the full current buffer}
5628 subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
5629 tree@var{N} @r{the surrounding level @var{N} tree, for example @code{tree3}}
5630 tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
5631 agenda @r{all agenda files}
5632 ("file"..) @r{scan these files}
5633 file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
5634 agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
5635 :block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
5636 @r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
5637 @r{these formats:}
5638 2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
5639 2007-12 @r{December 2007}
5640 2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
5641 2007 @r{the year 2007}
5642 today, yesterday, today-@var{N} @r{a relative day}
5643 thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-@var{N} @r{a relative week}
5644 thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-@var{N} @r{a relative month}
5645 thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-@var{N} @r{a relative year}
5646 @r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
5647 :tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times.}
5648 :tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times.}
5649 :step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
5650 @r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
5651 :stepskip0 @r{Don't show steps that have zero time}
5652 :tags @r{A tags match to select entries that should contribute}
5653 :link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.}
5654 :formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
5655 @r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds a column with % time.}
5656 @r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula.}
5657 @r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
5658 :timestamp @r{A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED,}
5659 @r{DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order.}
5660 @end example
5661 To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
5662 day, you could write
5663 @example
5664 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
5665 #+END: clocktable
5666 @end example
5667 @noindent
5668 and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
5669 parameters must be specified in a single line---the line is broken here
5670 only to fit it into the manual.}
5671 @example
5672 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
5673 :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
5674 #+END: clocktable
5675 @end example
5676 A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
5677 @example
5678 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
5679 #+END: clocktable
5680 @end example
5681 @kindex C-c C-c
5682 @item C-c C-c
5683 @kindex C-c C-x C-u
5684 @itemx C-c C-x C-u
5685 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5686 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5687 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u
5688 @item C-u C-c C-x C-u
5689 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5690 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
5691 @kindex S-@key{left}
5692 @kindex S-@key{right}
5693 @item S-@key{left}
5694 @itemx S-@key{right}
5695 Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
5696 needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
5697 @code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
5698 @end table
5699
5700 The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
5701 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
5702 worked on or closed during a day.
5703
5704 @node Resolving idle time, Effort estimates, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
5705 @section Resolving idle time
5706 @cindex resolve idle time
5707
5708 @cindex idle, resolve, dangling
5709 If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
5710 computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to ``resolve'' the
5711 time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or
5712 applying it to another one.
5713
5714 @vindex org-clock-idle-time
5715 By customizing the variable @code{org-clock-idle-time} to some integer, such
5716 as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after
5717 being idle for that many minutes@footnote{On computers using Mac OS X,
5718 idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For
5719 X11, you can install a utility program @file{x11idle.c}, available in the
5720 UTILITIES directory of the Org git distribution, to get the same general
5721 treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs idle time
5722 only.}, and ask what you want to do with the idle time. There will be a
5723 question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how much idle time has
5724 passed (constantly updated with the current amount), as well as a set of
5725 choices to correct the discrepancy:
5726
5727 @table @kbd
5728 @item k
5729 To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press @kbd{k}. Org
5730 will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press @key{RET} to keep them all,
5731 effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes.
5732 @item K
5733 If you use the shift key and press @kbd{K}, it will keep however many minutes
5734 you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of
5735 the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task.
5736 @item s
5737 To keep none of the minutes, use @kbd{s} to subtract all the away time from
5738 the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned.
5739 @item S
5740 To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time,
5741 use the shift key and press @kbd{S}. Remember that using shift will always
5742 leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose.
5743 @item C
5744 To cancel the clock altogether, use @kbd{C}. Note that if instead of
5745 canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less
5746 than a minute, the clock will still be canceled rather than clutter up the
5747 log with an empty entry.
5748 @end table
5749
5750 What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now
5751 want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately
5752 after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time ``on
5753 the books'', so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to
5754 the next task you clock in on.
5755
5756 There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you
5757 were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who
5758 scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly
5759 lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org
5760 mode changes, including your last clock in.
5761
5762 If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a
5763 dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using
5764 that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period,
5765 Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is
5766 identical to dealing with away time due to idleness, it's just happening due
5767 to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time.
5768
5769 You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling
5770 clocks at any time using @kbd{M-x org-resolve-clocks}.
5771
5772 @node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Resolving idle time, Dates and Times
5773 @section Effort estimates
5774 @cindex effort estimates
5775
5776 @cindex property, Effort
5777 @vindex org-effort-property
5778 If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
5779 produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
5780 assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
5781 may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
5782 great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
5783 special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
5784 used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. You can set the effort
5785 for an entry with the following commands:
5786
5787 @table @kbd
5788 @kindex C-c C-x e
5789 @item C-c C-x e
5790 Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric prefix
5791 argument, set it to the NTH allowed value (see below). This command is also
5792 accessible from the agenda with the @kbd{e} key.
5793 @kindex C-c C-x C-e
5794 @item C-c C-x C-e
5795 Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
5796 @end table
5797
5798 Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view
5799 (@pxref{Column view}). You should start by setting up discrete values for
5800 effort estimates, and a @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values
5801 together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For a specific
5802 buffer you can use
5803
5804 @example
5805 #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00 8:00
5806 #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
5807 @end example
5808
5809 @noindent
5810 @vindex org-global-properties
5811 @vindex org-columns-default-format
5812 or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
5813 variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
5814 In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
5815 setup may be advised.
5816
5817 The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
5818 mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
5819 value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
5820 In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
5821
5822 @vindex org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum
5823 If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
5824 will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
5825 the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
5826 column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
5827 an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
5828 option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
5829 appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
5830 then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
5831
5832 Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
5833 with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
5834 these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
5835 down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
5836
5837 @node Relative timer, , Effort estimates, Dates and Times
5838 @section Taking notes with a relative timer
5839 @cindex relative timer
5840
5841 When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
5842 be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
5843 such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
5844
5845 @table @kbd
5846 @kindex C-c C-x .
5847 @item C-c C-x .
5848 Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
5849 timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
5850 restarted.
5851 @kindex C-c C-x -
5852 @item C-c C-x -
5853 Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
5854 argument, first reset the timer to 0.
5855 @kindex M-@key{RET}
5856 @item M-@key{RET}
5857 Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
5858 new timer items.
5859 @kindex C-c C-x ,
5860 @item C-c C-x ,
5861 Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused.
5862 @c removed the sentence because it is redundant to the following item
5863 @kindex C-u C-c C-x ,
5864 @item C-u C-c C-x ,
5865 Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
5866 old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
5867 @kindex C-c C-x 0
5868 @item C-c C-x 0
5869 Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
5870 timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
5871 specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
5872 default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
5873 restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
5874 prefix argument @kbd{C-u C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
5875 by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
5876 not started at exactly the right moment.
5877 @end table
5878
5879 @node Capture - Refile - Archive, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
5880 @chapter Capture - Refile - Archive
5881 @cindex capture
5882
5883 An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
5884 capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
5885 Org does this using a process called @i{capture}. It also can store files
5886 related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory. Once in the
5887 system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving completed project
5888 trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and fast.
5889
5890 @menu
5891 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
5892 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
5893 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
5894 * Protocols:: External (e.g. Browser) access to Emacs and Org
5895 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
5896 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
5897 @end menu
5898
5899 @node Capture, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive, Capture - Refile - Archive
5900 @section Capture
5901 @cindex capture
5902
5903 Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by John Wiegley
5904 excellent remember package. Up to version 6.36 Org used a special setup
5905 for @file{remember.el}. @file{org-remember.el} is still part of Org-mode for
5906 backward compatibility with existing setups. You can find the documentation
5907 for org-remember at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-remember.pdf}.
5908
5909 The new capturing setup described here is preferred and should be used by new
5910 users. To convert your @code{org-remember-templates}, run the command
5911 @example
5912 @kbd{M-x org-capture-import-remember-templates @key{RET}}
5913 @end example
5914 @noindent and then customize the new variable with @kbd{M-x
5915 customize-variable org-capture-templates}, check the result, and save the
5916 customization. You can then use both remember and capture until
5917 you are familiar with the new mechanism.
5918
5919 Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your work
5920 flow. The basic process of capturing is very similar to remember, but Org
5921 does enhance it with templates and more.
5922
5923 @menu
5924 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
5925 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
5926 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
5927 @end menu
5928
5929 @node Setting up capture, Using capture, Capture, Capture
5930 @subsection Setting up capture
5931
5932 The following customization sets a default target file for notes, and defines
5933 a global key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c c} is only a
5934 suggestion.} for capturing new material.
5935
5936 @example
5937 (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
5938 (define-key global-map "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
5939 @end example
5940
5941 @node Using capture, Capture templates, Setting up capture, Capture
5942 @subsection Using capture
5943
5944 @table @kbd
5945 @kindex C-c c
5946 @item C-c c
5947 Call the command @code{org-capture}. If you have templates defined
5948 @pxref{Capture templates}, it will offer these templates for selection or use
5949 a new Org outline node as the default template. It will insert the template
5950 into the target file and switch to an indirect buffer narrowed to this new
5951 node. You may then insert the information you want.
5952
5953 @kindex C-c C-c
5954 @item C-c C-c
5955 Once you have finished entering information into the capture buffer,
5956 @kbd{C-c C-c} will return you to the window configuration before the capture
5957 process, so that you can resume your work without further distraction.
5958
5959 @kindex C-c C-w
5960 @item C-c C-w
5961 Finalize the capture process by refiling (@pxref{Refiling notes}) the note to
5962 a different place.
5963
5964 @kindex C-c C-k
5965 @item C-c C-k
5966 Abort the capture process and return to the previous state.
5967 @end table
5968
5969 You can also call @code{org-capture} in a special way from the agenda, using
5970 the @kbd{k c} key combination. With this access, any timestamps inserted by
5971 the selected capture template will default to the cursor date in the agenda,
5972 rather than to the current date.
5973
5974 @node Capture templates, , Using capture, Capture
5975 @subsection Capture templates
5976 @cindex templates, for Capture
5977
5978 You can use templates for different types of capture items, and
5979 for different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is
5980 through the customize interface.
5981
5982 @table @kbd
5983 @kindex C-c c C
5984 @item C-c c C
5985 Customize the variable @code{org-capture-templates}.
5986 @end table
5987
5988 Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's look at
5989 an example. Say you would like to use one template to create general TODO
5990 entries, and you want to put these entries under the heading @samp{Tasks} in
5991 your file @file{~/org/gtd.org}. Also, a date tree in the file
5992 @file{journal.org} should capture journal entries. A possible configuration
5993 would look like:
5994
5995 @example
5996 (setq org-capture-templates
5997 '(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks")
5998 "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a")
5999 ("j" "Journal" entry (file+datetree "~/org/journal.org")
6000 "* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a")))
6001 @end example
6002
6003 @noindent If you then press @kbd{C-c c t}, Org will prepare the template
6004 for you like this:
6005 @example
6006 * TODO
6007 [[file:@var{link to where you initiated capture}]]
6008 @end example
6009
6010 @noindent
6011 During expansion of the template, @code{%a} has been replaced by a link to
6012 the location from where you called the capture command. This can be
6013 extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill in
6014 the task definition, press @code{C-c C-c} and Org returns you to the same
6015 place where you started the capture process.
6016
6017
6018 @menu
6019 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
6020 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
6021 @end menu
6022
6023 @node Template elements, Template expansion, Capture templates, Capture templates
6024 @subsubsection Template elements
6025
6026 Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in
6027 @code{org-capture-templates} is a list with the following items:
6028
6029 @table @var
6030 @item keys
6031 The keys that will select the template, as a string, characters
6032 only, for example @code{"a"} for a template to be selected with a
6033 single key, or @code{"bt"} for selection with two keys. When using
6034 several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential
6035 in the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the
6036 prefix key, for example
6037 @example
6038 ("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy")
6039 @end example
6040 @noindent If you do not define a template for the @kbd{C} key, this key will
6041 be used to open the customize buffer for this complex variable.
6042
6043 @item description
6044 A short string describing the template, which will be shown during
6045 selection.
6046
6047 @item type
6048 The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are:
6049 @table @code
6050 @item entry
6051 An Org-mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child of the
6052 target entry or as a top-level entry. The target file should be an Org-mode
6053 file.
6054 @item item
6055 A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the target
6056 location. Again the target file should be an Org file.
6057 @item checkitem
6058 A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item by the
6059 default template.
6060 @item table-line
6061 a new line in the first table at the target location. Where exactly the
6062 line will be inserted depends on the properties @code{:prepend} and
6063 @code{:table-line-pos} (see below).
6064 @item plain
6065 Text to be inserted as it is.
6066 @end table
6067
6068 @item target
6069 Specification of where the captured item should be placed.
6070 In Org-mode files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become
6071 children of this node, other types will be added to the table or list in the
6072 body of this node.
6073
6074 Valid values are:
6075 @table @code
6076 @item (file "path/to/file")
6077 Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file.
6078
6079 @item (id "id of existing org entry")
6080 Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry.
6081
6082 @item (file+headline "path/to/file" "node headline")
6083 Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the file.
6084
6085 @item (file+olp "path/to/file" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)
6086 For non-unique headings, the full path is safer.
6087
6088 @item (file+regexp "path/to/file" "regexp to find location")
6089 Use a regular expression to position the cursor.
6090
6091 @item (file+datetree "path/to/file")
6092 Will create a heading in a date tree.
6093
6094 @item (file+function "path/to/file" function-finding-location)
6095 A function to find the right location in the file.
6096
6097 @item (clock)
6098 File to the entry that is currently being clocked.
6099
6100 @item (function function-finding-location)
6101 Most general way, write your own function to find both
6102 file and location.
6103 @end table
6104
6105 @item template
6106 The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this empty, an
6107 appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise this is a string with
6108 escape codes, which will be replaced depending on time and context of the
6109 capture call. The string with escapes may be loaded from a template file,
6110 using the special syntax @code{(file "path/to/template")}. See below for
6111 more details.
6112
6113 @item properties
6114 The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options.
6115 Recognized properties are:
6116 @table @code
6117 @item :prepend
6118 Normally new captured information will be appended at
6119 the target location (last child, last table line, last list item...).
6120 Setting this property will change that.
6121
6122 @item :immediate-finish
6123 When set, do not offer to edit the information, just
6124 file it away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs
6125 information that can be added automatically.
6126
6127 @item :empty-lines
6128 Set this to the number of lines to insert
6129 before and after the new item. Default 0, only common other value is 1.
6130
6131 @item :clock-in
6132 Start the clock in this item.
6133
6134 @item :clock-resume
6135 If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that clock when finished
6136 with the capture.
6137
6138 @item :unnarrowed
6139 Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. Default is to
6140 narrow it so that you only see the new material.
6141 @end table
6142 @end table
6143
6144 @node Template expansion, , Template elements, Capture templates
6145 @subsubsection Template expansion
6146
6147 In the template itself, special @kbd{%}-escapes@footnote{If you need one of
6148 these sequences literally, escape the @kbd{%} with a backslash.} allow
6149 dynamic insertion of content:
6150
6151 @comment SJE: should these sentences terminate in period?
6152 @smallexample
6153 %^@{@var{prompt}@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
6154 @r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
6155 @r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}}
6156 @r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
6157 %a @r{annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}}
6158 %A @r{like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part}
6159 %i @r{initial content, the region when capture is called while the}
6160 @r{region is active.}
6161 @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
6162 %t @r{timestamp, date only}
6163 %T @r{timestamp with date and time}
6164 %u, %U @r{like the above, but inactive timestamps}
6165 %^t @r{like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}}
6166 @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}}
6167 %n @r{user name (taken from @code{user-full-name})}
6168 %c @r{Current kill ring head.}
6169 %x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
6170 %^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
6171 %^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
6172 %k @r{title of the currently clocked task}
6173 %K @r{link to the currently clocked task}
6174 %^g @r{prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
6175 %^G @r{prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
6176 %^@{@var{prop}@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @var{prop}}
6177 %:keyword @r{specific information for certain link types, see below}
6178 %[@var{file}] @r{insert the contents of the file given by @var{file}}
6179 %(@var{sexp}) @r{evaluate Elisp @var{sexp} and replace with the result}
6180 @end smallexample
6181
6182 @noindent
6183 For specific link types, the following keywords will be
6184 defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
6185 hyperlink types}), any property you store with
6186 @code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in capture templates in a
6187 similar way.}:
6188
6189 @vindex org-from-is-user-regexp
6190 @smallexample
6191 Link type | Available keywords
6192 -------------------+----------------------------------------------
6193 bbdb | %:name %:company
6194 bbdb | %::server %:port %:nick
6195 vm, wl, mh, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
6196 | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
6197 | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
6198 | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
6199 gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
6200 w3, w3m | %:url
6201 info | %:file %:node
6202 calendar | %:date
6203 @end smallexample
6204
6205 @noindent
6206 To place the cursor after template expansion use:
6207
6208 @smallexample
6209 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6210 @end smallexample
6211
6212
6213 @node Attachments, RSS Feeds, Capture, Capture - Refile - Archive
6214 @section Attachments
6215 @cindex attachments
6216
6217 @vindex org-attach-directory
6218 It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
6219 Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
6220 Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can establish associations with
6221 files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
6222 source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
6223 which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
6224 uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
6225 located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
6226 your Org file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org files from one
6227 directory to another, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
6228 to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
6229 @code{git init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
6230 The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
6231
6232 In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a directory of your
6233 choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment
6234 directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached
6235 directory.
6236
6237 @noindent The following commands deal with attachments:
6238
6239 @table @kbd
6240
6241 @kindex C-c C-a
6242 @item C-c C-a
6243 The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
6244 keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must press an additional key
6245 to select a command:
6246
6247 @table @kbd
6248 @kindex C-c C-a a
6249 @item a
6250 @vindex org-attach-method
6251 Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
6252 will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
6253 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6254
6255 @kindex C-c C-a c
6256 @kindex C-c C-a m
6257 @kindex C-c C-a l
6258 @item c/m/l
6259 Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
6260 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6261
6262 @kindex C-c C-a n
6263 @item n
6264 Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
6265
6266 @kindex C-c C-a z
6267 @item z
6268 Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
6269 attachments yourself.
6270
6271 @kindex C-c C-a o
6272 @item o
6273 @vindex org-file-apps
6274 Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one, prompt for a
6275 file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
6276 For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks
6277 (@pxref{Handling links}).
6278
6279 @kindex C-c C-a O
6280 @item O
6281 Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
6282
6283 @kindex C-c C-a f
6284 @item f
6285 Open the current task's attachment directory.
6286
6287 @kindex C-c C-a F
6288 @item F
6289 Also open the directory, but force using @command{dired} in Emacs.
6290
6291 @kindex C-c C-a d
6292 @item d
6293 Select and delete a single attachment.
6294
6295 @kindex C-c C-a D
6296 @item D
6297 Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
6298 @command{dired} and delete from there.
6299
6300 @kindex C-c C-a s
6301 @item C-c C-a s
6302 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR
6303 Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by
6304 putting the directory path into the @code{ATTACH_DIR} property.
6305
6306 @kindex C-c C-a i
6307 @item C-c C-a i
6308 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT
6309 Set the @code{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT} property, so that children will use the
6310 same directory for attachments as the parent does.
6311 @end table
6312 @end table
6313
6314 @node RSS Feeds, Protocols, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive
6315 @section RSS feeds
6316 @cindex RSS feeds
6317 @cindex Atom feeds
6318
6319 Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds and
6320 Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a
6321 podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the
6322 web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, configure the variable
6323 @code{org-feed-alist}. The docstring of this variable has detailed
6324 information. Here is just an example:
6325
6326 @example
6327 (setq org-feed-alist
6328 '(("Slashdot"
6329 "http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot"
6330 "~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries")))
6331 @end example
6332
6333 @noindent
6334 will configure that new items from the feed provided by
6335 @code{rss.slashdot.org} will result in new entries in the file
6336 @file{~/org/feeds.org} under the heading @samp{Slashdot Entries}, whenever
6337 the following command is used:
6338
6339 @table @kbd
6340 @kindex C-c C-x g
6341 @item C-c C-x g
6342 Collect items from the feeds configured in @code{org-feed-alist} and act upon
6343 them.
6344 @kindex C-c C-x G
6345 @item C-c C-x G
6346 Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed.
6347 @end table
6348
6349 Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer @samp{FEEDSTATUS} in which
6350 it will store information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid
6351 adding the same item several times. You should add @samp{FEEDSTATUS} to the
6352 list of drawers in that file:
6353
6354 @example
6355 #+DRAWERS: LOGBOOK PROPERTIES FEEDSTATUS
6356 @end example
6357
6358 For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see
6359 @file{org-feed.el} and the docstring of @code{org-feed-alist}.
6360
6361 @node Protocols, Refiling notes, RSS Feeds, Capture - Refile - Archive
6362 @section Protocols for external access
6363 @cindex protocols, for external access
6364 @cindex emacsserver
6365
6366 You can set up Org for handling protocol calls from outside applications that
6367 are passed to Emacs through the @file{emacsserver}. For example, you can
6368 configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to
6369 Org and create a note from it using capture (@pxref{Capture}). Or you
6370 could create a bookmark that will tell Emacs to open the local source file of
6371 a remote website you are looking at with the browser. See
6372 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.php} for detailed
6373 documentation and setup instructions.
6374
6375 @node Refiling notes, Archiving, Protocols, Capture - Refile - Archive
6376 @section Refiling notes
6377 @cindex refiling notes
6378
6379 When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile some of the entries
6380 into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting, finding the
6381 right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To simplify this
6382 process, you can use the following special command:
6383
6384 @table @kbd
6385 @kindex C-c C-w
6386 @item C-c C-w
6387 @vindex org-reverse-note-order
6388 @vindex org-refile-targets
6389 @vindex org-refile-use-outline-path
6390 @vindex org-outline-path-complete-in-steps
6391 @vindex org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes
6392 @vindex org-log-refile
6393 @vindex org-refile-use-cache
6394 Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
6395 for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
6396 all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
6397 Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
6398 last subitem.@*
6399 By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
6400 targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
6401 See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
6402 select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
6403 the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
6404 @code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}. If you would like to be able to
6405 create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, check the
6406 variable @code{org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes}.
6407 When the variable @code{org-log-refile}@footnote{with corresponding
6408 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logrefile}, @code{lognoterefile},
6409 and @code{nologrefile}} is set, a time stamp or a note will be
6410 recorded when an entry has been refiled.
6411 @kindex C-u C-c C-w
6412 @item C-u C-c C-w
6413 Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
6414 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-w
6415 @item C-u C-u C-c C-w
6416 Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
6417 @item C-2 C-c C-w
6418 Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
6419 @item C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w
6420 Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned on by
6421 setting @code{org-refile-use-cache}. To make the command seen new possible
6422 targets, you have to clear the cache with this command.
6423 @end table
6424
6425 @node Archiving, , Refiling notes, Capture - Refile - Archive
6426 @section Archiving
6427 @cindex archiving
6428
6429 When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
6430 to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
6431 agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global
6432 searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
6433
6434 @table @kbd
6435 @kindex C-c C-x C-a
6436 @item C-c C-x C-a
6437 @vindex org-archive-default-command
6438 Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable
6439 @code{org-archive-default-command}.
6440 @end table
6441
6442 @menu
6443 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
6444 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
6445 @end menu
6446
6447 @node Moving subtrees, Internal archiving, Archiving, Archiving
6448 @subsection Moving a tree to the archive file
6449 @cindex external archiving
6450
6451 The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file,
6452 the archive file.
6453
6454 @table @kbd
6455 @kindex C-c $
6456 @kindex C-c C-x C-s
6457 @item C-c C-x C-s@ @r{or short} @ C-c $
6458 @vindex org-archive-location
6459 Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
6460 given by @code{org-archive-location}.
6461 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-s
6462 @item C-u C-c C-x C-s
6463 Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
6464 the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
6465 If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
6466 location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
6467 is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
6468 @end table
6469
6470 @cindex archive locations
6471 The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
6472 current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
6473 current file name. For information and examples on how to change this,
6474 see the documentation string of the variable
6475 @code{org-archive-location}. There is also an in-buffer option for
6476 setting this variable, for example@footnote{For backward compatibility,
6477 the following also works: If there are several such lines in a file,
6478 each specifies the archive location for the text below it. The first
6479 such line also applies to any text before its definition. However,
6480 using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible
6481 with the outline structure of the document. The correct method for
6482 setting multiple archive locations in a buffer is using properties.}:
6483
6484 @cindex #+ARCHIVE
6485 @example
6486 #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
6487 @end example
6488
6489 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
6490 @noindent
6491 If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
6492 or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
6493 location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
6494
6495 @vindex org-archive-save-context-info
6496 When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
6497 record context information like the file from where the entry came, its
6498 outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
6499 @code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
6500 added.
6501
6502
6503 @node Internal archiving, , Moving subtrees, Archiving
6504 @subsection Internal archiving
6505
6506 If you want to just switch off (for agenda views) certain subtrees without
6507 moving them to a different file, you can use the @code{ARCHIVE tag}.
6508
6509 A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
6510 its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
6511 @itemize @minus
6512 @item
6513 @vindex org-cycle-open-archived-trees
6514 It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
6515 command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
6516 subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
6517 @code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
6518 @code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
6519 @item
6520 @vindex org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees
6521 During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
6522 archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
6523 @code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
6524 @item
6525 @vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
6526 During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
6527 archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
6528 @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
6529 be included. In the agenda you can press @kbd{v a} to get archives
6530 temporarily included.
6531 @item
6532 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
6533 Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
6534 is. Configure the details using the variable
6535 @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
6536 @item
6537 @vindex org-columns-skip-archived-trees
6538 Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
6539 @code{org-columns-skip-archived-trees} is configured to @code{nil}.
6540 @end itemize
6541
6542 The following commands help manage the ARCHIVE tag:
6543
6544 @table @kbd
6545 @kindex C-c C-x a
6546 @item C-c C-x a
6547 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
6548 the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
6549 hidden.
6550 @kindex C-u C-c C-x a
6551 @item C-u C-c C-x a
6552 Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
6553 To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
6554 found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
6555 cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
6556 level 1 trees will be checked.
6557 @kindex C-@kbd{TAB}
6558 @item C-@kbd{TAB}
6559 Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
6560 @kindex C-c C-x A
6561 @item C-c C-x A
6562 Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
6563 the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}. The
6564 entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its
6565 original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the
6566 outline.
6567 @end table
6568
6569
6570 @node Agenda Views, Markup, Capture - Refile - Archive, Top
6571 @chapter Agenda views
6572 @cindex agenda views
6573
6574 Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
6575 tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
6576 files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
6577 important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
6578 sorted and displayed in an organized way.
6579
6580 Org can select items based on various criteria and display them
6581 in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
6582
6583 @itemize @bullet
6584 @item
6585 an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
6586 for specific dates,
6587 @item
6588 a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
6589 action items,
6590 @item
6591 a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and
6592 TODO state associated with them,
6593 @item
6594 a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
6595 in time-sorted view,
6596 @item
6597 a @emph{text search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
6598 that contain specified keywords,
6599 @item
6600 a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
6601 along, and
6602 @item
6603 @emph{custom views} that are special searches and combinations of different
6604 views.
6605 @end itemize
6606
6607 @noindent
6608 The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
6609 buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
6610 corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
6611 edit these files remotely.
6612
6613 @vindex org-agenda-window-setup
6614 @vindex org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit
6615 Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
6616 window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
6617 @code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
6618 @code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
6619
6620 @menu
6621 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
6622 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
6623 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
6624 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
6625 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
6626 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
6627 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
6628 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
6629 @end menu
6630
6631 @node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
6632 @section Agenda files
6633 @cindex agenda files
6634 @cindex files for agenda
6635
6636 @vindex org-agenda-files
6637 The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
6638 files}, the files listed in the variable
6639 @code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
6640 list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
6641 maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
6642 all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
6643 of the list.
6644
6645 Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
6646 be put into the list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
6647 @kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
6648 the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
6649 dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
6650 the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
6651
6652 @cindex files, adding to agenda list
6653 @table @kbd
6654 @kindex C-c [
6655 @item C-c [
6656 Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
6657 the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
6658 the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
6659 @kindex C-c ]
6660 @item C-c ]
6661 Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
6662 @kindex C-,
6663 @kindex C-'
6664 @item C-,
6665 @itemx C-'
6666 Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
6667 @kindex M-x org-iswitchb
6668 @item M-x org-iswitchb
6669 Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
6670 buffers.
6671 @end table
6672
6673 @noindent
6674 The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
6675 to visit any of them.
6676
6677 If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
6678 this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a
6679 file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
6680 you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
6681 (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
6682 extended period, use the following commands:
6683
6684 @table @kbd
6685 @kindex C-c C-x <
6686 @item C-c C-x <
6687 Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
6688 prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
6689 the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
6690 effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
6691 or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
6692 agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
6693 @kindex C-c C-x >
6694 @item C-c C-x >
6695 Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
6696 @end table
6697
6698 @noindent
6699 When working with @file{speedbar.el}, you can use the following commands in
6700 the Speedbar frame:
6701 @table @kbd
6702 @kindex <
6703 @item < @r{in the speedbar frame}
6704 Permanently restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree
6705 in such a file---at the cursor in the Speedbar frame.
6706 If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
6707 effect immediately.
6708 @kindex >
6709 @item > @r{in the speedbar frame}
6710 Lift the restriction.
6711 @end table
6712
6713 @node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
6714 @section The agenda dispatcher
6715 @cindex agenda dispatcher
6716 @cindex dispatching agenda commands
6717 The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a
6718 global key---for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Installation}). In the
6719 following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
6720 is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
6721 pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
6722 command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
6723 @table @kbd
6724 @item a
6725 Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
6726 @item t @r{/} T
6727 Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
6728 @item m @r{/} M
6729 Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
6730 tags and properties}).
6731 @item L
6732 Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
6733 @item s
6734 Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
6735 and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
6736 @item /
6737 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
6738 Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
6739 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. This
6740 uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
6741 used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
6742 1.
6743 @item # @r{/} !
6744 Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
6745 @item <
6746 Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
6747 compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
6748 buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
6749 selecting the command.
6750 @item < <
6751 If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
6752 the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
6753 backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
6754 current region/subtree.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
6755 character selecting the command.
6756 @end table
6757
6758 You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
6759 dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
6760 possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
6761 blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
6762 a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
6763
6764 @node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
6765 @section The built-in agenda views
6766
6767 In this section we describe the built-in views.
6768
6769 @menu
6770 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
6771 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
6772 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
6773 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
6774 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
6775 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
6776 @end menu
6777
6778 @node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
6779 @subsection The weekly/daily agenda
6780 @cindex agenda
6781 @cindex weekly agenda
6782 @cindex daily agenda
6783
6784 The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
6785 paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
6786
6787 @table @kbd
6788 @cindex org-agenda, command
6789 @kindex C-c a a
6790 @item C-c a a
6791 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
6792 Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda
6793 shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
6794 compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
6795 listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
6796 list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
6797 C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed (see also the
6798 variable @code{org-agenda-ndays})
6799 @end table
6800
6801 Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
6802 change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
6803 The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
6804 commands}.
6805
6806 @subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
6807 @cindex calendar integration
6808 @cindex diary integration
6809
6810 Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
6811 calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
6812 countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
6813 anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
6814 (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
6815 Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
6816 the diary.
6817
6818 In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org-mode's
6819 agenda, you only need to customize the variable
6820
6821 @lisp
6822 (setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
6823 @end lisp
6824
6825 @noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
6826 entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the
6827 agenda buffer created by Org-mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
6828 @key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
6829 file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
6830 insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
6831 well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
6832 Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
6833 calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
6834 between calendar and agenda.
6835
6836 If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
6837 faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
6838 the entries into an Org file. Org-mode evaluates diary-style sexp
6839 entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
6840 creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
6841 the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example,
6842 the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
6843 will be made in the agenda:
6844
6845 @example
6846 * Birthdays and similar stuff
6847 #+CATEGORY: Holiday
6848 %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
6849 #+CATEGORY: Ann
6850 %%(diary-anniversary 5 14 1956)@footnote{Note that the order of the arguments (month, day, year) depends on the setting of @code{calendar-date-style}.} Arthur Dent is %d years old
6851 %%(diary-anniversary 10 2 1869) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
6852 @end example
6853
6854 @subsubheading Anniversaries from BBDB
6855 @cindex BBDB, anniversaries
6856 @cindex anniversaries, from BBDB
6857
6858 If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you will
6859 very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a
6860 separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB
6861 anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the
6862 following to one your your agenda files:
6863
6864 @example
6865 * Anniversaries
6866 :PROPERTIES:
6867 :CATEGORY: Anniv
6868 :END:
6869 %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
6870 @end example
6871
6872 You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically,
6873 you need to press @kbd{C-o anniversary @key{RET}} with the cursor in a BBDB
6874 record and then add the date in the format @code{YYYY-MM-DD}, followed by a
6875 space and the class of the anniversary (@samp{birthday} or @samp{wedding}, or
6876 a format string). If you omit the class, it will default to @samp{birthday}.
6877 Here are a few examples, the header for the file @file{org-bbdb.el} contains
6878 more detailed information.
6879
6880 @example
6881 1973-06-22
6882 1955-08-02 wedding
6883 2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org-mode, %d years ago
6884 @end example
6885
6886 After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs
6887 session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org updates its
6888 hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast---much
6889 faster in fact than a long list of @samp{%%(diary-anniversary)} entries
6890 in an Org or Diary file.
6891
6892 @subsubheading Appointment reminders
6893 @cindex @file{appt.el}
6894 @cindex appointment reminders
6895
6896 Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add all
6897 the appointments of your agenda files, use the command
6898 @code{org-agenda-to-appt}. This command also lets you filter through the
6899 list of your appointments and add only those belonging to a specific category
6900 or matching a regular expression. See the docstring for details.
6901
6902 @node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
6903 @subsection The global TODO list
6904 @cindex global TODO list
6905 @cindex TODO list, global
6906
6907 The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
6908 collected into a single place.
6909
6910 @table @kbd
6911 @kindex C-c a t
6912 @item C-c a t
6913 Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all agenda
6914 files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. By default, this lists
6915 items with a state the is not a DONE state. The buffer is in
6916 @code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate the TODO
6917 entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
6918 @kindex C-c a T
6919 @item C-c a T
6920 @cindex TODO keyword matching
6921 @vindex org-todo-keywords
6922 Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You can
6923 also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. You are
6924 prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several keywords by
6925 separating them with @samp{|} as the boolean OR operator. With a numeric
6926 prefix, the nth keyword in @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
6927 @kindex r
6928 The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
6929 a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
6930 for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
6931 keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
6932 Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
6933 search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
6934 @end table
6935
6936 Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
6937 TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
6938 TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
6939
6940 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
6941 Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
6942 keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
6943 it more compact:
6944 @itemize @minus
6945 @item
6946 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled
6947 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines
6948 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date
6949 Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for execution or
6950 have a @emph{deadline} (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}.
6951 Configure the variables @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled},
6952 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines}, and/or
6953 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date} to exclude such items from the
6954 global TODO list.
6955 @item
6956 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
6957 TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
6958 such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
6959 and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
6960 @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
6961 @end itemize
6962
6963 @node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
6964 @subsection Matching tags and properties
6965 @cindex matching, of tags
6966 @cindex matching, of properties
6967 @cindex tags view
6968 @cindex match view
6969
6970 If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} (@pxref{Tags}),
6971 or have properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), you can select headlines
6972 based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match
6973 syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with @kbd{C-c /
6974 m}.
6975
6976 @table @kbd
6977 @kindex C-c a m
6978 @item C-c a m
6979 Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
6980 command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
6981 expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
6982 @samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
6983 define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
6984 @kindex C-c a M
6985 @item C-c a M
6986 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
6987 @vindex org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options
6988 Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items in a
6989 not-DONE state and force checking subitems (see variable
6990 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). To exclude scheduled/deadline items,
6991 see the variable @code{org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options}. Matching
6992 specific TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see
6993 @ref{Tag searches}.
6994 @end table
6995
6996 The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
6997 commands}.
6998
6999 @subsubheading Match syntax
7000
7001 @cindex Boolean logic, for tag/property searches
7002 A search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and @samp{|} for
7003 OR. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}. Parentheses are currently
7004 not implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular
7005 expression matching tags, or an expression like @code{PROPERTY OPERATOR
7006 VALUE} with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each element
7007 may be preceded by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic
7008 sugar for positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when
7009 @samp{+} or @samp{-} is present. Here are some examples, using only tags.
7010
7011 @table @samp
7012 @item +work-boss
7013 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
7014 @samp{:boss:}.
7015 @item work|laptop
7016 Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
7017 @item work|laptop+night
7018 Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
7019 @samp{:night:}.
7020 @end table
7021
7022 @cindex regular expressions, with tags search
7023 Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly
7024 braces. For example,
7025 @samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
7026 @samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}.
7027
7028 @cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
7029 @cindex level, require for tags/property match
7030 @cindex category, require for tags/property match
7031 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
7032 You may also test for properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same
7033 time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special
7034 properties that represent other metadata (@pxref{Special properties}). For
7035 example, the ``property'' @code{TODO} represents the TODO keyword of the
7036 entry. Or, the ``property'' @code{LEVEL} represents the level of an entry.
7037 So a search @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"} lists all level three headlines
7038 that have the tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword
7039 DONE. In buffers with @code{org-odd-levels-only} set, @samp{LEVEL} does not
7040 count the number of stars, but @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars etc.
7041
7042 Here are more examples:
7043 @table @samp
7044 @item work+TODO="WAITING"
7045 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
7046 keyword @samp{WAITING}.
7047 @item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
7048 Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
7049 @end table
7050
7051 When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test
7052 the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
7053
7054 @example
7055 +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
7056 +With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
7057 @end example
7058
7059 @noindent
7060 The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
7061 @itemize @minus
7062 @item
7063 If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
7064 and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
7065 @samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
7066 @item
7067 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes,
7068 a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
7069 @item
7070 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes @emph{and} angular
7071 brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
7072 assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
7073 comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
7074 are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
7075 @code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e. without a time
7076 specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
7077 @code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
7078 respectively, can be used.
7079 @item
7080 If the comparison value is enclosed
7081 in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
7082 regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
7083 match.
7084 @end itemize
7085
7086 So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
7087 not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
7088 @samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
7089 property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
7090 matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
7091 on or after October 11, 2008.
7092
7093 Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
7094 other properties will slow down the search. However, once you have paid the
7095 price by accessing one property, testing additional properties is cheap
7096 again.
7097
7098 You can configure Org-mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
7099 beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
7100 inheritance}, for details.
7101
7102 For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a
7103 different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the
7104 tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms
7105 connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then specify a Boolean
7106 expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for
7107 tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive selection on
7108 several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with boolean AND.
7109 However, @emph{negative selection} combined with AND can be meaningful. To
7110 make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any TODO keyword
7111 (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M}, or equivalently start the TODO
7112 part after the slash with @samp{!}. Using @kbd{C-c a M} or @samp{/!} will
7113 not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples:
7114
7115 @table @samp
7116 @item work/WAITING
7117 Same as @samp{work+TODO="WAITING"}
7118 @item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
7119 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
7120 nor @samp{NEXT}
7121 @item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
7122 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
7123 @samp{NEXT}.
7124 @end table
7125
7126 @node Timeline, Search view, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
7127 @subsection Timeline for a single file
7128 @cindex timeline, single file
7129 @cindex time-sorted view
7130
7131 The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org-mode
7132 file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
7133 to give an overview over events in a project.
7134
7135 @table @kbd
7136 @kindex C-c a L
7137 @item C-c a L
7138 Show a time-sorted view of the Org file, with all time-stamped items.
7139 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
7140 (scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
7141 @end table
7142
7143 @noindent
7144 The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
7145 @ref{Agenda commands}.
7146
7147 @node Search view, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
7148 @subsection Search view
7149 @cindex search view
7150 @cindex text search
7151 @cindex searching, for text
7152
7153 This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org-mode entries.
7154 It is particularly useful to find notes.
7155
7156 @table @kbd
7157 @kindex C-c a s
7158 @item C-c a s
7159 This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring
7160 or specific words using a boolean logic.
7161 @end table
7162 For example, the search string @samp{computer equipment} will find entries
7163 that contain @samp{computer equipment} as a substring. If the two words are
7164 separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match.
7165 Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean
7166 logic. The search string @samp{+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}}
7167 will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
7168 and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
7169 not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
7170 exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first @samp{+} is necessary to turn on
7171 word search, other @samp{+} characters are optional. For more details, see
7172 the docstring of the command @code{org-search-view}.
7173
7174 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7175 Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
7176 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
7177
7178 @node Stuck projects, , Search view, Built-in agenda views
7179 @subsection Stuck projects
7180
7181 If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
7182 work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
7183 that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
7184 has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
7185 Org-mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
7186 projects and define next actions for them.
7187
7188 @table @kbd
7189 @kindex C-c a #
7190 @item C-c a #
7191 List projects that are stuck.
7192 @kindex C-c a !
7193 @item C-c a !
7194 @vindex org-stuck-projects
7195 Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
7196 project is and how to find it.
7197 @end table
7198
7199 You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
7200 work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
7201 level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
7202 one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
7203
7204 Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org-mode, identify
7205 projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
7206 indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
7207 assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
7208 and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
7209 is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
7210 contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
7211 either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
7212 with a tags/todo match@footnote{@xref{Tag searches}.}
7213 @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and
7214 IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The
7215 correct customization for this is
7216
7217 @lisp
7218 (setq org-stuck-projects
7219 '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
7220 "\\<IGNORE\\>"))
7221 @end lisp
7222
7223 Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry
7224 will still be searched for stuck projects.
7225
7226 @node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
7227 @section Presentation and sorting
7228 @cindex presentation, of agenda items
7229
7230 @vindex org-agenda-prefix-format
7231 Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org-mode visually prepares
7232 the items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line
7233 starts with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category}
7234 (@pxref{Categories}) of the item and other important information. You can
7235 customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
7236 The prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
7237 associated with the item.
7238
7239 @menu
7240 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
7241 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
7242 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
7243 @end menu
7244
7245 @node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
7246 @subsection Categories
7247
7248 @cindex category
7249 The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
7250 the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
7251 specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
7252 backward compatibility, the following also works: if there are several
7253 such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
7254 The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
7255 line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
7256 incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
7257 method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
7258 property.}:
7259
7260 @example
7261 #+CATEGORY: Thesis
7262 @end example
7263
7264 @noindent
7265 @cindex property, CATEGORY
7266 If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
7267 (sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the
7268 special category you want to apply as the value.
7269
7270 @noindent
7271 The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
7272 longer than 10 characters.
7273
7274 @node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
7275 @subsection Time-of-day specifications
7276 @cindex time-of-day specification
7277
7278 Org-mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
7279 time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
7280 agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
7281 ranges can be specified with two timestamps, like
7282 @c
7283 @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
7284
7285 In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
7286 plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
7287 integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
7288 specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
7289
7290 For agenda display, Org-mode extracts the time and displays it in a
7291 standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
7292 the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
7293
7294 @example
7295 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7296 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7297 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7298 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7299 @end example
7300
7301 @cindex time grid
7302 If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
7303 timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
7304
7305 @example
7306 8:00...... ------------------
7307 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7308 10:00...... ------------------
7309 12:00...... ------------------
7310 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7311 14:00...... ------------------
7312 16:00...... ------------------
7313 18:00...... ------------------
7314 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7315 20:00...... ------------------
7316 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7317 @end example
7318
7319 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
7320 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
7321 The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
7322 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
7323 @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
7324
7325 @node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
7326 @subsection Sorting of agenda items
7327 @cindex sorting, of agenda items
7328 @cindex priorities, of agenda items
7329 Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
7330 done depends on the type of view.
7331 @itemize @bullet
7332 @item
7333 @vindex org-agenda-files
7334 For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
7335 default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
7336 time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
7337 of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
7338 grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
7339 Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
7340 which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
7341 for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
7342 overdue scheduled or deadline items.
7343 @item
7344 For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
7345 each category, sorting takes place according to priority
7346 (@pxref{Priorities}). The priority used for sorting derives from the
7347 priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due
7348 or scheduled date.
7349 @item
7350 For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
7351 sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
7352 @end itemize
7353
7354 @vindex org-agenda-sorting-strategy
7355 Sorting can be customized using the variable
7356 @code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
7357 the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
7358
7359 @node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
7360 @section Commands in the agenda buffer
7361 @cindex commands, in agenda buffer
7362
7363 Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
7364 file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
7365 buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
7366 original entry location, and to edit the Org files ``remotely'' from
7367 the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
7368 removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
7369
7370 Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
7371 the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
7372
7373 @table @kbd
7374 @tsubheading{Motion}
7375 @cindex motion commands in agenda
7376 @kindex n
7377 @item n
7378 Next line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
7379 @kindex p
7380 @item p
7381 Previous line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
7382 @tsubheading{View/Go to Org file}
7383 @kindex mouse-3
7384 @kindex @key{SPC}
7385 @item mouse-3
7386 @itemx @key{SPC}
7387 Display the original location of the item in another window.
7388 With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
7389 outline, not only the heading.
7390 @c
7391 @kindex L
7392 @item L
7393 Display original location and recenter that window.
7394 @c
7395 @kindex mouse-2
7396 @kindex mouse-1
7397 @kindex @key{TAB}
7398 @item mouse-2
7399 @itemx mouse-1
7400 @itemx @key{TAB}
7401 Go to the original location of the item in another window. Under Emacs
7402 22, @kbd{mouse-1} will also works for this.
7403 @c
7404 @kindex @key{RET}
7405 @itemx @key{RET}
7406 Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
7407 @c
7408 @kindex F
7409 @item F
7410 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode
7411 Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
7412 the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
7413 location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
7414 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
7415 @code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
7416 @c
7417 @kindex C-c C-x b
7418 @item C-c C-x b
7419 Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
7420 numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
7421 negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
7422 previously used indirect buffer.
7423
7424 @kindex C-c C-o
7425 @item C-c C-o
7426 Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any links in the
7427 text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, it
7428 will be followed without a selection prompt.
7429
7430 @tsubheading{Change display}
7431 @cindex display changing, in agenda
7432 @kindex o
7433 @item o
7434 Delete other windows.
7435 @c
7436 @kindex v d
7437 @kindex d
7438 @kindex v w
7439 @kindex w
7440 @kindex v m
7441 @kindex v y
7442 @item v d @ @r{or short} @ d
7443 @itemx v w @ @r{or short} @ w
7444 @itemx v m
7445 @itemx v y
7446 Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view,
7447 this setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda commands. Since
7448 month and year views are slow to create, they do not become the default.
7449 A numeric prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day
7450 of the year, ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example,
7451 @kbd{32 d} jumps to February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When
7452 setting day, week, or month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix
7453 argument as well. For example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in
7454 2007. If such a year specification has only one or two digits, it will
7455 be mapped to the interval 1938-2037.
7456 @c
7457 @kindex f
7458 @item f
7459 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
7460 Go forward in time to display the following @code{org-agenda-ndays} days.
7461 For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week.
7462 With prefix arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-ndays} days.
7463 @c
7464 @kindex b
7465 @item b
7466 Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
7467 @c
7468 @kindex .
7469 @item .
7470 Go to today.
7471 @c
7472 @kindex j
7473 @item j
7474 Prompt for a date and go there.
7475 @c
7476 @kindex D
7477 @item D
7478 Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
7479 @c
7480 @kindex v l
7481 @kindex v L
7482 @kindex l
7483 @item v l @ @r{or short} @ l
7484 @vindex org-log-done
7485 @vindex org-agenda-log-mode-items
7486 Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while
7487 logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
7488 entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
7489 types that should be included in log mode using the variable
7490 @code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
7491 all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
7492 prefix args @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
7493 @kbd{v L} is equivalent to @kbd{C-u v l}.
7494 @c
7495 @kindex v [
7496 @kindex [
7497 @item v [ @ @r{or short} @ [
7498 Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily
7499 agenda and timeline views.
7500 @c
7501 @kindex v a
7502 @kindex v A
7503 @item v a
7504 @itemx v A
7505 Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked
7506 @code{ARCHIVED} are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you use the
7507 capital @kbd{A}, even all archive files are included. To exit archives mode,
7508 press @kbd{v a} again.
7509 @c
7510 @kindex v R
7511 @kindex R
7512 @item v R @ @r{or short} @ R
7513 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode
7514 Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
7515 always show a table with the clocked times for the timespan and file scope
7516 covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
7517 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
7518 @code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}.
7519 @c
7520 @kindex v E
7521 @kindex E
7522 @item v E @ @r{or short} @ E
7523 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode
7524 @vindex org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines
7525 Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org
7526 outline node referenced by an agenda line will be displayed below the line.
7527 The maximum number of lines is given by the variable
7528 @code{org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines}. Calling this command with a numeric
7529 prefix argument will temporarily modify that number to the prefix value.
7530 @c
7531 @kindex G
7532 @item G
7533 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
7534 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
7535 Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
7536 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
7537 @c
7538 @kindex r
7539 @item r
7540 Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after
7541 modification of the timestamps of items with @kbd{S-@key{left}} and
7542 @kbd{S-@key{right}}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
7543 argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
7544 keyword.
7545 @kindex g
7546 @item g
7547 Same as @kbd{r}.
7548 @c
7549 @kindex s
7550 @kindex C-x C-s
7551 @item s
7552 @itemx C-x C-s
7553 Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of
7554 IDs.
7555 @c
7556 @kindex C-c C-x C-c
7557 @item C-c C-x C-c
7558 @vindex org-columns-default-format
7559 Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
7560 view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
7561 point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
7562 that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
7563 @code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
7564 @code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
7565
7566 @kindex C-c C-x >
7567 @item C-c C-x >
7568 Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a
7569 file or subtree (@pxref{Agenda files}).
7570
7571 @tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
7572 @cindex filtering, by tag and effort, in agenda
7573 @cindex tag filtering, in agenda
7574 @cindex effort filtering, in agenda
7575 @cindex query editing, in agenda
7576
7577 @kindex /
7578 @item /
7579 @vindex org-agenda-filter-preset
7580 Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
7581 The difference between this and a custom agenda command is that filtering is
7582 very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without
7583 having to recreate the agenda@footnote{Custom commands can preset a filter by
7584 binding the variable @code{org-agenda-filter-preset} as an option. This
7585 filter will then be applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through
7586 refreshes and more secondary filtering.}
7587
7588 You will be prompted for a tag selection letter, SPC will mean any tag at
7589 all. Pressing @key{TAB} at that prompt will offer use completion to select a
7590 tag (including any tags that do not have a selection character). The command
7591 then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag. When called
7592 with prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second
7593 @kbd{/} at the prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries.
7594 If the first key you press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter
7595 will be narrowed by requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag.
7596 Instead of pressing @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also
7597 immediately use the @kbd{\} command.
7598
7599 @vindex org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high
7600 In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set-up allowed
7601 efforts globally, for example
7602 @lisp
7603 (setq org-global-properties
7604 '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
7605 @end lisp
7606 You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of
7607 @kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort
7608 estimate in your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value.
7609 The filter will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal,
7610 or larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0-9 are not used
7611 as fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit
7612 directly without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed. For
7613 application of the operator, entries without a defined effort will be treated
7614 according to the value of @code{org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high}. To filter
7615 for tasks without effort definition, press @kbd{?} as the operator.
7616
7617 Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the variable
7618 @code{org-agenda-auto-exclude-function} is set to a user-defined function,
7619 that function can decide which tags should be excluded from the agenda
7620 automatically. Once this is set, the @kbd{/} command then accepts @kbd{RET}
7621 as a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example, let's
7622 say you use a @code{Net} tag to identify tasks which need network access, an
7623 @code{Errand} tag for errands in town, and a @code{Call} tag for making phone
7624 calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the
7625 Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this:
7626
7627 @lisp
7628 @group
7629 (defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
7630 (and (cond
7631 ((string= tag "Net")
7632 (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
7633 "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
7634 ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
7635 (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
7636 (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
7637 (concat "-" tag)))
7638
7639 (setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
7640 @end group
7641 @end lisp
7642
7643 @kindex \
7644 @item \
7645 Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
7646 prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
7647 the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
7648 @kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
7649
7650 @kindex [
7651 @kindex ]
7652 @kindex @{
7653 @kindex @}
7654 @item [ ] @{ @}
7655 @table @i
7656 @item @r{in} search view
7657 add new search words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions
7658 (@kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will
7659 add a positive search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search
7660 term @i{must} occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a
7661 negative search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
7662 selected.
7663 @end table
7664
7665 @page
7666 @tsubheading{Remote editing}
7667 @cindex remote editing, from agenda
7668
7669 @item 0-9
7670 Digit argument.
7671 @c
7672 @cindex undoing remote-editing events
7673 @cindex remote editing, undo
7674 @kindex C-_
7675 @item C-_
7676 Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
7677 both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
7678 @c
7679 @kindex t
7680 @item t
7681 Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
7682 original org file.
7683 @c
7684 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
7685 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
7686 @item C-S-@key{right}@r{/}@key{left}
7687 Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords.
7688 @c
7689 @kindex C-k
7690 @item C-k
7691 @vindex org-agenda-confirm-kill
7692 Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
7693 to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
7694 is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
7695 variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
7696 @c
7697 @kindex C-c C-w
7698 @item C-c C-w
7699 Refile the entry at point.
7700 @c
7701 @kindex C-c C-x C-a
7702 @kindex a
7703 @item C-c C-x C-a @ @r{or short} @ a
7704 @vindex org-archive-default-command
7705 Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default
7706 archiving command set in @code{org-archive-default-command}. When using the
7707 @code{a} key, confirmation will be required.
7708 @c
7709 @kindex C-c C-x a
7710 @item C-c C-x a
7711 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
7712 @c
7713 @kindex C-c C-x A
7714 @item C-c C-x A
7715 Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{archive
7716 sibling}.
7717 @c
7718 @kindex $
7719 @kindex C-c C-x C-s
7720 @item C-c C-x C-s @ @r{or short} @ $
7721 Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
7722 entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
7723 different file.
7724 @c
7725 @kindex T
7726 @item T
7727 @vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
7728 Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
7729 turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
7730 tags of a headline occasionally.
7731 @c
7732 @kindex :
7733 @item :
7734 Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
7735 agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
7736 @c
7737 @kindex ,
7738 @item ,
7739 Set the priority for the current item. Org-mode prompts for the
7740 priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC}, the priority cookie
7741 is removed from the entry.
7742 @c
7743 @kindex P
7744 @item P
7745 Display weighted priority of current item.
7746 @c
7747 @kindex +
7748 @kindex S-@key{up}
7749 @item +
7750 @itemx S-@key{up}
7751 Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
7752 the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
7753 key for this.
7754 @c
7755 @kindex -
7756 @kindex S-@key{down}
7757 @item -
7758 @itemx S-@key{down}
7759 Decrease the priority of the current item.
7760 @c
7761 @kindex C-c C-z
7762 @kindex z
7763 @item z @ @r{or also} @ C-c C-z
7764 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
7765 Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then files to the
7766 same location where state change notes are put. Depending on
7767 @code{org-log-into-drawer}, this maybe inside a drawer.
7768 @c
7769 @kindex C-c C-a
7770 @item C-c C-a
7771 Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
7772 @c
7773 @kindex C-c C-s
7774 @item C-c C-s
7775 Schedule this item, with prefix arg remove the scheduling timestamp
7776 @c
7777 @kindex C-c C-d
7778 @item C-c C-d
7779 Set a deadline for this item, with prefix arg remove the deadline.
7780 @c
7781 @kindex k
7782 @item k
7783 Agenda actions, to set dates for selected items to the cursor date.
7784 This command also works in the calendar! The command prompts for an
7785 additional key:
7786 @example
7787 m @r{Mark the entry at point for action. You can also make entries}
7788 @r{in Org files with @kbd{C-c C-x C-k}.}
7789 d @r{Set the deadline of the marked entry to the date at point.}
7790 s @r{Schedule the marked entry at the date at point.}
7791 r @r{Call @code{org-capture} with the cursor date as default date.}
7792 @end example
7793 @noindent
7794 Press @kbd{r} afterward to refresh the agenda and see the effect of the
7795 command.
7796 @c
7797 @kindex S-@key{right}
7798 @item S-@key{right}
7799 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the
7800 future. With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For
7801 example, @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. With a
7802 @kbd{C-u} prefix, change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the
7803 command, it will continue to change hours even without the prefix arg. With
7804 a double @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix, do the same for changing minutes. The stamp
7805 is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly reflected
7806 in the agenda buffer. Use @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} to update the buffer.
7807 @c
7808 @kindex S-@key{left}
7809 @item S-@key{left}
7810 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
7811 into the past.
7812 @c
7813 @kindex >
7814 @item >
7815 Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key @kbd{>} has
7816 been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.} on my keyboard.
7817 @c
7818 @kindex I
7819 @item I
7820 Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
7821 is stopped first.
7822 @c
7823 @kindex O
7824 @item O
7825 Stop the previously started clock.
7826 @c
7827 @kindex X
7828 @item X
7829 Cancel the currently running clock.
7830
7831 @kindex J
7832 @item J
7833 Jump to the running clock in another window.
7834
7835 @tsubheading{Bulk remote editing selected entries}
7836 @cindex remote editing, bulk, from agenda
7837
7838 @kindex m
7839 @item m
7840 Mark the entry at point for bulk action.
7841
7842 @kindex u
7843 @item u
7844 Unmark entry for bulk action.
7845
7846 @kindex U
7847 @item U
7848 Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
7849
7850 @kindex B
7851 @item B
7852 Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will prompt for
7853 another key to select the action to be applied. The prefix arg to @kbd{B}
7854 will be passed through to the @kbd{s} and @kbd{d} commands, to bulk-remove
7855 these special timestamps.
7856 @example
7857 r @r{Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries}
7858 @r{will no longer be in the agenda, refresh (@kbd{g}) to bring them back.}
7859 $ @r{Archive all selected entries.}
7860 A @r{Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings.}
7861 t @r{Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and}
7862 @r{changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and}
7863 @r{suppressing logging notes (but not time stamps).}
7864 + @r{Add a tag to all selected entries.}
7865 - @r{Remove a tag from all selected entries.}
7866 s @r{Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates}
7867 @r{by a fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus}
7868 @r{at the prompt, for example @samp{++8d} or @samp{++2w}.}
7869 d @r{Set deadline to a specific date.}
7870 @end example
7871
7872
7873 @tsubheading{Calendar commands}
7874 @cindex calendar commands, from agenda
7875 @kindex c
7876 @item c
7877 Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
7878 @c
7879 @item c
7880 When in the calendar, compute and show the Org-mode agenda for the
7881 date at the cursor.
7882 @c
7883 @cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
7884 @kindex i
7885 @item i
7886 @vindex org-agenda-diary-file
7887 Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor and (for
7888 block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to the Emacs diary
7889 file@footnote{This file is parsed for the agenda when
7890 @code{org-agenda-include-diary} is set.}, in a way similar to the @kbd{i}
7891 command in the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where
7892 you can add the entry.
7893
7894 If you configure @code{org-agenda-diary-file} to point to an Org-mode file,
7895 Org will create entries (in org-mode syntax) in that file instead. Most
7896 entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it
7897 easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree will be
7898 built under an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, or else with years as
7899 top-level entries. Emacs will prompt you for the entry text - if you specify
7900 it, the entry will be created in @code{org-agenda-diary-file} without further
7901 interaction. If you directly press @key{RET} at the prompt without typing
7902 text, the target file will be shown in another window for you to finish the
7903 entry there. See also the @kbd{k r} command.
7904 @c
7905 @kindex M
7906 @item M
7907 Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
7908 @c
7909 @kindex S
7910 @item S
7911 Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
7912 with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar.
7913 @c
7914 @kindex C
7915 @item C
7916 Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
7917 calendars.
7918 @c
7919 @kindex H
7920 @item H
7921 Show holidays for three months around the cursor date.
7922
7923 @item M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
7924 Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
7925 This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
7926
7927 @tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
7928 @kindex C-x C-w
7929 @item C-x C-w
7930 @cindex exporting agenda views
7931 @cindex agenda views, exporting
7932 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
7933 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
7934 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
7935 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), PDF (extension @file{.pdf}),
7936 and plain text (any other extension). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix
7937 argument, immediately open the newly created file. Use the variable
7938 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
7939 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
7940
7941 @tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
7942 @kindex q
7943 @item q
7944 Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
7945 @c
7946 @kindex x
7947 @cindex agenda files, removing buffers
7948 @item x
7949 Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
7950 for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
7951 visit Org files will not be removed.
7952 @end table
7953
7954
7955 @node Custom agenda views, Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
7956 @section Custom agenda views
7957 @cindex custom agenda views
7958 @cindex agenda views, custom
7959
7960 Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
7961 frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
7962 agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
7963 dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
7964
7965 @menu
7966 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
7967 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
7968 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
7969 @end menu
7970
7971 @node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
7972 @subsection Storing searches
7973
7974 The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
7975 shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
7976 buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
7977 buffer).
7978 @kindex C-c a C
7979 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
7980 Custom commands are configured in the variable
7981 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
7982 example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with
7983 Emacs Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid
7984 search types:
7985
7986 @lisp
7987 @group
7988 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
7989 '(("w" todo "WAITING")
7990 ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
7991 ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
7992 ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
7993 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
7994 ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
7995 ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
7996 ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
7997 ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
7998 ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
7999 @end group
8000 @end lisp
8001
8002 @noindent
8003 The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
8004 after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
8005 Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
8006 similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
8007 first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
8008 prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
8009 inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
8010 parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
8011 expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
8012 therefore define:
8013
8014 @table @kbd
8015 @item C-c a w
8016 as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
8017 keyword
8018 @item C-c a W
8019 as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
8020 results as a sparse tree
8021 @item C-c a u
8022 as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
8023 @samp{:urgent:}
8024 @item C-c a v
8025 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
8026 headlines that are also TODO items
8027 @item C-c a U
8028 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
8029 displaying the result as a sparse tree
8030 @item C-c a f
8031 to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
8032 containing the word @samp{FIXME}
8033 @item C-c a h
8034 as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
8035 additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
8036 Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
8037 @end table
8038
8039 @node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
8040 @subsection Block agenda
8041 @cindex block agenda
8042 @cindex agenda, with block views
8043
8044 Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
8045 the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
8046 the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
8047 daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
8048 for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
8049 matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
8050 @code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
8051
8052 @lisp
8053 @group
8054 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8055 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8056 ((agenda "")
8057 (tags-todo "home")
8058 (tags "garden")))
8059 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8060 ((agenda "")
8061 (tags-todo "work")
8062 (tags "office")))))
8063 @end group
8064 @end lisp
8065
8066 @noindent
8067 This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
8068 you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
8069 your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
8070 @samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
8071 command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
8072
8073 @node Setting Options, , Block agenda, Custom agenda views
8074 @subsection Setting options for custom commands
8075 @cindex options, for custom agenda views
8076
8077 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8078 Org-mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
8079 and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
8080 commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
8081 some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
8082 options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
8083 right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
8084
8085 @lisp
8086 @group
8087 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8088 '(("w" todo "WAITING"
8089 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
8090 (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
8091 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
8092 ((org-show-following-heading nil)
8093 (org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
8094 ("N" search ""
8095 ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
8096 (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
8097 @end group
8098 @end lisp
8099
8100 @noindent
8101 Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
8102 priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
8103 instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
8104 @kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
8105 headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
8106 will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
8107 to only a single file.
8108
8109 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8110 For command sets creating a block agenda,
8111 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
8112 options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
8113 command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
8114 the set. The former are just added to the command entry, the latter
8115 must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
8116 agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
8117 for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
8118 the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
8119 @code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
8120
8121 @lisp
8122 @group
8123 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8124 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8125 ((agenda)
8126 (tags-todo "home")
8127 (tags "garden"
8128 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
8129 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
8130 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8131 ((agenda)
8132 (tags-todo "work")
8133 (tags "office")))))
8134 @end group
8135 @end lisp
8136
8137 As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
8138 When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it
8139 fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in
8140 this interface, the @emph{values} are just Lisp expressions. So if the
8141 value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
8142 yourself.
8143
8144
8145 @node Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda column view, Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
8146 @section Exporting Agenda Views
8147 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8148
8149 If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed
8150 version of some agenda views to carry around. Org-mode can export custom
8151 agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's
8152 @file{htmlize.el}.}, Postscript, PDF@footnote{To create PDF output, the
8153 ghostscript @file{ps2pdf} utility must be installed on the system. Selecting
8154 a PDF file with also create the postscript file.}, and iCalendar files. If
8155 you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
8156
8157 @table @kbd
8158 @kindex C-x C-w
8159 @item C-x C-w
8160 @cindex exporting agenda views
8161 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8162 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8163 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8164 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8165 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), iCalendar (extension
8166 @file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
8167 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8168 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export, for example
8169
8170 @vindex org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines
8171 @vindex htmlize-output-type
8172 @vindex ps-number-of-columns
8173 @vindex ps-landscape-mode
8174 @lisp
8175 (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
8176 '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8177 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8178 (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
8179 (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
8180 @end lisp
8181 @end table
8182
8183 If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
8184 any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
8185 @footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
8186 or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
8187 them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
8188 that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global
8189 TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
8190 Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
8191 as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
8192 or absolute.
8193
8194 @lisp
8195 @group
8196 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8197 '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
8198 ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
8199 ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8200 ((agenda "")
8201 (tags-todo "home")
8202 (tags "garden"))
8203 nil
8204 ("~/views/home.html"))
8205 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8206 ((agenda)
8207 (tags-todo "work")
8208 (tags "office"))
8209 nil
8210 ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
8211 @end group
8212 @end lisp
8213
8214 The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
8215 @file{.html}, Org-mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
8216 the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
8217 @file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
8218 Postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
8219 run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
8220 limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other
8221 extension produces a plain ASCII file.
8222
8223 The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
8224 commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
8225 Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
8226 files in one step:
8227
8228 @table @kbd
8229 @kindex C-c a e
8230 @item C-c a e
8231 Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
8232 them.
8233 @end table
8234
8235 You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
8236 set options for the export commands. For example:
8237
8238 @lisp
8239 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8240 '(("X" agenda ""
8241 ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8242 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8243 (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
8244 (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
8245 (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
8246 ("theagenda.ps"))))
8247 @end lisp
8248
8249 @noindent
8250 This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
8251 print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be cut
8252 in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
8253 the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
8254 instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
8255 to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
8256 black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
8257 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
8258 in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
8259
8260 @noindent
8261 From the command line you may also use
8262 @example
8263 emacs -f org-batch-store-agenda-views -kill
8264 @end example
8265 @noindent
8266 or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting depends on the
8267 system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.}
8268 @example
8269 emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
8270 org-agenda-ndays 30 \
8271 org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
8272 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
8273 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
8274 -kill
8275 @end example
8276 @noindent
8277 which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
8278 @file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with a 30-day
8279 extent.
8280
8281 You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
8282 processing by other programs. See @ref{Extracting agenda information}, for
8283 more information.
8284
8285
8286 @node Agenda column view, , Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda Views
8287 @section Using column view in the agenda
8288 @cindex column view, in agenda
8289 @cindex agenda, column view
8290
8291 Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
8292 properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
8293 quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
8294 collected by certain criteria.
8295
8296 @table @kbd
8297 @kindex C-c C-x C-c
8298 @item C-c C-x C-c
8299 Turn on column view in the agenda.
8300 @end table
8301
8302 To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
8303 entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
8304 This causes the following issues:
8305
8306 @enumerate
8307 @item
8308 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8309 @vindex org-overriding-columns-format
8310 Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
8311 entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
8312 may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
8313 Org first checks if the variable @code{org-overriding-columns-format} is
8314 currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
8315 the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
8316 does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in its file), it
8317 uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
8318 @item
8319 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
8320 If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
8321 turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
8322 make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
8323 also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
8324 values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
8325 cover a single day, in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
8326 vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
8327 example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
8328 same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and its @emph{child}). In these
8329 cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
8330 some values will count double.
8331 @item
8332 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
8333 the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
8334 the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
8335 current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
8336 a column listing the planned total effort for a task---one of the major
8337 applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
8338 clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
8339 the agenda).
8340 @end enumerate
8341
8342
8343 @node Markup, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
8344 @chapter Markup for rich export
8345
8346 When exporting Org-mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
8347 structure of the document as accurately as possible in the backend. Since
8348 export targets like HTML, La@TeX{}, or DocBook allow much richer formatting,
8349 Org-mode has rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This section
8350 summarizes the markup rules used in an Org-mode buffer.
8351
8352 @menu
8353 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
8354 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
8355 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
8356 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
8357 * Index entries:: Making an index
8358 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
8359 * Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
8360 @end menu
8361
8362 @node Structural markup elements, Images and tables, Markup, Markup
8363 @section Structural markup elements
8364
8365 @menu
8366 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
8367 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
8368 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
8369 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
8370 * Lists:: Lists
8371 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
8372 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
8373 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
8374 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
8375 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
8376 @end menu
8377
8378 @node Document title, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements, Structural markup elements
8379 @subheading Document title
8380 @cindex document title, markup rules
8381
8382 @noindent
8383 The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
8384
8385 @cindex #+TITLE
8386 @example
8387 #+TITLE: This is the title of the document
8388 @end example
8389
8390 @noindent
8391 If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first non-empty,
8392 non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or if you have
8393 turned off exporting of the text before the first headline (see below), the
8394 title will be the file name without extension.
8395
8396 @cindex property, EXPORT_TITLE
8397 If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the heading
8398 of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the subtree has a
8399 property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take precedence.
8400
8401 @node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Structural markup elements
8402 @subheading Headings and sections
8403 @cindex headings and sections, markup rules
8404
8405 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
8406 The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
8407 Structure}, forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
8408 However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
8409 tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
8410 levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
8411 switch globally by setting the variable @code{org-export-headline-levels}, or on a
8412 per-file basis with a line
8413
8414 @cindex #+OPTIONS
8415 @example
8416 #+OPTIONS: H:4
8417 @end example
8418
8419 @node Table of contents, Initial text, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements
8420 @subheading Table of contents
8421 @cindex table of contents, markup rules
8422
8423 @vindex org-export-with-toc
8424 The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
8425 of the file. If you would like to get it to a different location, insert the
8426 string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by itself at the desired
8427 location. The depth of the table of contents is by default the same as the
8428 number of headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number, or turn off
8429 the table of contents entirely, by configuring the variable
8430 @code{org-export-with-toc}, or on a per-file basis with a line like
8431
8432 @example
8433 #+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
8434 #+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
8435 @end example
8436
8437 @node Initial text, Lists, Table of contents, Structural markup elements
8438 @subheading Text before the first headline
8439 @cindex text before first headline, markup rules
8440 @cindex #+TEXT
8441
8442 Org-mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even uses
8443 the first line as the document title. The text will be fully marked up. If
8444 you need to include literal HTML, La@TeX{}, or DocBook code, use the special
8445 constructs described below in the sections for the individual exporters.
8446
8447 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
8448 Some people like to use the space before the first headline for setup and
8449 internal links and therefore would like to control the exported text before
8450 the first headline in a different way. You can do so by setting the variable
8451 @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{t}. On a per-file
8452 basis, you can get the same effect with @samp{#+OPTIONS: skip:t}.
8453
8454 @noindent
8455 If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
8456 @code{#+TEXT} construct:
8457
8458 @example
8459 #+OPTIONS: skip:t
8460 #+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
8461 #+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
8462 #+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the first headline
8463 @end example
8464
8465 @node Lists, Paragraphs, Initial text, Structural markup elements
8466 @subheading Lists
8467 @cindex lists, markup rules
8468
8469 Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists}, are translated to the backend's
8470 syntax for such lists. Most backends support unordered, ordered, and
8471 description lists.
8472
8473 @node Paragraphs, Footnote markup, Lists, Structural markup elements
8474 @subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
8475 @cindex paragraphs, markup rules
8476
8477 Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
8478 a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
8479
8480 To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
8481 can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
8482
8483 @cindex #+BEGIN_VERSE
8484 @example
8485 #+BEGIN_VERSE
8486 Great clouds overhead
8487 Tiny black birds rise and fall
8488 Snow covers Emacs
8489
8490 -- AlexSchroeder
8491 #+END_VERSE
8492 @end example
8493
8494 When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
8495 as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
8496 can include quotations in Org-mode documents like this:
8497
8498 @cindex #+BEGIN_QUOTE
8499 @example
8500 #+BEGIN_QUOTE
8501 Everything should be made as simple as possible,
8502 but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
8503 #+END_QUOTE
8504 @end example
8505
8506 If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
8507 @cindex #+BEGIN_CENTER
8508 @example
8509 #+BEGIN_CENTER
8510 Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
8511 but not any simpler
8512 #+END_CENTER
8513 @end example
8514
8515
8516 @node Footnote markup, Emphasis and monospace, Paragraphs, Structural markup elements
8517 @subheading Footnote markup
8518 @cindex footnotes, markup rules
8519 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
8520
8521 Footnotes defined in the way described in @ref{Footnotes}, will be exported by
8522 all backends. Org allows multiple references to the same note, and
8523 different backends support this to varying degrees.
8524
8525 @node Emphasis and monospace, Horizontal rules, Footnote markup, Structural markup elements
8526 @subheading Emphasis and monospace
8527
8528 @cindex underlined text, markup rules
8529 @cindex bold text, markup rules
8530 @cindex italic text, markup rules
8531 @cindex verbatim text, markup rules
8532 @cindex code text, markup rules
8533 @cindex strike-through text, markup rules
8534 You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
8535 and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
8536 in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org-mode specific
8537 syntax, it is exported verbatim.
8538
8539 @node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, Emphasis and monospace, Structural markup elements
8540 @subheading Horizontal rules
8541 @cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
8542 A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be
8543 exported as a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML).
8544
8545 @node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Structural markup elements
8546 @subheading Comment lines
8547 @cindex comment lines
8548 @cindex exporting, not
8549 @cindex #+BEGIN_COMMENT
8550
8551 Lines starting with @samp{#} in column zero are treated as comments and will
8552 never be exported. If you want an indented line to be treated as a comment,
8553 start it with @samp{#+ }. Also entire subtrees starting with the word
8554 @samp{COMMENT} will never be exported. Finally, regions surrounded by
8555 @samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT} ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will not be exported.
8556
8557 @table @kbd
8558 @kindex C-c ;
8559 @item C-c ;
8560 Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
8561 @end table
8562
8563
8564 @node Images and tables, Literal examples, Structural markup elements, Markup
8565 @section Images and Tables
8566
8567 @cindex tables, markup rules
8568 @cindex #+CAPTION
8569 @cindex #+LABEL
8570 Both the native Org-mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
8571 the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org-mode tables,
8572 the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
8573 lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign
8574 a caption and a label for cross references, and in the text you can refer to
8575 the object with @code{\ref@{tab:basic-data@}}:
8576
8577 @example
8578 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
8579 #+LABEL: tbl:basic-data
8580 | ... | ...|
8581 |-----|----|
8582 @end example
8583
8584 @cindex inlined images, markup rules
8585 Some backends (HTML, La@TeX{}, and DocBook) allow you to directly include
8586 images into the exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image
8587 files does not have a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}.
8588 If you wish to define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal
8589 cross references, make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede
8590 it with @code{#+CAPTION} and @code{#+LABEL} as follows:
8591
8592 @example
8593 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
8594 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
8595 [[./img/a.jpg]]
8596 @end example
8597
8598 You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
8599 backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for more
8600 information.
8601
8602
8603 @node Literal examples, Include files, Images and tables, Markup
8604 @section Literal examples
8605 @cindex literal examples, markup rules
8606 @cindex code line references, markup rules
8607
8608 You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
8609 markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
8610 for source code and similar examples.
8611 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
8612
8613 @example
8614 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
8615 Some example from a text file.
8616 #+END_EXAMPLE
8617 @end example
8618
8619 Note that such blocks may be @i{indented} in order to align nicely with
8620 indented text and in particular with plain list structure (@pxref{Plain
8621 lists}). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the
8622 example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
8623 whitespace before the colon:
8624
8625 @example
8626 Here is an example
8627 : Some example from a text file.
8628 @end example
8629
8630 @cindex formatting source code, markup rules
8631 If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
8632 that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
8633 look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{Currently this works for the
8634 HTML backend, and requires the @file{htmlize.el} package version 1.34 or
8635 later. It also works for LaTeX with the listings package, if you turn on the
8636 option @code{org-export-latex-listings} and make sure that the listings
8637 package is included by the LaTeX header.}. This is done with the @samp{src}
8638 block, where you also need to specify the name of the major mode that should
8639 be used to fontify the example:
8640 @cindex #+BEGIN_SRC
8641
8642 @example
8643 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
8644 (defun org-xor (a b)
8645 "Exclusive or."
8646 (if a (not b) b))
8647 #+END_SRC
8648 @end example
8649
8650 Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
8651 switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
8652 numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
8653 numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
8654 Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as
8655 targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]} (i.e. the reference name
8656 enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a
8657 link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of
8658 cool.
8659
8660 You can also add a @code{-r} switch which @i{removes} the labels from the
8661 source code@footnote{Adding @code{-k} to @code{-n -r} will @i{keep} the
8662 labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might
8663 be useful to explain those in an org-mode example code.}. With the @code{-n}
8664 switch, links to these references will be labeled by the line numbers from
8665 the code listing, otherwise links will use the labels with no parentheses.
8666 Here is an example:
8667
8668 @example
8669 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
8670 (save-excursion (ref:sc)
8671 (goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
8672 #+END_SRC
8673 In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
8674 jumps to point-min.
8675 @end example
8676
8677 @vindex org-coderef-label-format
8678 If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
8679 @code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
8680 -n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
8681
8682 HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas, @xref{Text
8683 areas in HTML export}.
8684
8685 @table @kbd
8686 @kindex C-c '
8687 @item C-c '
8688 Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
8689 switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by
8690 pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon exit, lines starting with @samp{*}
8691 or @samp{#} will get a comma prepended, to keep them from being interpreted
8692 by Org as outline nodes or special comments. These commas will be stripped
8693 for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and also for export.}, the edited version will
8694 then replace the old version in the Org buffer. Fixed-width regions
8695 (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space) will be edited
8696 using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select a different-mode with the
8697 variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.} to allow creating ASCII
8698 drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line will create a new
8699 fixed-width region.
8700 @kindex C-c l
8701 @item C-c l
8702 Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
8703 temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label, make sure
8704 that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
8705 formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
8706 label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
8707 @end table
8708
8709
8710 @node Include files, Index entries, Literal examples, Markup
8711 @section Include files
8712 @cindex include files, markup rules
8713
8714 During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
8715 include your @file{.emacs} file, you could use:
8716 @cindex #+INCLUDE
8717
8718 @example
8719 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
8720 @end example
8721 @noindent
8722 The optional second and third parameter are the markup (e.g. @samp{quote},
8723 @samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
8724 language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional, if it is not
8725 given, the text will be assumed to be in Org-mode format and will be
8726 processed normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
8727 parameters @code{:prefix1} and @code{:prefix} to specify prefixes for the
8728 first line and for each following line, as well as any options accepted by
8729 the selected markup. For example, to include a file as an item, use
8730
8731 @example
8732 #+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
8733 @end example
8734
8735 @table @kbd
8736 @kindex C-c '
8737 @item C-c '
8738 Visit the include file at point.
8739 @end table
8740
8741 @node Index entries, Macro replacement, Include files, Markup
8742 @section Index entries
8743 @cindex index entries, for publishing
8744
8745 You can specify entries that will be used for generating an index during
8746 publishing. This is done by lines starting with @code{#+INDEX}. An entry
8747 the contains an exclamation mark will create a sub item. See @ref{Generating
8748 an index} for more information.
8749
8750 @example
8751 * Curriculum Vitae
8752 #+INDEX: CV
8753 #+INDEX: Application!CV
8754 @end example
8755
8756
8757
8758
8759 @node Macro replacement, Embedded LaTeX, Index entries, Markup
8760 @section Macro replacement
8761 @cindex macro replacement, during export
8762 @cindex #+MACRO
8763
8764 You can define text snippets with
8765
8766 @example
8767 #+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments
8768 @end example
8769
8770 @noindent which can be referenced anywhere in the document (even in
8771 code examples) with @code{@{@{@{name(arg1,arg2)@}@}@}}. In addition to
8772 defined macros, @code{@{@{@{title@}@}@}}, @code{@{@{@{author@}@}@}}, etc.,
8773 will reference information set by the @code{#+TITLE:}, @code{#+AUTHOR:}, and
8774 similar lines. Also, @code{@{@{@{date(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} and
8775 @code{@{@{@{modification-time(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} refer to current date time
8776 and to the modification time of the file being exported, respectively.
8777 @var{FORMAT} should be a format string understood by
8778 @code{format-time-string}.
8779
8780 Macro expansion takes place during export, and some people use it to
8781 construct complex HTML code.
8782
8783
8784 @node Embedded LaTeX, , Macro replacement, Markup
8785 @section Embedded La@TeX{}
8786 @cindex @TeX{} interpretation
8787 @cindex La@TeX{} interpretation
8788
8789 Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. One
8790 exception, however, are scientific notes which need to be able to contain
8791 mathematical symbols and the occasional formula. La@TeX{}@footnote{La@TeX{}
8792 is a macro system based on Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the
8793 features described here as ``La@TeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for
8794 simplicity I am blurring this distinction.} is widely used to typeset
8795 scientific documents. Org-mode supports embedding La@TeX{} code into its
8796 files, because many academics are used to reading La@TeX{} source code, and
8797 because it can be readily processed into images for HTML production.
8798
8799 It is not necessary to mark La@TeX{} macros and code in any special way.
8800 If you observe a few conventions, Org-mode knows how to find it and what
8801 to do with it.
8802
8803 @menu
8804 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
8805 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
8806 * LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
8807 * Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
8808 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
8809 @end menu
8810
8811 @node Special symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX, Embedded LaTeX
8812 @subsection Special symbols
8813 @cindex math symbols
8814 @cindex special symbols
8815 @cindex @TeX{} macros
8816 @cindex La@TeX{} fragments, markup rules
8817 @cindex HTML entities
8818 @cindex La@TeX{} entities
8819
8820 You can use La@TeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha} to
8821 indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. Completion
8822 for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a few letters,
8823 and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. Unlike La@TeX{}
8824 code, Org-mode allows these macros to be present without surrounding math
8825 delimiters, for example:
8826
8827 @example
8828 Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
8829 @end example
8830
8831 @vindex org-entities
8832 During export, these symbols will be transformed into the native format of
8833 the exporter backend. Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as
8834 @code{&alpha;} in the HTML output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the La@TeX{}
8835 output. Similarly, @code{\nbsp} will become @code{&nbsp;} in HTML and
8836 @code{~} in La@TeX{}. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it
8837 like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
8838
8839 A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and
8840 La@TeX{}, see the variable @code{org-entities} for the complete list.
8841 @samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
8842 @samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
8843 different lengths or a compact set of dots.
8844
8845 If you would like to see entities displayed as utf8 characters, use the
8846 following command@footnote{You can turn this on by default by setting the
8847 variable @code{org-pretty-entities}, or on a per-file base with the
8848 @code{#+STARTUP} option @code{entitiespretty}.}:
8849
8850 @table @kbd
8851 @kindex C-c C-x \
8852 @item C-c C-x \
8853 Toggle display of entities as UTF8 characters. This does not change the
8854 buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it overlays the UTF8 character
8855 for display purposes only.
8856 @end table
8857
8858 @node Subscripts and superscripts, LaTeX fragments, Special symbols, Embedded LaTeX
8859 @subsection Subscripts and superscripts
8860 @cindex subscript
8861 @cindex superscript
8862
8863 Just like in La@TeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super-
8864 and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
8865 math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
8866 not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
8867 with curly braces. For example
8868
8869 @example
8870 The mass if the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
8871 the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
8872 @end example
8873
8874 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
8875 To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote @samp{^} and
8876 @samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\^} and @samp{\_}. If you write a text
8877 where the underscore is often used in a different context, Org's convention
8878 to always interpret these as subscripts can get in your way. Configure the
8879 variable @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts} to globally change this
8880 convention, or use, on a per-file basis:
8881
8882 @example
8883 #+OPTIONS: ^:@{@}
8884 @end example
8885
8886 @table @kbd
8887 @kindex C-c C-x \
8888 @item C-c C-x \
8889 In addition to showing entities as UTF8 characters, this command will also
8890 format sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way.
8891 @end table
8892
8893 @node LaTeX fragments, Previewing LaTeX fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX
8894 @subsection La@TeX{} fragments
8895 @cindex La@TeX{} fragments
8896
8897 @vindex org-format-latex-header
8898 With symbols, sub- and superscripts, HTML is pretty much at its end when
8899 it comes to representing mathematical formulas@footnote{Yes, there is
8900 MathML, but that is not yet fully supported by many browsers, and there
8901 is no decent converter for turning La@TeX{} or ASCII representations of
8902 formulas into MathML. So for the time being, converting formulas into
8903 images seems the way to go.}. More complex expressions need a dedicated
8904 formula processor. To this end, Org-mode can contain arbitrary La@TeX{}
8905 fragments. It provides commands to preview the typeset result of these
8906 fragments, and upon export to HTML, all fragments will be converted to
8907 images and inlined into the HTML document@footnote{The La@TeX{} export
8908 will not use images for displaying La@TeX{} fragments but include these
8909 fragments directly into the La@TeX{} code.}. For this to work you
8910 need to be on a system with a working La@TeX{} installation. You also
8911 need the @file{dvipng} program, available at
8912 @url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/}. The La@TeX{} header that
8913 will be used when processing a fragment can be configured with the
8914 variable @code{org-format-latex-header}.
8915
8916 La@TeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
8917 snippets will be identified as La@TeX{} source code:
8918 @itemize @bullet
8919 @item
8920 Environments of any kind. The only requirement is that the
8921 @code{\begin} statement appears on a new line, preceded by only
8922 whitespace.
8923 @item
8924 Text within the usual La@TeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
8925 currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
8926 math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
8927 directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
8928 and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash.
8929 For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use
8930 @samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
8931 @end itemize
8932
8933 @noindent For example:
8934
8935 @example
8936 \begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments,
8937 x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures
8938 \end@{equation@} % etc
8939
8940 If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
8941 either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
8942 @end example
8943
8944 @noindent
8945 @vindex org-format-latex-options
8946 If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
8947 can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
8948 ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the La@TeX{} converter.
8949
8950 @node Previewing LaTeX fragments, CDLaTeX mode, LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
8951 @subsection Previewing LaTeX fragments
8952 @cindex LaTeX fragments, preview
8953
8954 La@TeX{} fragments can be processed to produce preview images of the
8955 typeset expressions:
8956
8957 @table @kbd
8958 @kindex C-c C-x C-l
8959 @item C-c C-x C-l
8960 Produce a preview image of the La@TeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
8961 over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
8962 fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
8963 with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
8964 two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
8965 process the entire buffer.
8966 @kindex C-c C-c
8967 @item C-c C-c
8968 Remove the overlay preview images.
8969 @end table
8970
8971 @vindex org-format-latex-options
8972 You can customize the variable @code{org-format-latex-options} to influence
8973 some aspects of the preview. In particular, the @code{:scale} (and for HTML
8974 export, @code{:html-scale}) property can be used to adjust the size of the
8975 preview images.
8976
8977 During HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), all La@TeX{} fragments are
8978 converted into images and inlined into the document if the following
8979 setting is active:
8980
8981 @lisp
8982 (setq org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments t)
8983 @end lisp
8984
8985 @node CDLaTeX mode, , Previewing LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
8986 @subsection Using CDLa@TeX{} to enter math
8987 @cindex CDLa@TeX{}
8988
8989 CDLa@TeX{} mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
8990 major La@TeX{} mode like AUC@TeX{} in order to speed-up insertion of
8991 environments and math templates. Inside Org-mode, you can make use of
8992 some of the features of CDLa@TeX{} mode. You need to install
8993 @file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
8994 AUC@TeX{}) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
8995 Don't use CDLa@TeX{} mode itself under Org-mode, but use the light
8996 version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org-mode. Turn it
8997 on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all
8998 Org files with
8999
9000 @lisp
9001 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
9002 @end lisp
9003
9004 When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
9005 details see the documentation of CDLa@TeX{} mode):
9006 @itemize @bullet
9007 @kindex C-c @{
9008 @item
9009 Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
9010 @item
9011 @kindex @key{TAB}
9012 The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
9013 La@TeX{} fragment@footnote{Org-mode has a method to test if the cursor is
9014 inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
9015 @code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
9016 expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
9017 correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
9018 the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
9019 environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
9020 you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
9021 this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
9022 To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}.
9023 @item
9024 @kindex _
9025 @kindex ^
9026 @vindex cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts
9027 Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a La@TeX{} fragment will insert these
9028 characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
9029 out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
9030 macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
9031 @code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
9032 @item
9033 @kindex `
9034 Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
9035 macros, also outside La@TeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
9036 after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
9037 @item
9038 @kindex '
9039 Pressing the single-quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
9040 the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
9041 1.5 seconds after the backquote, a help window will pop up. Character
9042 modification will work only inside La@TeX{} fragments, outside the quote
9043 is normal.
9044 @end itemize
9045
9046 @node Exporting, Publishing, Markup, Top
9047 @chapter Exporting
9048 @cindex exporting
9049
9050 Org-mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
9051 printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and simple
9052 version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a notes file on
9053 the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for exchange with a
9054 broad range of other applications. La@TeX{} export lets you use Org-mode and
9055 its structured editing functions to easily create La@TeX{} files. DocBook
9056 export makes it possible to convert Org files to many other formats using
9057 DocBook tools. For project management you can create gantt and resource
9058 charts by using TaskJuggler export. To incorporate entries with associated
9059 times like deadlines or appointments into a desktop calendar program like
9060 iCal, Org-mode can also produce extracts in the iCalendar format. Currently
9061 Org-mode only supports export, not import of these different formats.
9062
9063 Org supports export of selected regions when @code{transient-mark-mode} is
9064 enabled (default in Emacs 23).
9065
9066 @menu
9067 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
9068 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
9069 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
9070 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
9071 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
9072 * LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to La@TeX{}, and processing to PDF
9073 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
9074 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
9075 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
9076 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
9077 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
9078 @end menu
9079
9080 @node Selective export, Export options, Exporting, Exporting
9081 @section Selective export
9082 @cindex export, selective by tags
9083
9084 @vindex org-export-select-tags
9085 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
9086 You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be exported,
9087 or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed by two variables:
9088 @code{org-export-select-tags} and @code{org-export-exclude-tags}.
9089
9090 Org first checks if any of the @emph{select} tags is present in the buffer.
9091 If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be excluded. If a
9092 selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above it will also be
9093 selected for export, but not the text below those headings.
9094
9095 @noindent
9096 If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected for
9097 export.
9098
9099 @noindent
9100 Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the @emph{exclude} tags will
9101 be removed from the export buffer.
9102
9103 @node Export options, The export dispatcher, Selective export, Exporting
9104 @section Export options
9105 @cindex options, for export
9106
9107 @cindex completion, of option keywords
9108 The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
9109 additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
9110 The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c
9111 C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
9112 correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion
9113 (@pxref{Completion}). For a summary of other in-buffer settings not
9114 specifically related to export, see @ref{In-buffer settings}.
9115 In particular, note that you can place commonly-used (export) options in
9116 a separate file which can be included using @code{#+SETUPFILE}.
9117
9118 @table @kbd
9119 @kindex C-c C-e t
9120 @item C-c C-e t
9121 Insert template with export options, see example below.
9122 @end table
9123
9124 @cindex #+TITLE
9125 @cindex #+AUTHOR
9126 @cindex #+DATE
9127 @cindex #+EMAIL
9128 @cindex #+DESCRIPTION
9129 @cindex #+KEYWORDS
9130 @cindex #+LANGUAGE
9131 @cindex #+TEXT
9132 @cindex #+OPTIONS
9133 @cindex #+BIND
9134 @cindex #+LINK_UP
9135 @cindex #+LINK_HOME
9136 @cindex #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS
9137 @cindex #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS
9138 @cindex #+XSLT
9139 @cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
9140 @vindex user-full-name
9141 @vindex user-mail-address
9142 @vindex org-export-default-language
9143 @example
9144 #+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
9145 #+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name})
9146 #+DATE: a date, fixed, of a format string for @code{format-time-string}
9147 #+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address})
9148 #+DESCRIPTION: the page description, e.g. for the XHTML meta tag
9149 #+KEYWORDS: the page keywords, e.g. for the XHTML meta tag
9150 #+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g. @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language})
9151 #+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
9152 #+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
9153 #+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
9154 #+BIND: lisp-var lisp-val, e.g.: org-export-latex-low-levels itemize
9155 @r{You need to confirm using these, or configure @code{org-export-allow-BIND}}
9156 #+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
9157 #+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
9158 #+LATEX_HEADER: extra line(s) for the LaTeX header, like \usepackage@{xyz@}
9159 #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
9160 #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
9161 #+XSLT: the XSLT stylesheet used by DocBook exporter to generate FO file
9162 @end example
9163
9164 @noindent
9165 The OPTIONS line is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure many options
9166 this way, you can use several OPTIONS lines.} form to specify export settings. Here
9167 you can:
9168 @cindex headline levels
9169 @cindex section-numbers
9170 @cindex table of contents
9171 @cindex line-break preservation
9172 @cindex quoted HTML tags
9173 @cindex fixed-width sections
9174 @cindex tables
9175 @cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts
9176 @cindex footnotes
9177 @cindex special strings
9178 @cindex emphasized text
9179 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9180 @cindex La@TeX{} fragments
9181 @cindex author info, in export
9182 @cindex time info, in export
9183 @example
9184 H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export}
9185 num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers}
9186 toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)}
9187 \n: @r{turn on/off line-break-preservation (DOES NOT WORK)}
9188 @@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags}
9189 :: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections}
9190 |: @r{turn on/off tables}
9191 ^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If}
9192 @r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but}
9193 @r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.}
9194 -: @r{turn on/off conversion of special strings.}
9195 f: @r{turn on/off footnotes like this[1].}
9196 todo: @r{turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text}
9197 pri: @r{turn on/off priority cookies}
9198 tags: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}}
9199 <: @r{turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES}
9200 *: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)}
9201 TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text}
9202 LaTeX: @r{turn on/off La@TeX{} fragments}
9203 skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading}
9204 author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file}
9205 email: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author email into exported file}
9206 creator: @r{turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file}
9207 timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file}
9208 d: @r{turn on/off inclusion of drawers}
9209 @end example
9210 @noindent
9211 These options take effect in both the HTML and La@TeX{} export, except
9212 for @code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX}, which are respectively @code{t} and
9213 @code{nil} for the La@TeX{} export.
9214
9215 When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with @kbd{C-c @@} before
9216 calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the file's export
9217 settings with properties @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, @code{EXPORT_TITLE},
9218 @code{EXPORT_TEXT}, @code{EXPORT_AUTHOR}, @code{EXPORT_DATE}, and
9219 @code{EXPORT_OPTIONS}.
9220
9221 @node The export dispatcher, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Export options, Exporting
9222 @section The export dispatcher
9223 @cindex dispatcher, for export commands
9224
9225 All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which is a
9226 prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the command.
9227 Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an active region that
9228 contains one outline tree, the first heading is used as document title and
9229 the subtrees are exported.
9230
9231 @table @kbd
9232 @kindex C-c C-e
9233 @item C-c C-e
9234 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9235 Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window
9236 listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing
9237 command. The prefix arg is passed through to the exporter. A double prefix
9238 @kbd{C-u C-u} causes most commands to be executed in the background, in a
9239 separate Emacs process@footnote{To make this behavior the default, customize
9240 the variable @code{org-export-run-in-background}.}.
9241 @kindex C-c C-e v
9242 @item C-c C-e v
9243 Like @kbd{C-c C-e}, but only export the text that is currently visible
9244 (i.e. not hidden by outline visibility).
9245 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-e
9246 @item C-u C-u C-c C-e
9247 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9248 Call an the exporter, but reverse the setting of
9249 @code{org-export-run-in-background}, i.e. request background processing if
9250 not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if set.
9251 @end table
9252
9253 @node ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, HTML export, The export dispatcher, Exporting
9254 @section ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export
9255 @cindex ASCII export
9256 @cindex Latin-1 export
9257 @cindex UTF-8 export
9258
9259 ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org-mode
9260 file, containing only plain ASCII. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export augment the file
9261 with special characters and symbols available in these encodings.
9262
9263 @cindex region, active
9264 @cindex active region
9265 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9266 @table @kbd
9267 @kindex C-c C-e a
9268 @item C-c C-e a
9269 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9270 Export as ASCII file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
9271 will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without
9272 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9273 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9274 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9275 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will
9276 become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an
9277 @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
9278 export.
9279 @kindex C-c C-e A
9280 @item C-c C-e A
9281 Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file.
9282 @kindex C-c C-e n
9283 @kindex C-c C-e N
9284 @item C-c C-e n @ @ @r{and} @ @ C-c C-e N
9285 Like the above commands, but use Latin-1 encoding.
9286 @kindex C-c C-e u
9287 @kindex C-c C-e U
9288 @item C-c C-e u @ @ @r{and} @ @ C-c C-e U
9289 Like the above commands, but use UTF-8 encoding.
9290 @kindex C-c C-e v a
9291 @kindex C-c C-e v n
9292 @kindex C-c C-e v u
9293 @item C-c C-e v a @ @ @r{and} @ @ C-c C-e v n @ @ @r{and} @ @ C-c C-e v u
9294 Export only the visible part of the document.
9295 @end table
9296
9297 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9298 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
9299 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
9300 will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur
9301 at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example,
9302
9303 @example
9304 @kbd{C-1 C-c C-e a}
9305 @end example
9306
9307 @noindent
9308 creates only top level headlines and does the rest as items. When
9309 headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
9310 the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
9311 the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation of
9312 the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve
9313 the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less
9314 indentation than the first, these are left alone.
9315
9316 @vindex org-export-ascii-links-to-notes
9317 Links will be exported in a footnote-like style, with the descriptive part in
9318 the text and the link in a note before the next heading. See the variable
9319 @code{org-export-ascii-links-to-notes} for details and other options.
9320
9321 @node HTML export, LaTeX and PDF export, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Exporting
9322 @section HTML export
9323 @cindex HTML export
9324
9325 Org-mode contains an HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
9326 HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
9327 language, but with additional support for tables.
9328
9329 @menu
9330 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
9331 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org-mode
9332 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
9333 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
9334 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
9335 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
9336 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
9337 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
9338 @end menu
9339
9340 @node HTML Export commands, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export, HTML export
9341 @subsection HTML export commands
9342
9343 @cindex region, active
9344 @cindex active region
9345 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9346 @table @kbd
9347 @kindex C-c C-e h
9348 @item C-c C-e h
9349 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9350 Export as HTML file @file{myfile.html}. For an Org file @file{myfile.org},
9351 the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
9352 without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9353 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9354 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9355 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
9356 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
9357 property, that name will be used for the export.
9358 @kindex C-c C-e b
9359 @item C-c C-e b
9360 Export as HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
9361 @kindex C-c C-e H
9362 @item C-c C-e H
9363 Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file.
9364 @kindex C-c C-e R
9365 @item C-c C-e R
9366 Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix argument, do
9367 not produce the file header and footer, but just the plain HTML section for
9368 the region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations.
9369 @kindex C-c C-e v h
9370 @kindex C-c C-e v b
9371 @kindex C-c C-e v H
9372 @kindex C-c C-e v R
9373 @item C-c C-e v h
9374 @item C-c C-e v b
9375 @item C-c C-e v H
9376 @item C-c C-e v R
9377 Export only the visible part of the document.
9378 @item M-x org-export-region-as-html
9379 Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was Org-mode
9380 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
9381 buffer.
9382 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML
9383 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org-mode syntax) by HTML
9384 code.
9385 @end table
9386
9387 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9388 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
9389 defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
9390 itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
9391 specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
9392
9393 @example
9394 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e b}
9395 @end example
9396
9397 @noindent
9398 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
9399
9400 @node Quoting HTML tags, Links in HTML export, HTML Export commands, HTML export
9401 @subsection Quoting HTML tags
9402
9403 Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{&lt;} and
9404 @samp{&gt;} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags
9405 which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in
9406 @samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for
9407 simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to
9408 the exported file use either
9409
9410 @cindex #+HTML
9411 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
9412 @example
9413 #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
9414 @end example
9415
9416 @noindent or
9417 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
9418
9419 @example
9420 #+BEGIN_HTML
9421 All lines between these markers are exported literally
9422 #+END_HTML
9423 @end example
9424
9425
9426 @node Links in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
9427 @subsection Links in HTML export
9428
9429 @cindex links, in HTML export
9430 @cindex internal links, in HTML export
9431 @cindex external links, in HTML export
9432 Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML. This
9433 includes automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
9434 targets}). Links to external files will still work if the target file is on
9435 the same @i{relative} path as the published Org file. Links to other
9436 @file{.org} files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
9437 that an HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same relative
9438 path. @samp{id:} links can then be used to jump to specific entries across
9439 files. For information related to linking files while publishing them to a
9440 publishing directory see @ref{Publishing links}.
9441
9442 If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
9443 @code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that will be added to the
9444 @code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{title}
9445 and @code{style} attributes for a link:
9446
9447 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
9448 @example
9449 #+ATTR_HTML: title="The Org-mode homepage" style="color:red;"
9450 [[http://orgmode.org]]
9451 @end example
9452
9453 @node Tables in HTML export, Images in HTML export, Links in HTML export, HTML export
9454 @subsection Tables
9455 @cindex tables, in HTML
9456 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
9457
9458 Org-mode tables are exported to HTML using the table tag defined in
9459 @code{org-export-html-table-tag}. The default setting makes tables without
9460 cell borders and frame. If you would like to change this for individual
9461 tables, place something like the following before the table:
9462
9463 @cindex #+CAPTION
9464 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
9465 @example
9466 #+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
9467 #+ATTR_HTML: border="2" rules="all" frame="all"
9468 @end example
9469
9470 @node Images in HTML export, Text areas in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, HTML export
9471 @subsection Images in HTML export
9472
9473 @cindex images, inline in HTML
9474 @cindex inlining images in HTML
9475 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
9476 HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
9477 it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
9478 default@footnote{But see the variable
9479 @code{org-export-html-inline-images}.}, images are inlined if a link does
9480 not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
9481 while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
9482 @samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
9483 itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
9484 image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
9485 image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
9486 will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
9487
9488 @example
9489 [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
9490 @end example
9491
9492 If you need to add attributes to an inlined image, use a @code{#+ATTR_HTML}.
9493 In the example below we specify the @code{alt} and @code{title} attributes to
9494 support text viewers and accessibility, and align it to the right.
9495
9496 @cindex #+CAPTION
9497 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
9498 @example
9499 #+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
9500 #+ATTR_HTML: alt="cat/spider image" title="Action!" align="right"
9501 [[./img/a.jpg]]
9502 @end example
9503
9504 @noindent
9505 and you could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
9506
9507 @node Text areas in HTML export, CSS support, Images in HTML export, HTML export
9508 @subsection Text areas in HTML export
9509
9510 @cindex text areas, in HTML
9511 An alternative way to publish literal code examples in HTML is to use text
9512 areas, where the example can even be edited before pasting it into an
9513 application. It is triggered by a @code{-t} switch at an @code{example} or
9514 @code{src} block. Using this switch disables any options for syntax and
9515 label highlighting, and line numbering, which may be present. You may also
9516 use @code{-h} and @code{-w} switches to specify the height and width of the
9517 text area, which default to the number of lines in the example, and 80,
9518 respectively. For example
9519
9520 @example
9521 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE -t -w 40
9522 (defun org-xor (a b)
9523 "Exclusive or."
9524 (if a (not b) b))
9525 #+END_EXAMPLE
9526 @end example
9527
9528
9529 @node CSS support, JavaScript support, Text areas in HTML export, HTML export
9530 @subsection CSS support
9531 @cindex CSS, for HTML export
9532 @cindex HTML export, CSS
9533
9534 @vindex org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix
9535 @vindex org-export-html-tag-class-prefix
9536 You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML exporter
9537 assigns the following special CSS classes@footnote{If the classes on TODO
9538 keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables
9539 @code{org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} and
9540 @code{org-export-html-tag-class-prefix} to make them unique.} to appropriate
9541 parts of the document---your style specifications may change these, in
9542 addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, tables, etc.
9543 @example
9544 p.author @r{author information, including email}
9545 p.date @r{publishing date}
9546 p.creator @r{creator info, about org-mode version}
9547 .title @r{document title}
9548 .todo @r{TODO keywords, all not-done states}
9549 .done @r{the DONE keywords, all stated the count as done}
9550 .WAITING @r{each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself}
9551 .timestamp @r{timestamp}
9552 .timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED}
9553 .timestamp-wrapper @r{span around keyword plus timestamp}
9554 .tag @r{tag in a headline}
9555 ._HOME @r{each tag uses itself as a class, "@@" replaced by "_"}
9556 .target @r{target for links}
9557 .linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
9558 .code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
9559 div.outline-N @r{div for outline level N (headline plus text))}
9560 div.outline-text-N @r{extra div for text at outline level N}
9561 .section-number-N @r{section number in headlines, different for each level}
9562 div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
9563 pre.src @r{formatted source code}
9564 pre.example @r{normal example}
9565 p.verse @r{verse paragraph}
9566 div.footnotes @r{footnote section headline}
9567 p.footnote @r{footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote}
9568 .footref @r{a footnote reference number (always a <sup>)}
9569 .footnum @r{footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>)}
9570 @end example
9571
9572 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
9573 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
9574 @vindex org-export-html-style
9575 @vindex org-export-html-extra
9576 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
9577 Each exported file contains a compact default style that defines these
9578 classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
9579 @code{org-export-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
9580 inclusion of these defaults off, customize
9581 @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}}. You may overwrite these
9582 settings, or add to them by using the variables @code{org-export-html-style}
9583 (for Org-wide settings) and @code{org-export-html-style-extra} (for more
9584 granular settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter variable
9585 individually for each file, you can use
9586
9587 @cindex #+STYLE
9588 @example
9589 #+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
9590 @end example
9591
9592 @noindent
9593 For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
9594 directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
9595 referring to an external file.
9596
9597 @c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
9598 @c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
9599
9600 @node JavaScript support, , CSS support, HTML export
9601 @subsection JavaScript supported display of web pages
9602
9603 @cindex Rose, Sebastian
9604 Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
9605 enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
9606 program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one
9607 is an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
9608 navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
9609 as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
9610 view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs. The
9611 script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can find
9612 the documentation for it at @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}.
9613 We host the script at our site, but if you use it a lot, you might
9614 not want to be dependent on @url{orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local
9615 copy on your own web server.
9616
9617 To use the script, you need to make sure that the @file{org-jsinfo.el} module
9618 gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try @kbd{M-x
9619 customize-variable @key{RET} org-modules @key{RET}} to convince yourself that
9620 this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the program is
9621 adding a single line to the Org file:
9622
9623 @cindex #+INFOJS_OPT
9624 @example
9625 #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
9626 @end example
9627
9628 @noindent
9629 If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
9630 needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
9631 viewing options:
9632
9633 @example
9634 path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
9635 @r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
9636 @r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
9637 view: @r{Initial view when website is first shown. Possible values are:}
9638 info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
9639 overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
9640 content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
9641 showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
9642 sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
9643 @r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
9644 @r{@code{org-export-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
9645 @r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-export-headline-levels}, each}
9646 @r{info/folding section can still contain child headlines.}
9647 toc: @r{Should the table of content @emph{initially} be visible?}
9648 @r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the "toc" with @kbd{i}.}
9649 tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
9650 @r{the variables @code{org-export-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
9651 ftoc: @r{Does the css of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?}
9652 @r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
9653 ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
9654 @r{Make this @code{above} if the section should be above initial text.}
9655 mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
9656 @r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
9657 buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
9658 @r{default), only one such button will be present.}
9659 @end example
9660 @noindent
9661 @vindex org-infojs-options
9662 @vindex org-export-html-use-infojs
9663 You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
9664 @code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
9665 pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}.
9666
9667 @node LaTeX and PDF export, DocBook export, HTML export, Exporting
9668 @section La@TeX{} and PDF export
9669 @cindex La@TeX{} export
9670 @cindex PDF export
9671 @cindex Guerry, Bastien
9672
9673 Org-mode contains a La@TeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
9674 further processing@footnote{The default LaTeX output is designed for
9675 processing with pdftex or latex. It includes packages that are not
9676 compatible with xetex and possibly luatex. See the variables
9677 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
9678 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}.}, this backend is also used to
9679 produce PDF output. Since the La@TeX{} output uses @file{hyperref} to
9680 implement links and cross references, the PDF output file will be fully
9681 linked.
9682
9683 @menu
9684 * LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
9685 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
9686 * Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal La@TeX{} code
9687 * Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to La@TeX{}
9688 * Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into La@TeX{} output
9689 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
9690 @end menu
9691
9692 @node LaTeX/PDF export commands, Header and sectioning, LaTeX and PDF export, LaTeX and PDF export
9693 @subsection La@TeX{} export commands
9694
9695 @cindex region, active
9696 @cindex active region
9697 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9698 @table @kbd
9699 @kindex C-c C-e l
9700 @item C-c C-e l
9701 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9702 Export as La@TeX{} file @file{myfile.tex}. For an Org file
9703 @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will
9704 be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This
9705 requires @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9706 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9707 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
9708 title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
9709 property, that name will be used for the export.
9710 @kindex C-c C-e L
9711 @item C-c C-e L
9712 Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file.
9713 @kindex C-c C-e v l
9714 @kindex C-c C-e v L
9715 @item C-c C-e v l
9716 @item C-c C-e v L
9717 Export only the visible part of the document.
9718 @item M-x org-export-region-as-latex
9719 Convert the region to La@TeX{} under the assumption that it was Org-mode
9720 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
9721 buffer.
9722 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex
9723 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org-mode syntax) by La@TeX{}
9724 code.
9725 @kindex C-c C-e p
9726 @item C-c C-e p
9727 Export as La@TeX{} and then process to PDF.
9728 @kindex C-c C-e d
9729 @item C-c C-e d
9730 Export as La@TeX{} and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
9731 @end table
9732
9733 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9734 @vindex org-latex-low-levels
9735 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
9736 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
9737 will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
9738 convert them to a custom string depending on
9739 @code{org-latex-low-levels}.
9740
9741 If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
9742 with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
9743
9744 @example
9745 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e l}
9746 @end example
9747
9748 @noindent
9749 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
9750
9751 @node Header and sectioning, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX/PDF export commands, LaTeX and PDF export
9752 @subsection Header and sectioning structure
9753 @cindex La@TeX{} class
9754 @cindex La@TeX{} sectioning structure
9755 @cindex La@TeX{} header
9756 @cindex header, for LaTeX files
9757 @cindex sectioning structure, for LaTeX export
9758
9759 By default, the La@TeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
9760
9761 @vindex org-export-latex-default-class
9762 @vindex org-export-latex-classes
9763 @vindex org-export-latex-default-packages-alist
9764 @vindex org-export-latex-packages-alist
9765 @cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
9766 @cindex #+LATEX_CLASS
9767 @cindex #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
9768 @cindex property, LATEX_CLASS
9769 @cindex property, LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
9770 You can change this globally by setting a different value for
9771 @code{org-export-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
9772 @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass} in your file, or with a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS:}
9773 property that applies when exporting a region containing only this (sub)tree.
9774 The class must be listed in @code{org-export-latex-classes}. This variable
9775 defines a header template for each class@footnote{Into which the values of
9776 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
9777 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist} are spliced.}, and allows you to
9778 define the sectioning structure for each class. You can also define your own
9779 classes there. @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS} or a @code{LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS}
9780 property can specify the options for the @code{\documentclass} macro. You
9781 can also use @code{#+LATEX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}} to add lines to the
9782 header. See the docstring of @code{org-export-latex-classes} for more
9783 information.
9784
9785 @node Quoting LaTeX code, Tables in LaTeX export, Header and sectioning, LaTeX and PDF export
9786 @subsection Quoting La@TeX{} code
9787
9788 Embedded La@TeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded LaTeX}, will be correctly
9789 inserted into the La@TeX{} file. This includes simple macros like
9790 @samp{\ref@{LABEL@}} to create a cross reference to a figure. Furthermore,
9791 you can add special code that should only be present in La@TeX{} export with
9792 the following constructs:
9793
9794 @cindex #+LaTeX
9795 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
9796 @example
9797 #+LaTeX: Literal LaTeX code for export
9798 @end example
9799
9800 @noindent or
9801 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
9802
9803 @example
9804 #+BEGIN_LaTeX
9805 All lines between these markers are exported literally
9806 #+END_LaTeX
9807 @end example
9808
9809
9810 @node Tables in LaTeX export, Images in LaTeX export, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX and PDF export
9811 @subsection Tables in La@TeX{} export
9812 @cindex tables, in La@TeX{} export
9813
9814 For La@TeX{} export of a table, you can specify a label and a caption
9815 (@pxref{Images and tables}). You can also use the @code{ATTR_LaTeX} line to
9816 request a @code{longtable} environment for the table, so that it may span
9817 several pages, or provide the @code{multicolumn} keyword that will make the
9818 table span the page in a multicolumn environment (@code{table*} environment).
9819 Finally, you can set the alignment string:
9820
9821 @cindex #+CAPTION
9822 @cindex #+LABEL
9823 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
9824 @example
9825 #+CAPTION: A long table
9826 #+LABEL: tbl:long
9827 #+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable align=l|lp@{3cm@}r|l
9828 | ..... | ..... |
9829 | ..... | ..... |
9830 @end example
9831
9832
9833 @node Images in LaTeX export, Beamer class export, Tables in LaTeX export, LaTeX and PDF export
9834 @subsection Images in La@TeX{} export
9835 @cindex images, inline in La@TeX{}
9836 @cindex inlining images in La@TeX{}
9837
9838 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
9839 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
9840 output file resulting from La@TeX{} processing. Org will use an
9841 @code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
9842 caption and/or a label as described in @ref{Images and tables}, the figure
9843 will be wrapped into a @code{figure} environment and thus become a floating
9844 element. You can use an @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line to specify the various
9845 options that can be used in the optional argument of the
9846 @code{\includegraphics} macro. To modify the placement option of the
9847 @code{figure} environment, add something like @samp{placement=[h!]} to the
9848 Attributes.
9849
9850 If you would like to let text flow around the image, add the word @samp{wrap}
9851 to the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line, which will make the figure occupy the left
9852 half of the page. To fine-tune, the @code{placement} field will be the set
9853 of additional arguments needed by the @code{wrapfigure} environment. Note
9854 that if you change the size of the image, you need to use compatible settings
9855 for @code{\includegraphics} and @code{wrapfigure}.
9856
9857 @cindex #+CAPTION
9858 @cindex #+LABEL
9859 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
9860 @example
9861 #+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
9862 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
9863 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
9864 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
9865
9866 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=0.38\textwidth wrap placement=@{r@}@{0.4\textwidth@}
9867 [[./img/hst.png]]
9868 @end example
9869
9870 If you need references to a label created in this way, write
9871 @samp{\ref@{fig:SED-HR4049@}} just like in La@TeX{}.
9872
9873 @node Beamer class export, , Images in LaTeX export, LaTeX and PDF export
9874 @subsection Beamer class export
9875
9876 The LaTeX class @file{beamer} allows production of high quality presentations
9877 using LaTeX and pdf processing. Org-mode has special support for turning an
9878 Org-mode file or tree into a @file{beamer} presentation.
9879
9880 When the LaTeX class for the current buffer (as set with @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS:
9881 beamer}) or subtree (set with a @code{LaTeX_CLASS} property) is
9882 @code{beamer}, a special export mode will turn the file or tree into a beamer
9883 presentation. Any tree with not-too-deep level nesting should in principle be
9884 exportable as a beamer presentation. By default, the top-level entries (or
9885 the first level below the selected subtree heading) will be turned into
9886 frames, and the outline structure below this level will become itemize lists.
9887 You can also configure the variable @code{org-beamer-frame-level} to a
9888 different level - then the hierarchy above frames will produce the sectioning
9889 structure of the presentation.
9890
9891 A template for useful in-buffer settings or properties can be inserted into
9892 the buffer with @kbd{M-x org-beamer-settings-template}. Among other things,
9893 this will install a column view format which is very handy for editing
9894 special properties used by beamer.
9895
9896 You can influence the structure of the presentation using the following
9897 properties:
9898
9899 @table @code
9900 @item BEAMER_env
9901 The environment that should be used to format this entry. Valid environments
9902 are defined in the constant @code{org-beamer-environments-default}, and you
9903 can define more in @code{org-beamer-environments-extra}. If this property is
9904 set, the entry will also get a @code{:B_environment:} tag to make this
9905 visible. This tag has no semantic meaning, it is only a visual aid.
9906 @item BEAMER_envargs
9907 The beamer-special arguments that should be used for the environment, like
9908 @code{[t]} or @code{[<+->]} of @code{<2-3>}. If the @code{BEAMER_col}
9909 property is also set, something like @code{C[t]} can be added here as well to
9910 set an options argument for the implied @code{columns} environment.
9911 @code{c[t]} will set an option for the implied @code{column} environment.
9912 @item BEAMER_col
9913 The width of a column that should start with this entry. If this property is
9914 set, the entry will also get a @code{:BMCOL:} property to make this visible.
9915 Also this tag is only a visual aid. When this is a plain number, it will be
9916 interpreted as a fraction of @code{\textwidth}. Otherwise it will be assumed
9917 that you have specified the units, like @samp{3cm}. The first such property
9918 in a frame will start a @code{columns} environment to surround the columns.
9919 This environment is closed when an entry has a @code{BEAMER_col} property
9920 with value 0 or 1, or automatically at the end of the frame.
9921 @item BEAMER_extra
9922 Additional commands that should be inserted after the environment has been
9923 opened. For example, when creating a frame, this can be used to specify
9924 transitions.
9925 @end table
9926
9927 Frames will automatically receive a @code{fragile} option if they contain
9928 source code that uses the verbatim environment. Special @file{beamer}
9929 specific code can be inserted using @code{#+BEAMER:} and
9930 @code{#+BEGIN_beamer...#+end_beamer} constructs, similar to other export
9931 backends, but with the difference that @code{#+LaTeX:} stuff will be included
9932 in the presentation as well.
9933
9934 Outline nodes with @code{BEAMER_env} property value @samp{note} or
9935 @samp{noteNH} will be formatted as beamer notes, i,e, they will be wrapped
9936 into @code{\note@{...@}}. The former will include the heading as part of the
9937 note text, the latter will ignore the heading of that node. To simplify note
9938 generation, it is actually enough to mark the note with a @emph{tag} (either
9939 @code{:B_note:} or @code{:B_noteNH:}) instead of creating the
9940 @code{BEAMER_env} property.
9941
9942 You can turn on a special minor mode @code{org-beamer-mode} for editing
9943 support with
9944
9945 @example
9946 #+STARTUP: beamer
9947 @end example
9948
9949 @table @kbd
9950 @kindex C-c C-b
9951 @item C-c C-b
9952 In @code{org-beamer-mode}, this key offers fast selection of a beamer
9953 environment or the @code{BEAMER_col} property.
9954 @end table
9955
9956 Column view provides a great way to set the environment of a node and other
9957 important parameters. Make sure you are using a COLUMN format that is geared
9958 toward this special purpose. The command @kbd{M-x
9959 org-beamer-settings-template} defines such a format.
9960
9961 Here is a simple example Org document that is intended for beamer export.
9962
9963 @smallexample
9964 #+LaTeX_CLASS: beamer
9965 #+TITLE: Example Presentation
9966 #+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik
9967 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation]
9968 #+BEAMER_FRAME_LEVEL: 2
9969 #+BEAMER_HEADER_EXTRA: \usetheme@{Madrid@}\usecolortheme@{default@}
9970 #+COLUMNS: %35ITEM %10BEAMER_env(Env) %10BEAMER_envargs(Args) %4BEAMER_col(Col) %8BEAMER_extra(Ex)
9971
9972 * This is the first structural section
9973
9974 ** Frame 1 \\ with a subtitle
9975 *** Thanks to Eric Fraga :BMCOL:B_block:
9976 :PROPERTIES:
9977 :BEAMER_env: block
9978 :BEAMER_envargs: C[t]
9979 :BEAMER_col: 0.5
9980 :END:
9981 for the first viable beamer setup in Org
9982 *** Thanks to everyone else :BMCOL:B_block:
9983 :PROPERTIES:
9984 :BEAMER_col: 0.5
9985 :BEAMER_env: block
9986 :BEAMER_envargs: <2->
9987 :END:
9988 for contributing to the discussion
9989 **** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note:
9990 ** Frame 2 \\ where we will not use columns
9991 *** Request :B_block:
9992 Please test this stuff!
9993 :PROPERTIES:
9994 :BEAMER_env: block
9995 :END:
9996 @end smallexample
9997
9998 For more information, see the documentation on Worg.
9999
10000 @node DocBook export, TaskJuggler export, LaTeX and PDF export, Exporting
10001 @section DocBook export
10002 @cindex DocBook export
10003 @cindex PDF export
10004 @cindex Cui, Baoqiu
10005
10006 Org contains a DocBook exporter written by Baoqiu Cui. Once an Org file is
10007 exported to DocBook format, it can be further processed to produce other
10008 formats, including PDF, HTML, man pages, etc., using many available DocBook
10009 tools and stylesheets.
10010
10011 Currently DocBook exporter only supports DocBook V5.0.
10012
10013 @menu
10014 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
10015 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
10016 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
10017 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
10018 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
10019 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
10020 @end menu
10021
10022 @node DocBook export commands, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export, DocBook export
10023 @subsection DocBook export commands
10024
10025 @cindex region, active
10026 @cindex active region
10027 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10028 @table @kbd
10029 @kindex C-c C-e D
10030 @item C-c C-e D
10031 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10032 Export as DocBook file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the DocBook XML
10033 file will be @file{myfile.xml}. The file will be overwritten without
10034 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10035 @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
10036 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10037 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10038 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10039 property, that name will be used for the export.
10040 @kindex C-c C-e V
10041 @item C-c C-e V
10042 Export as DocBook file, process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10043
10044 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command
10045 @vindex org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command
10046 Note that, in order to produce PDF output based on exported DocBook file, you
10047 need to have XSLT processor and XSL-FO processor software installed on your
10048 system. Check variables @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} and
10049 @code{org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command}.
10050
10051 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet
10052 The stylesheet argument @code{%s} in variable
10053 @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} is replaced by the value of
10054 variable @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet}, which needs to be set by
10055 the user. You can also overrule this global setting on a per-file basis by
10056 adding an in-buffer setting @code{#+XSLT:} to the Org file.
10057
10058 @kindex C-c C-e v D
10059 @item C-c C-e v D
10060 Export only the visible part of the document.
10061 @end table
10062
10063 @node Quoting DocBook code, Recursive sections, DocBook export commands, DocBook export
10064 @subsection Quoting DocBook code
10065
10066 You can quote DocBook code in Org files and copy it verbatim into exported
10067 DocBook file with the following constructs:
10068
10069 @cindex #+DOCBOOK
10070 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10071 @example
10072 #+DOCBOOK: Literal DocBook code for export
10073 @end example
10074
10075 @noindent or
10076 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10077
10078 @example
10079 #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10080 All lines between these markers are exported by DocBook exporter
10081 literally.
10082 #+END_DOCBOOK
10083 @end example
10084
10085 For example, you can use the following lines to include a DocBook warning
10086 admonition. As to what this warning says, you should pay attention to the
10087 document context when quoting DocBook code in Org files. You may make
10088 exported DocBook XML files invalid by not quoting DocBook code correctly.
10089
10090 @example
10091 #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10092 <warning>
10093 <para>You should know what you are doing when quoting DocBook XML code
10094 in your Org file. Invalid DocBook XML file may be generated by
10095 DocBook exporter if you are not careful!</para>
10096 </warning>
10097 #+END_DOCBOOK
10098 @end example
10099
10100 @node Recursive sections, Tables in DocBook export, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export
10101 @subsection Recursive sections
10102 @cindex DocBook recursive sections
10103
10104 DocBook exporter exports Org files as articles using the @code{article}
10105 element in DocBook. Recursive sections, i.e. @code{section} elements, are
10106 used in exported articles. Top level headlines in Org files are exported as
10107 top level sections, and lower level headlines are exported as nested
10108 sections. The entire structure of Org files will be exported completely, no
10109 matter how many nested levels of headlines there are.
10110
10111 Using recursive sections makes it easy to port and reuse exported DocBook
10112 code in other DocBook document types like @code{book} or @code{set}.
10113
10114 @node Tables in DocBook export, Images in DocBook export, Recursive sections, DocBook export
10115 @subsection Tables in DocBook export
10116 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
10117
10118 Tables in Org files are exported as HTML tables, which have been supported since
10119 DocBook V4.3.
10120
10121 If a table does not have a caption, an informal table is generated using the
10122 @code{informaltable} element; otherwise, a formal table will be generated
10123 using the @code{table} element.
10124
10125 @node Images in DocBook export, Special characters, Tables in DocBook export, DocBook export
10126 @subsection Images in DocBook export
10127 @cindex images, inline in DocBook
10128 @cindex inlining images in DocBook
10129
10130 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10131 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, will be exported to DocBook
10132 using @code{mediaobject} elements. Each @code{mediaobject} element contains
10133 an @code{imageobject} that wraps an @code{imagedata} element. If you have
10134 specified a caption for an image as described in @ref{Images and tables}, a
10135 @code{caption} element will be added in @code{mediaobject}. If a label is
10136 also specified, it will be exported as an @code{xml:id} attribute of the
10137 @code{mediaobject} element.
10138
10139 @vindex org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes
10140 Image attributes supported by the @code{imagedata} element, like @code{align}
10141 or @code{width}, can be specified in two ways: you can either customize
10142 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} or use the
10143 @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line. Attributes specified in variable
10144 @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} are applied to all inline
10145 images in the Org file to be exported (unless they are overridden by image
10146 attributes specified in @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} lines).
10147
10148 The @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line can be used to specify additional image
10149 attributes or override default image attributes for individual images. If
10150 the same attribute appears in both the @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line and
10151 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes}, the former
10152 takes precedence. Here is an example about how image attributes can be
10153 set:
10154
10155 @cindex #+CAPTION
10156 @cindex #+LABEL
10157 @cindex #+ATTR_DOCBOOK
10158 @example
10159 #+CAPTION: The logo of Org-mode
10160 #+LABEL: unicorn-svg
10161 #+ATTR_DOCBOOK: scalefit="1" width="100%" depth="100%"
10162 [[./img/org-mode-unicorn.svg]]
10163 @end example
10164
10165 @vindex org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions
10166 By default, DocBook exporter recognizes the following image file types:
10167 @file{jpeg}, @file{jpg}, @file{png}, @file{gif}, and @file{svg}. You can
10168 customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions} to add
10169 more types to this list as long as DocBook supports them.
10170
10171 @node Special characters, , Images in DocBook export, DocBook export
10172 @subsection Special characters in DocBook export
10173 @cindex Special characters in DocBook export
10174
10175 @vindex org-export-docbook-doctype
10176 @vindex org-entities
10177 Special characters that are written in @TeX{}-like syntax, such as @code{\alpha},
10178 @code{\Gamma}, and @code{\Zeta}, are supported by DocBook exporter. These
10179 characters are rewritten to XML entities, like @code{&alpha;},
10180 @code{&Gamma;}, and @code{&Zeta;}, based on the list saved in variable
10181 @code{org-entities}. As long as the generated DocBook file includes the
10182 corresponding entities, these special characters are recognized.
10183
10184 You can customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to include the
10185 entities you need. For example, you can set variable
10186 @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to the following value to recognize all
10187 special characters included in XHTML entities:
10188
10189 @example
10190 "<!DOCTYPE article [
10191 <!ENTITY % xhtml1-symbol PUBLIC
10192 \"-//W3C//ENTITIES Symbol for HTML//EN//XML\"
10193 \"http://www.w3.org/2003/entities/2007/xhtml1-symbol.ent\"
10194 >
10195 %xhtml1-symbol;
10196 ]>
10197 "
10198 @end example
10199
10200 @node TaskJuggler export, Freemind export, DocBook export, Exporting
10201 @section TaskJuggler export
10202 @cindex TaskJuggler export
10203 @cindex Project management
10204
10205 @uref{http://www.taskjuggler.org/, TaskJuggler} is a project management tool.
10206 It provides an optimizing scheduler that computes your project time lines and
10207 resource assignments based on the project outline and the constraints that
10208 you have provided.
10209
10210 The TaskJuggler exporter is a bit different from other exporters, such as the
10211 HTML and LaTeX exporters for example, in that it does not export all the
10212 nodes of a document or strictly follow the order of the nodes in the
10213 document.
10214
10215 Instead the TaskJuggler exporter looks for a tree that defines the tasks and
10216 a optionally tree that defines the resources for this project. It then
10217 creates a TaskJuggler file based on these trees and the attributes defined in
10218 all the nodes.
10219
10220 @subsection TaskJuggler export commands
10221
10222 @table @kbd
10223 @kindex C-c C-e j
10224 @item C-c C-e j
10225 Export as TaskJuggler file.
10226
10227 @kindex C-c C-e J
10228 @item C-c C-e J
10229 Export as TaskJuggler file and then open the file with TaskJugglerUI.
10230 @end table
10231
10232 @subsection Tasks
10233
10234 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag
10235 Create your tasks as you usually do with Org-mode. Assign efforts to each
10236 task using properties (it's easiest to do this in the column view). You
10237 should end up with something similar to the example by Peter Jones in
10238 @url{http://www.contextualdevelopment.com/static/artifacts/articles/2008/project-planning/project-planning.org}.
10239 Now mark the top node of your tasks with a tag named
10240 @code{:taskjuggler_project:} (or whatever you customized
10241 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag} to). You are now ready to export
10242 the project plan with @kbd{C-c C-e J} which will export the project plan and
10243 open a gantt chart in TaskJugglerUI.
10244
10245 @subsection Resources
10246
10247 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag
10248 Next you can define resources and assign those to work on specific tasks. You
10249 can group your resources hierarchically. Tag the top node of the resources
10250 with @code{:taskjuggler_resource:} (or whatever you customized
10251 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag} to). You can optionally assign an
10252 identifier (named @samp{resource_id}) to the resources (using the standard
10253 Org properties commands, @pxref{Property syntax}) or you can let the exporter
10254 generate identifiers automatically (the exporter picks the first word of the
10255 headline as the identifier as long as it is unique, see the documentation of
10256 @code{org-taskjuggler-get-unique-id}). Using that identifier you can then
10257 allocate resources to tasks. This is again done with the @samp{allocate}
10258 property on the tasks. Do this in column view or when on the task type
10259 @kbd{C-c C-x p allocate @key{RET} <resource_id> @key{RET}}.
10260
10261 Once the allocations are done you can again export to TaskJuggler and check
10262 in the Resource Allocation Graph which person is working on what task at what
10263 time.
10264
10265 @subsection Export of properties
10266
10267 The exporter also takes TODO state information into consideration, i.e. if a
10268 task is marked as done it will have the corresponding attribute in
10269 TaskJuggler (@samp{complete 100}). Also it will export any property on a task
10270 resource or resource node which is known to TaskJuggler, such as
10271 @samp{limits}, @samp{vacation}, @samp{shift}, @samp{booking},
10272 @samp{efficiency}, @samp{journalentry}, @samp{rate} for resources or
10273 @samp{account}, @samp{start}, @samp{note}, @samp{duration}, @samp{end},
10274 @samp{journalentry}, @samp{milestone}, @samp{reference}, @samp{responsible},
10275 @samp{scheduling}, etc for tasks.
10276
10277 @subsection Dependencies
10278
10279 The exporter will handle dependencies that are defined in the tasks either
10280 with the @samp{ORDERED} attribute (@pxref{TODO dependencies}), with the
10281 @samp{BLOCKER} attribute (see org-depend.el) or alternatively with a
10282 @samp{depends} attribute. Both the @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends}
10283 attribute can be either @samp{previous-sibling} or a reference to an
10284 identifier (named @samp{task_id}) which is defined for another task in the
10285 project. @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends} attribute can define multiple
10286 dependencies separated by either space or comma. You can also specify
10287 optional attributes on the dependency by simply appending it. The following
10288 examples should illustrate this:
10289
10290 @example
10291 * Preparation
10292 :PROPERTIES:
10293 :task_id: preparation
10294 :ORDERED: t
10295 :END:
10296 * Training material
10297 :PROPERTIES:
10298 :task_id: training_material
10299 :ORDERED: t
10300 :END:
10301 ** Markup Guidelines
10302 :PROPERTIES:
10303 :Effort: 2.0
10304 :END:
10305 ** Workflow Guidelines
10306 :PROPERTIES:
10307 :Effort: 2.0
10308 :END:
10309 * Presentation
10310 :PROPERTIES:
10311 :Effort: 2.0
10312 :BLOCKER: training_material @{ gapduration 1d @} preparation
10313 :END:
10314 @end example
10315
10316 @subsection Reports
10317
10318 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports
10319 TaskJuggler can produce many kinds of reports (e.g. gantt chart, resource
10320 allocation, etc). The user defines what kind of reports should be generated
10321 for a project in the TaskJuggler file. The exporter will automatically insert
10322 some default reports in the file. These defaults are defined in
10323 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports}. They can be modified using
10324 customize along with a number of other options. For a more complete list, see
10325 @kbd{M-x customize-group @key{RET} org-export-taskjuggler @key{RET}}.
10326
10327 For more information and examples see the Org-taskjuggler tutorial at
10328 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-taskjuggler.php}.
10329
10330 @node Freemind export, XOXO export, TaskJuggler export, Exporting
10331 @section Freemind export
10332 @cindex Freemind export
10333 @cindex mind map
10334
10335 The Freemind exporter was written by Lennart Borgman.
10336
10337 @table @kbd
10338 @kindex C-c C-e m
10339 @item C-c C-e m
10340 Export as Freemind mind map @file{myfile.mm}.
10341 @end table
10342
10343 @node XOXO export, iCalendar export, Freemind export, Exporting
10344 @section XOXO export
10345 @cindex XOXO export
10346
10347 Org-mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
10348 Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
10349 does not interpret any additional Org-mode features.
10350
10351 @table @kbd
10352 @kindex C-c C-e x
10353 @item C-c C-e x
10354 Export as XOXO file @file{myfile.html}.
10355 @kindex C-c C-e v
10356 @item C-c C-e v x
10357 Export only the visible part of the document.
10358 @end table
10359
10360 @node iCalendar export, , XOXO export, Exporting
10361 @section iCalendar export
10362 @cindex iCalendar export
10363
10364 @vindex org-icalendar-include-todo
10365 @vindex org-icalendar-use-deadline
10366 @vindex org-icalendar-use-scheduled
10367 @vindex org-icalendar-categories
10368 Some people use Org-mode for keeping track of projects, but still prefer a
10369 standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments. In this
10370 case it can be useful to show deadlines and other time-stamped items in Org
10371 files in the calendar application. Org-mode can export calendar information
10372 in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to have TODO entries
10373 included in the export, configure the variable
10374 @code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. Plain timestamps are exported as VEVENT,
10375 and TODO items as VTODO. It will also create events from deadlines that are
10376 in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO items will be used
10377 to set the start and due dates for the TODO entry@footnote{See the variables
10378 @code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}.
10379 As categories, it will use the tags locally defined in the heading, and the
10380 file/tree category@footnote{To add inherited tags or the TODO state,
10381 configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-categories}.}.
10382
10383 @vindex org-icalendar-store-UID
10384 @cindex property, ID
10385 The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
10386 identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
10387 the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
10388 @code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
10389 entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
10390 a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
10391 prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
10392 In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
10393 figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
10394
10395 @table @kbd
10396 @kindex C-c C-e i
10397 @item C-c C-e i
10398 Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same
10399 directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
10400 @kindex C-c C-e I
10401 @item C-c C-e I
10402 @vindex org-agenda-files
10403 Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in
10404 @code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
10405 file will be written.
10406 @kindex C-c C-e c
10407 @item C-c C-e c
10408 @vindex org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file
10409 Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
10410 @code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
10411 @code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}.
10412 @end table
10413
10414 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
10415 @vindex org-icalendar-include-body
10416 @cindex property, SUMMARY
10417 @cindex property, DESCRIPTION
10418 @cindex property, LOCATION
10419 The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
10420 property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
10421 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
10422 entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
10423 and the description from the body (limited to
10424 @code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
10425
10426 How this calendar is best read and updated, depends on the application
10427 you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
10428
10429 @node Publishing, Working With Source Code, Exporting, Top
10430 @chapter Publishing
10431 @cindex publishing
10432
10433 Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure
10434 automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of interlinked org
10435 files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML
10436 pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web
10437 server.
10438
10439 You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF
10440 conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server.
10441
10442 Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
10443
10444 @menu
10445 * Configuration:: Defining projects
10446 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
10447 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
10448 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
10449 @end menu
10450
10451 @node Configuration, Uploading files, Publishing, Publishing
10452 @section Configuration
10453
10454 Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
10455 and many other properties of a project.
10456
10457 @menu
10458 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
10459 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
10460 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
10461 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
10462 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
10463 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
10464 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
10465 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
10466 @end menu
10467
10468 @node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
10469 @subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
10470 @cindex org-publish-project-alist
10471 @cindex projects, for publishing
10472
10473 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
10474 Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one
10475 variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. Each element of the list
10476 configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms:
10477
10478 @lisp
10479 ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
10480 @r{or}
10481 ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
10482
10483 @end lisp
10484
10485 In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A
10486 project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as the
10487 publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project
10488 takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the
10489 @code{:components} property are taken to be sub-projects, which group
10490 together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such
10491 a ``meta-project'', all the components will also be published, in the
10492 sequence given.
10493
10494 @node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
10495 @subsection Sources and destinations for files
10496 @cindex directories, for publishing
10497
10498 Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
10499 particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files,
10500 and where to put published files.
10501
10502 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
10503 @item @code{:base-directory}
10504 @tab Directory containing publishing source files
10505 @item @code{:publishing-directory}
10506 @tab Directory where output files will be published. You can directly
10507 publish to a webserver using a file name syntax appropriate for
10508 the Emacs @file{tramp} package. Or you can publish to a local directory and
10509 use external tools to upload your website (@pxref{Uploading files}).
10510 @item @code{:preparation-function}
10511 @tab Function or list of functions to be called before starting the
10512 publishing process, for example, to run @code{make} for updating files to be
10513 published. The project property list is scoped into this call as the
10514 variable @code{project-plist}.
10515 @item @code{:completion-function}
10516 @tab Function or list of functions called after finishing the publishing
10517 process, for example, to change permissions of the resulting files. The
10518 project property list is scoped into this call as the variable
10519 @code{project-plist}.
10520 @end multitable
10521 @noindent
10522
10523 @node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
10524 @subsection Selecting files
10525 @cindex files, selecting for publishing
10526
10527 By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
10528 are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
10529 properties
10530 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
10531 @item @code{:base-extension}
10532 @tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
10533 regular expression. Set this to the symbol @code{any} if you want to get all
10534 files in @code{:base-directory}, even without extension.
10535
10536 @item @code{:exclude}
10537 @tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
10538 published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
10539 extension.
10540
10541 @item @code{:include}
10542 @tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
10543 and @code{:exclude}.
10544 @end multitable
10545
10546 @node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
10547 @subsection Publishing action
10548 @cindex action, for publishing
10549
10550 Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
10551 possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
10552 Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
10553 @code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
10554 export}). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using
10555 @code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}. If you want to publish the Org file itself,
10556 but with @i{archived}, @i{commented}, and @i{tag-excluded} trees removed, use
10557 @code{org-publish-org-to-org} and set the parameters @code{:plain-source}
10558 and/or @code{:htmlized-source}. This will produce @file{file.org} and
10559 @file{file.org.html} in the publishing
10560 directory@footnote{@file{file-source.org} and @file{file-source.org.html} if
10561 source and publishing directories are equal. Note that with this kind of
10562 setup, you need to add @code{:exclude "-source\\.org"} to the project
10563 definition in @code{org-publish-project-alist} to avoid that the published
10564 source files will be considered as new org files the next time the project is
10565 published.}. Other files like images only
10566 need to be copied to the publishing destination, for this you may use
10567 @code{org-publish-attachment}. For non-Org files, you always need to
10568 specify the publishing function:
10569
10570 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
10571 @item @code{:publishing-function}
10572 @tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
10573 list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
10574 @item @code{:plain-source}
10575 @tab Non-nil means, publish plain source.
10576 @item @code{:htmlized-source}
10577 @tab Non-nil means, publish htmlized source.
10578 @end multitable
10579
10580 The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing at least
10581 a @code{:publishing-directory} property, the name of the file to be
10582 published, and the path to the publishing directory of the output file. It
10583 should take the specified file, make the necessary transformation (if any)
10584 and place the result into the destination folder.
10585
10586 @node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
10587 @subsection Options for the HTML/La@TeX{} exporters
10588 @cindex options, for publishing
10589
10590 The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
10591 and La@TeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
10592 variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
10593 with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
10594 respective variable for details.
10595
10596 @vindex org-export-html-link-up
10597 @vindex org-export-html-link-home
10598 @vindex org-export-default-language
10599 @vindex org-display-custom-times
10600 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
10601 @vindex org-export-with-section-numbers
10602 @vindex org-export-section-number-format
10603 @vindex org-export-with-toc
10604 @vindex org-export-preserve-breaks
10605 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
10606 @vindex org-export-with-emphasize
10607 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
10608 @vindex org-export-with-special-strings
10609 @vindex org-export-with-footnotes
10610 @vindex org-export-with-drawers
10611 @vindex org-export-with-tags
10612 @vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords
10613 @vindex org-export-with-priority
10614 @vindex org-export-with-TeX-macros
10615 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
10616 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
10617 @vindex org-export-with-fixed-width
10618 @vindex org-export-with-timestamps
10619 @vindex org-export-author-info
10620 @vindex org-export-email
10621 @vindex org-export-creator-info
10622 @vindex org-export-with-tables
10623 @vindex org-export-highlight-first-table-line
10624 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
10625 @vindex org-export-html-style
10626 @vindex org-export-html-style-extra
10627 @vindex org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html
10628 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
10629 @vindex org-export-html-extension
10630 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
10631 @vindex org-export-html-expand
10632 @vindex org-export-html-with-timestamp
10633 @vindex org-export-publishing-directory
10634 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
10635 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
10636 @vindex org-export-html-auto-preamble
10637 @vindex org-export-html-auto-postamble
10638 @vindex user-full-name
10639 @vindex user-mail-address
10640 @vindex org-export-select-tags
10641 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
10642
10643 @multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
10644 @item @code{:link-up} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-up}
10645 @item @code{:link-home} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-home}
10646 @item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
10647 @item @code{:customtime} @tab @code{org-display-custom-times}
10648 @item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
10649 @item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
10650 @item @code{:section-number-format} @tab @code{org-export-section-number-format}
10651 @item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
10652 @item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
10653 @item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
10654 @item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
10655 @item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
10656 @item @code{:special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
10657 @item @code{:footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
10658 @item @code{:drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
10659 @item @code{:tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
10660 @item @code{:todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
10661 @item @code{:priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
10662 @item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros}
10663 @item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}
10664 @item @code{:latex-listings} @tab @code{org-export-latex-listings}
10665 @item @code{:skip-before-1st-heading} @tab @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading}
10666 @item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
10667 @item @code{:timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
10668 @item @code{:author-info} @tab @code{org-export-author-info}
10669 @item @code{:email-info} @tab @code{org-export-email-info}
10670 @item @code{:creator-info} @tab @code{org-export-creator-info}
10671 @item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
10672 @item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line}
10673 @item @code{:style-include-default} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}
10674 @item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style}
10675 @item @code{:style-extra} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-extra}
10676 @item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html}
10677 @item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images}
10678 @item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-export-html-extension}
10679 @item @code{:xml-declaration} @tab @code{org-export-html-xml-declaration}
10680 @item @code{:html-table-tag} @tab @code{org-export-html-table-tag}
10681 @item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand}
10682 @item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp}
10683 @item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
10684 @item @code{:preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble}
10685 @item @code{:postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble}
10686 @item @code{:auto-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-preamble}
10687 @item @code{:auto-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-postamble}
10688 @item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name}
10689 @item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address} : @code{addr;addr;..}
10690 @item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
10691 @item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
10692 @item @code{:latex-image-options} @tab @code{org-export-latex-image-default-option}
10693 @end multitable
10694
10695 Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in
10696 both HTML and La@TeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and
10697 @code{:LaTeX-fragments}, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the
10698 La@TeX{} export.
10699
10700 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
10701 When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist},
10702 its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if
10703 any) during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export
10704 options}), however, override everything.
10705
10706 @node Publishing links, Sitemap, Publishing options, Configuration
10707 @subsection Links between published files
10708 @cindex links, publishing
10709
10710 To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use
10711 something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply
10712 @samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). When published, this link
10713 becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the
10714 pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when
10715 you publish them to HTML. If you also publish the Org source file and want
10716 to link to that, use an @code{http:} link instead of a @code{file:} link,
10717 because @code{file:} links are converted to link to the corresponding
10718 @file{html} file.
10719
10720 You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful
10721 with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload
10722 the related files, these links will work too. See @ref{Complex example}, for
10723 an example of this usage.
10724
10725 Sometimes an Org file to be published may contain links that are
10726 only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
10727 location. In this case, use the property
10728
10729 @multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6
10730 @item @code{:link-validation-function}
10731 @tab Function to validate links
10732 @end multitable
10733
10734 @noindent
10735 to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
10736 accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
10737 the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
10738 function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a
10739 description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
10740 function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given
10741 file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
10742
10743 @node Sitemap, Generating an index, Publishing links, Configuration
10744 @subsection Generating a sitemap
10745 @cindex sitemap, of published pages
10746
10747 The following properties may be used to control publishing of
10748 a map of files for a given project.
10749
10750 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.65
10751 @item @code{:auto-sitemap}
10752 @tab When non-nil, publish a sitemap during @code{org-publish-current-project}
10753 or @code{org-publish-all}.
10754
10755 @item @code{:sitemap-filename}
10756 @tab Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to @file{sitemap.org} (which
10757 becomes @file{sitemap.html}).
10758
10759 @item @code{:sitemap-title}
10760 @tab Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of file.
10761
10762 @item @code{:sitemap-function}
10763 @tab Plug-in function to use for generation of the sitemap.
10764 Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-sitemap}, which generates a plain list
10765 of links to all files in the project.
10766
10767 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-folders}
10768 @tab Where folders should appear in the sitemap. Set this to @code{first}
10769 (default) or @code{last} to display folders first or last,
10770 respectively. Any other value will mix files and folders.
10771
10772 @item @code{:sitemap-alphabetically}
10773 @tab The site map is normally sorted alphabetically. Set this explicitly to
10774 @code{nil} to turn off sorting.
10775
10776 @item @code{:sitemap-ignore-case}
10777 @tab Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default @code{nil}.
10778
10779 @end multitable
10780
10781 @node Generating an index, , Sitemap, Configuration
10782 @subsection Generating an index
10783 @cindex index, in a publishing project
10784
10785 Org-mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project.
10786
10787 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
10788 @item @code{:makeindex}
10789 @tab When non-nil, generate in index in the file @file{theindex.org} and
10790 publish it as @file{theindex.html}.
10791 @end multitable
10792
10793 The file will be create when first publishing a project with the
10794 @code{:makeindex} set. The file only contains a statement @code{#+include:
10795 "theindex.inc"}. You can then built around this include statement by adding
10796 a title, style information etc.
10797
10798 @node Uploading files, Sample configuration, Configuration, Publishing
10799 @section Uploading files
10800 @cindex rsync
10801 @cindex unison
10802
10803 For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
10804 @command{rsync} or @command{unison}, it might be preferable not to use the built in
10805 @i{remote} publishing facilities of Org-mode which rely heavily on
10806 Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be
10807 so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems
10808 under heavy usage.
10809
10810 Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition
10811 to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute
10812 checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local
10813 directory (possibly even @i{in place} with your Org files) and then use
10814 @file{unison} or @file{rsync} to do the synchronization with the remote host.
10815
10816 Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to transfer to
10817 a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing
10818 definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org
10819 files with @code{org-publish} and let the synchronization tool do the rest.
10820 You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as @file{jpg},
10821 @file{css} or @file{gif} files in the project definition since the 3rd party
10822 tool syncs them.
10823
10824 Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so
10825 that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set
10826 @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag} to @code{nil}, you gain the main
10827 benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example
10828 files you might include with @code{#+INCLUDE}. The timestamp mechanism in
10829 Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified.
10830
10831 @node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Uploading files, Publishing
10832 @section Sample configuration
10833
10834 Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
10835 project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
10836 more complex, with a multi-component project.
10837
10838 @menu
10839 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
10840 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
10841 @end menu
10842
10843 @node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
10844 @subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
10845
10846 This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
10847 directory on the local machine.
10848
10849 @lisp
10850 (setq org-publish-project-alist
10851 '(("org"
10852 :base-directory "~/org/"
10853 :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
10854 :section-numbers nil
10855 :table-of-contents nil
10856 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
10857 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
10858 type=\"text/css\"/>")))
10859 @end lisp
10860
10861 @node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
10862 @subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
10863
10864 This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
10865 Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
10866 style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are
10867 excluded.
10868
10869 To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
10870 your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
10871 paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
10872 publishable images in @file{~/images}, you would link to an image with
10873 @c
10874 @example
10875 file:../images/myimage.png
10876 @end example
10877 @c
10878 On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
10879 same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
10880 right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
10881
10882 @lisp
10883 (setq org-publish-project-alist
10884 '(("orgfiles"
10885 :base-directory "~/org/"
10886 :base-extension "org"
10887 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
10888 :publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
10889 :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
10890 :headline-levels 3
10891 :section-numbers nil
10892 :table-of-contents nil
10893 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
10894 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
10895 :auto-preamble t
10896 :auto-postamble nil)
10897
10898 ("images"
10899 :base-directory "~/images/"
10900 :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
10901 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
10902 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
10903
10904 ("other"
10905 :base-directory "~/other/"
10906 :base-extension "css\\|el"
10907 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
10908 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
10909 ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
10910 @end lisp
10911
10912 @node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
10913 @section Triggering publication
10914
10915 Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
10916
10917 @table @kbd
10918 @kindex C-c C-e C
10919 @item C-c C-e C
10920 Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
10921 @kindex C-c C-e P
10922 @item C-c C-e P
10923 Publish the project containing the current file.
10924 @kindex C-c C-e F
10925 @item C-c C-e F
10926 Publish only the current file.
10927 @kindex C-c C-e E
10928 @item C-c C-e E
10929 Publish every project.
10930 @end table
10931
10932 @vindex org-publish-use-timestamps-flag
10933 Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions
10934 normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force
10935 publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands
10936 above, or by customizing the variable @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag}.
10937 This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via
10938 @code{#+SETUPFILE:} or @code{#+INCLUDE:}.
10939
10940 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
10941 @comment Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
10942
10943 @node Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
10944 @chapter Working with source code
10945 @cindex Schulte, Eric
10946 @cindex Davison, Dan
10947 @cindex source code, working with
10948
10949 Source code can be included in Org-mode documents using a @samp{src} block,
10950 e.g.
10951
10952 @example
10953 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
10954 (defun org-xor (a b)
10955 "Exclusive or."
10956 (if a (not b) b))
10957 #+END_SRC
10958 @end example
10959
10960 Org-mode provides a number of features for working with live source code,
10961 including editing of code blocks in their native major-mode, evaluation of
10962 code blocks, tangling of code blocks, and exporting code blocks and
10963 their results in several formats. This functionality was contributed by Dan
10964 Davison and Eric Schulte, and was originally named Org-babel.
10965
10966 The following sections describe Org-mode's code block handling facilities.
10967
10968 @menu
10969 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
10970 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
10971 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
10972 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
10973 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org-mode buffer
10974 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
10975 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
10976 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
10977 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
10978 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org-mode
10979 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
10980 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
10981 @end menu
10982
10983 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
10984 @comment Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
10985
10986 @node Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
10987 @section Structure of code blocks
10988 @cindex code block, structure
10989 @cindex source code, block structure
10990
10991 The structure of code blocks is as follows:
10992
10993 @example
10994 #+srcname: <name>
10995 #+begin_src <language> <switches> <header arguments>
10996 <body>
10997 #+end_src
10998 @end example
10999
11000 @table @code
11001 @item <name>
11002 This name is associated with the code block. This is similar to the
11003 @samp{#+tblname} lines that can be used to name tables in Org-mode files.
11004 Referencing the name of a code block makes it possible to evaluate the
11005 block from other places in the file, other files, or from Org-mode table
11006 formulas (see @ref{The spreadsheet}).
11007 @item <language>
11008 The language of the code in the block.
11009 @item <switches>
11010 Switches controlling exportation of the code block (see switches discussion in
11011 @ref{Literal examples})
11012 @item <header arguments>
11013 Optional header arguments control many aspects of evaluation, export and
11014 tangling of code blocks. See the @ref{Header arguments}
11015 section. Header arguments can also be set on a per-buffer or per-subtree
11016 basis using properties.
11017 @item <body>
11018 The source code.
11019 @end table
11020
11021 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11022 @comment Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
11023
11024 @node Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
11025 @section Editing source code
11026 @cindex code block, editing
11027 @cindex source code, editing
11028
11029 @kindex C-c '
11030 Use @kbd{C-c '} to edit the current code block. This brings up
11031 a language major-mode edit buffer containing the body of the code
11032 block. Saving this buffer will write the new contents back to the Org
11033 buffer. Use @kbd{C-c '} again to exit.
11034
11035 The @code{org-src-mode} minor mode will be active in the edit buffer. The
11036 following variables can be used to configure the behavior of the edit
11037 buffer. See also the customization group @code{org-edit-structure} for
11038 further configuration options.
11039
11040 @table @code
11041 @item org-src-lang-modes
11042 If an Emacs major-mode named @code{<lang>-mode} exists, where
11043 @code{<lang>} is the language named in the header line of the code block,
11044 then the edit buffer will be placed in that major-mode. This variable
11045 can be used to map arbitrary language names to existing major modes.
11046 @item org-src-window-setup
11047 Controls the way Emacs windows are rearranged when the edit buffer is created.
11048 @item org-src-preserve-indentation
11049 This variable is especially useful for tangling languages such as
11050 python, in which whitespace indentation in the output is critical.
11051 @item org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer
11052 By default, Org will ask before returning to an open edit buffer. Set
11053 this variable to nil to switch without asking.
11054 @end table
11055
11056 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11057 @comment Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
11058
11059 @node Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
11060 @section Exporting code blocks
11061 @cindex code block, exporting
11062 @cindex source code, exporting
11063
11064 It is possible to export the @emph{contents} of code blocks, the
11065 @emph{results} of code block evaluation, @emph{neither}, or @emph{both}. For
11066 most languages, the default exports the contents of code blocks. However, for
11067 some languages (e.g. @code{ditaa}) the default exports the results of code
11068 block evaluation. For information on exporting code block bodies, see
11069 @ref{Literal examples}.
11070
11071 The @code{:exports} header argument can be used to specify export
11072 behavior:
11073
11074 @subsubheading Header arguments:
11075 @table @code
11076 @item :exports code
11077 The default in most languages. The body of the code block is exported, as
11078 described in @ref{Literal examples}.
11079 @item :exports results
11080 The code block will be evaluated and the results will be placed in the
11081 Org-mode buffer for export, either updating previous results of the code
11082 block located anywhere in the buffer or, if no previous results exist,
11083 placing the results immediately after the code block. The body of the code
11084 block will not be exported.
11085 @item :exports both
11086 Both the code block and its results will be exported.
11087 @item :exports none
11088 Neither the code block nor its results will be exported.
11089 @end table
11090
11091 It is possible to inhibit the evaluation of code blocks during export.
11092 Setting the the @code{org-export-babel-evaluate} variable to @code{nil} will
11093 ensure that no code blocks are evaluated as part of the export process. This
11094 can be useful in situations where potentially untrusted Org-mode files are
11095 exported in an automated fashion, for example when Org-mode is used as the
11096 markup language for a wiki.
11097
11098 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11099 @comment Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
11100 @node Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
11101 @section Extracting source code
11102 @cindex source code, extracting
11103 @cindex code block, extracting source code
11104
11105 Creating pure source code files by extracting code from source blocks is
11106 referred to as ``tangling''---a term adopted from the literate programming
11107 community. During ``tangling'' of code blocks their bodies are expanded
11108 using @code{org-babel-expand-src-block} which can expand both variable and
11109 ``noweb'' style references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}).
11110
11111 @subsubheading Header arguments
11112 @table @code
11113 @item :tangle no
11114 The default. The code block is not included in the tangled output.
11115 @item :tangle yes
11116 Include the code block in the tangled output. The output file name is the
11117 name of the org file with the extension @samp{.org} replaced by the extension
11118 for the block language.
11119 @item :tangle filename
11120 Include the code block in the tangled output to file @samp{filename}.
11121 @end table
11122
11123 @kindex C-c C-v t
11124 @subsubheading Functions
11125 @table @code
11126 @item org-babel-tangle @kbd{C-c C-v t}
11127 Tangle the current file.
11128 @item org-babel-tangle-file
11129 Choose a file to tangle.
11130 @end table
11131
11132 @subsubheading Hooks
11133 @table @code
11134 @item org-babel-post-tangle-hook
11135 This hook is run from within code files tangled by @code{org-babel-tangle}.
11136 Example applications could include post-processing, compilation or evaluation
11137 of tangled code files.
11138 @end table
11139
11140 @node Evaluating code blocks, Library of Babel, Extracting source code, Working With Source Code
11141 @section Evaluating code blocks
11142 @cindex code block, evaluating
11143 @cindex source code, evaluating
11144
11145 Code blocks can be evaluated@footnote{Whenever code is evaluated there is a
11146 potential for that code to do harm. Org-mode provides a number of safeguards
11147 to ensure that it only evaluates code with explicit confirmation from the
11148 user. For information on these safeguards (and on how to disable them) see
11149 @ref{Code evaluation security}.} and the results placed in the Org-mode
11150 buffer. By default, evaluation is only turned on for @code{emacs-lisp} code
11151 blocks, however support exists for evaluating blocks in many languages. See
11152 @ref{Languages} for a list of supported languages. See @ref{Structure of
11153 code blocks} for information on the syntax used to define a code block.
11154
11155 @kindex C-c C-c
11156 There are a number of ways to evaluate code blocks. The simplest is to press
11157 @kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{C-c C-v e} with the point on a code block@footnote{The
11158 @code{org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c} variable can be used to remove code
11159 evaluation from the @kbd{C-c C-c} key binding.}. This will call the
11160 @code{org-babel-execute-src-block} function to evaluate the block and insert
11161 its results into the Org-mode buffer.
11162
11163 It is also possible to evaluate named code blocks from anywhere in an
11164 Org-mode buffer or an Org-mode table. @code{#+call} (or synonymously
11165 @code{#+function} or @code{#+lob}) lines can be used to remotely execute code
11166 blocks located in the current Org-mode buffer or in the ``Library of Babel''
11167 (see @ref{Library of Babel}). These lines use the following syntax.
11168
11169 @example
11170 #+call: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
11171 #+function: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
11172 #+lob: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
11173 @end example
11174
11175 @table @code
11176 @item <name>
11177 The name of the code block to be evaluated.
11178 @item <arguments>
11179 Arguments specified in this section will be passed to the code block.
11180 @item <header arguments>
11181 Header arguments can be placed after the function invocation. See
11182 @ref{Header arguments} for more information on header arguments.
11183 @end table
11184
11185
11186 @node Library of Babel, Languages, Evaluating code blocks, Working With Source Code
11187 @section Library of Babel
11188 @cindex babel, library of
11189 @cindex source code, library
11190 @cindex code block, library
11191
11192 The ``Library of Babel'' is a library of code blocks
11193 that can be called from any Org-mode file. The library is housed in an
11194 Org-mode file located in the @samp{contrib} directory of Org-mode.
11195 Org-mode users can deposit functions they believe to be generally
11196 useful in the library.
11197
11198 Code blocks defined in the ``Library of Babel'' can be called remotely as if
11199 they were in the current Org-mode buffer (see @ref{Evaluating code blocks}
11200 for information on the syntax of remote code block evaluation).
11201
11202 @kindex C-c C-v l
11203 Code blocks located in any Org-mode file can be loaded into the ``Library of
11204 Babel'' with the @code{org-babel-lob-ingest} function, bound to @kbd{C-c C-v
11205 l}.
11206
11207 @node Languages, Header arguments, Library of Babel, Working With Source Code
11208 @section Languages
11209 @cindex babel, languages
11210 @cindex source code, languages
11211 @cindex code block, languages
11212
11213 Code blocks in the following languages are supported.
11214
11215 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.3 0.22 0.2
11216 @item @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier} @tab @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier}
11217 @item Asymptote @tab asymptote @tab C @tab C
11218 @item C++ @tab C++ @tab Clojure @tab clojure
11219 @item css @tab css @tab ditaa @tab ditaa
11220 @item Graphviz @tab dot @tab Emacs Lisp @tab emacs-lisp
11221 @item gnuplot @tab gnuplot @tab Haskell @tab haskell
11222 @item LaTeX @tab latex @tab Matlab @tab matlab
11223 @item Mscgen @tab mscgen @tab Objective Caml @tab ocaml
11224 @item Octave @tab octave @tab OZ @tab oz
11225 @item Perl @tab perl @tab Python @tab python
11226 @item R @tab R @tab Ruby @tab ruby
11227 @item Sass @tab sass @tab GNU Screen @tab screen
11228 @item shell @tab sh @tab SQL @tab sql
11229 @item Sqlite @tab sqlite
11230 @end multitable
11231
11232 Language-specific documentation is available for some languages. If
11233 available, it can be found at
11234 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages}.
11235
11236 The @code{org-babel-load-languages} controls which languages are enabled for
11237 evaluation (by default only @code{emacs-lisp} is enabled). This variable can
11238 be set using the customization interface or by adding code like the following
11239 to your emacs configuration.
11240
11241 @quotation
11242 The following disables @code{emacs-lisp} evaluation and enables evaluation of
11243 @code{R} code blocks.
11244 @end quotation
11245
11246 @lisp
11247 (org-babel-do-load-languages
11248 'org-babel-load-languages
11249 '((emacs-lisp . nil)
11250 (R . t)))
11251 @end lisp
11252
11253 It is also possible to enable support for a language by loading the related
11254 elisp file with @code{require}.
11255
11256 @quotation
11257 The following adds support for evaluating @code{clojure} code blocks.
11258 @end quotation
11259
11260 @lisp
11261 (require 'ob-clojure)
11262 @end lisp
11263
11264 @node Header arguments, Results of evaluation, Languages, Working With Source Code
11265 @section Header arguments
11266 @cindex code block, header arguments
11267 @cindex source code, block header arguments
11268
11269 Code block functionality can be configured with header arguments. This
11270 section provides an overview of the use of header arguments, and then
11271 describes each header argument in detail.
11272
11273 @menu
11274 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
11275 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
11276 @end menu
11277
11278 @node Using header arguments, Specific header arguments, Header arguments, Header arguments
11279 @subsection Using header arguments
11280
11281 The values of header arguments can be set in five different ways, each more
11282 specific (and having higher priority) than the last.
11283 @menu
11284 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
11285 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
11286 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
11287 * Header arguments in Org-mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
11288 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
11289 @end menu
11290
11291
11292 @node System-wide header arguments, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments, Using header arguments
11293 @subsubheading System-wide header arguments
11294 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
11295 System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by customizing the
11296 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} variable:
11297
11298 @example
11299 :session => "none"
11300 :results => "replace"
11301 :exports => "code"
11302 :cache => "no"
11303 :noweb => "no"
11304 @end example
11305
11306 @c @example
11307 @c org-babel-default-header-args is a variable defined in `org-babel.el'.
11308 @c Its value is
11309 @c ((:session . "none")
11310 @c (:results . "replace")
11311 @c (:exports . "code")
11312 @c (:cache . "no")
11313 @c (:noweb . "no"))
11314
11315
11316 @c Documentation:
11317 @c Default arguments to use when evaluating a code block.
11318 @c @end example
11319
11320 For example, the following example could be used to set the default value of
11321 @code{:noweb} header arguments to @code{yes}. This would have the effect of
11322 expanding @code{:noweb} references by default when evaluating source code
11323 blocks.
11324
11325 @lisp
11326 (setq org-babel-default-header-args
11327 (cons '(:noweb . "yes")
11328 (assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args)))
11329 @end lisp
11330
11331 @node Language-specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, System-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
11332 @subsubheading Language-specific header arguments
11333 Each language can define its own set of default header arguments. See the
11334 language-specific documentation available online at
11335 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel}.
11336
11337 @node Buffer-wide header arguments, Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments
11338 @subsubheading Buffer-wide header arguments
11339 Buffer-wide header arguments may be specified through the use of a special
11340 line placed anywhere in an Org-mode file. The line consists of the
11341 @code{#+BABEL:} keyword followed by a series of header arguments which may be
11342 specified using the standard header argument syntax.
11343
11344 For example the following would set @code{session} to @code{*R*}, and
11345 @code{results} to @code{silent} for every code block in the buffer, ensuring
11346 that all execution took place in the same session, and no results would be
11347 inserted into the buffer.
11348
11349 @example
11350 #+BABEL: :session *R* :results silent
11351 @end example
11352
11353 @node Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Code block specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
11354 @subsubheading Header arguments in Org-mode properties
11355
11356 Header arguments are also read from Org-mode properties (see @ref{Property
11357 syntax}), which can be set on a buffer-wide or per-heading basis. An example
11358 of setting a header argument for all code blocks in a buffer is
11359
11360 @example
11361 #+property: tangle yes
11362 @end example
11363
11364 When properties are used to set default header arguments, they are looked up
11365 with inheritance, so the value of the @code{:cache} header argument will default
11366 to @code{yes} in all code blocks in the subtree rooted at the following
11367 heading:
11368
11369 @example
11370 * outline header
11371 :PROPERTIES:
11372 :cache: yes
11373 :END:
11374 @end example
11375
11376 @kindex C-c C-x p
11377 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
11378 Properties defined in this way override the properties set in
11379 @code{org-babel-default-header-args}. It is convenient to use the
11380 @code{org-set-property} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-x p} to set properties
11381 in Org-mode documents.
11382
11383 @node Code block specific header arguments, , Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Using header arguments
11384 @subsubheading Code block specific header arguments
11385
11386 The most common way to assign values to header arguments is at the
11387 code block level. This can be done by listing a sequence of header
11388 arguments and their values as part of the @code{#+begin_src} line.
11389 Properties set in this way override both the values of
11390 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} and header arguments specified as
11391 properties. In the following example, the @code{:results} header argument
11392 is set to @code{silent}, meaning the results of execution will not be
11393 inserted in the buffer, and the @code{:exports} header argument is set to
11394 @code{code}, meaning only the body of the code block will be
11395 preserved on export to HTML or LaTeX.
11396
11397 @example
11398 #+source: factorial
11399 #+begin_src haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0
11400 fac 0 = 1
11401 fac n = n * fac (n-1)
11402 #+end_src
11403 @end example
11404
11405 Similarly, it is possible to set header arguments for inline code blocks:
11406
11407 @example
11408 src_haskell[:exports both]@{fac 5@}
11409 @end example
11410
11411 Header arguments for ``Library of Babel'' or function call lines can be set as shown below:
11412
11413 @example
11414 #+call: factorial(n=5) :exports results
11415 @end example
11416
11417 @node Specific header arguments, , Using header arguments, Header arguments
11418 @subsection Specific header arguments
11419 The following header arguments are defined:
11420
11421 @menu
11422 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
11423 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
11424 be collected and handled
11425 * file:: Specify a path for file output
11426 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
11427 directory for code block execution
11428 * exports:: Export code and/or results
11429 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
11430 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
11431 expansion during tangling
11432 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
11433 code files
11434 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
11435 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
11436 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
11437 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
11438 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
11439 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
11440 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
11441 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
11442 @end menu
11443
11444 @node var, results, Specific header arguments, Specific header arguments
11445 @subsubsection @code{:var}
11446 The @code{:var} header argument is used to pass arguments to code blocks.
11447 The specifics of how arguments are included in a code block vary by language;
11448 these are addressed in the language-specific documentation. However, the
11449 syntax used to specify arguments is the same across all languages. The
11450 values passed to arguments can be literal values, values from org-mode tables
11451 and literal example blocks, or the results of other code blocks.
11452
11453 These values can be indexed in a manner similar to arrays---see the
11454 ``indexable variable values'' heading below.
11455
11456 The following syntax is used to pass arguments to code blocks using the
11457 @code{:var} header argument.
11458
11459 @example
11460 :var name=assign
11461 @end example
11462
11463 where @code{assign} can take one of the following forms
11464
11465 @itemize @bullet
11466 @item literal value
11467 either a string @code{"string"} or a number @code{9}.
11468 @item reference
11469 a table name:
11470
11471 @example
11472 #+tblname: example-table
11473 | 1 |
11474 | 2 |
11475 | 3 |
11476 | 4 |
11477
11478 #+source: table-length
11479 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var table=example-table
11480 (length table)
11481 #+end_src
11482
11483 #+results: table-length
11484 : 4
11485 @end example
11486
11487 a code block name, as assigned by @code{#+srcname:}, followed by
11488 parentheses:
11489
11490 @example
11491 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var length=table-length()
11492 (* 2 length)
11493 #+end_src
11494
11495 #+results:
11496 : 8
11497 @end example
11498
11499 In addition, an argument can be passed to the code block referenced
11500 by @code{:var}. The argument is passed within the parentheses following the
11501 code block name:
11502
11503 @example
11504 #+source: double
11505 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var input=8
11506 (* 2 input)
11507 #+end_src
11508
11509 #+results: double
11510 : 16
11511
11512 #+source: squared
11513 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=1)
11514 (* input input)
11515 #+end_src
11516
11517 #+results: squared
11518 : 4
11519 @end example
11520 @end itemize
11521
11522 @subsubheading Alternate argument syntax
11523 It is also possible to specify arguments in a potentially more natural way
11524 using the @code{#+source:} line of a code block. As in the following
11525 example arguments can be packed inside of parenthesis, separated by commas,
11526 following the source name.
11527
11528 @example
11529 #+source: double(input=0, x=2)
11530 #+begin_src emacs-lisp
11531 (* 2 (+ input x))
11532 #+end_src
11533 @end example
11534
11535 @subsubheading Indexable variable values
11536 It is possible to reference portions of variable values by ``indexing'' into
11537 the variables. Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting back from
11538 the end. If an index is separated by @code{,}s then each subsequent section
11539 will index into the next deepest nesting or dimension of the value. The
11540 following example assigns the last cell of the first row the table
11541 @code{example-table} to the variable @code{data}:
11542
11543 @example
11544 #+results: example-table
11545 | 1 | a |
11546 | 2 | b |
11547 | 3 | c |
11548 | 4 | d |
11549
11550 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1]
11551 data
11552 #+end_src
11553
11554 #+results:
11555 : a
11556 @end example
11557
11558 Ranges of variable values can be referenced using two integers separated by a
11559 @code{:}, in which case the entire inclusive range is referenced. For
11560 example the following assigns the middle three rows of @code{example-table}
11561 to @code{data}.
11562
11563 @example
11564 #+results: example-table
11565 | 1 | a |
11566 | 2 | b |
11567 | 3 | c |
11568 | 4 | d |
11569 | 5 | 3 |
11570
11571 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3]
11572 data
11573 #+end_src
11574
11575 #+results:
11576 | 2 | b |
11577 | 3 | c |
11578 | 4 | d |
11579 @end example
11580
11581 Additionally, an empty index, or the single character @code{*}, are both
11582 interpreted to mean the entire range and as such are equivalent to
11583 @code{0:-1}, as shown in the following example in which the entire first
11584 column is referenced.
11585
11586 @example
11587 #+results: example-table
11588 | 1 | a |
11589 | 2 | b |
11590 | 3 | c |
11591 | 4 | d |
11592
11593 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0]
11594 data
11595 #+end_src
11596
11597 #+results:
11598 | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 |
11599 @end example
11600
11601 It is possible to index into the results of code blocks as well as tables.
11602 Any number of dimensions can be indexed. Dimensions are separated from one
11603 another by commas, as shown in the following example.
11604
11605 @example
11606 #+source: 3D
11607 #+begin_src emacs-lisp
11608 '(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9))
11609 ((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18))
11610 ((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27)))
11611 #+end_src
11612
11613 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1]
11614 data
11615 #+end_src
11616
11617 #+results:
11618 | 11 | 14 | 17 |
11619 @end example
11620
11621 @node results, file, var, Specific header arguments
11622 @subsubsection @code{:results}
11623
11624 There are three classes of @code{:results} header argument. Only one option of
11625 each type may be supplied per code block.
11626
11627 @itemize @bullet
11628 @item
11629 @b{collection} header arguments specify how the results should be collected
11630 from the code block
11631 @item
11632 @b{type} header arguments specify what type of result the code block will
11633 return---which has implications for how they will be inserted into the
11634 Org-mode buffer
11635 @item
11636 @b{handling} header arguments specify how the results of evaluating the code
11637 block should be handled.
11638 @end itemize
11639
11640 @subsubheading Collection
11641 The following options are mutually exclusive, and specify how the results
11642 should be collected from the code block.
11643
11644 @itemize @bullet
11645 @item @code{value}
11646 This is the default. The result is the value of the last statement in the
11647 code block. This header argument places the evaluation in functional
11648 mode. Note that in some languages, e.g., python, use of this result type
11649 requires that a @code{return} statement be included in the body of the source
11650 code block. E.g., @code{:results value}.
11651 @item @code{output}
11652 The result is the collection of everything printed to STDOUT during the
11653 execution of the code block. This header argument places the
11654 evaluation in scripting mode. E.g., @code{:results output}.
11655 @end itemize
11656
11657 @subsubheading Type
11658
11659 The following options are mutually exclusive and specify what type of results
11660 the code block will return. By default, results are inserted as either a
11661 table or scalar depending on their value.
11662
11663 @itemize @bullet
11664 @item @code{table}, @code{vector}
11665 The results should be interpreted as an Org-mode table. If a single value is
11666 returned, it will be converted into a table with one row and one column.
11667 E.g., @code{:results value table}.
11668 @item @code{scalar}, @code{verbatim}
11669 The results should be interpreted literally---they will not be
11670 converted into a table. The results will be inserted into the Org-mode
11671 buffer as quoted text. E.g., @code{:results value verbatim}.
11672 @item @code{file}
11673 The results will be interpreted as the path to a file, and will be inserted
11674 into the Org-mode buffer as a file link. E.g., @code{:results value file}.
11675 @item @code{raw}, @code{org}
11676 The results are interpreted as raw Org-mode code and are inserted directly
11677 into the buffer. If the results look like a table they will be aligned as
11678 such by Org-mode. E.g., @code{:results value raw}.
11679 @item @code{html}
11680 Results are assumed to be HTML and will be enclosed in a @code{begin_html}
11681 block. E.g., @code{:results value html}.
11682 @item @code{latex}
11683 Results assumed to be LaTeX and are enclosed in a @code{begin_latex} block.
11684 E.g., @code{:results value latex}.
11685 @item @code{code}
11686 Result are assumed to be parseable code and are enclosed in a code block.
11687 E.g., @code{:results value code}.
11688 @item @code{pp}
11689 The result is converted to pretty-printed code and is enclosed in a code
11690 block. This option currently supports Emacs Lisp, python, and ruby. E.g.,
11691 @code{:results value pp}.
11692 @end itemize
11693
11694 @subsubheading Handling
11695 The following results options indicate what happens with the
11696 results once they are collected.
11697
11698 @itemize @bullet
11699 @item @code{silent}
11700 The results will be echoed in the minibuffer but will not be inserted into
11701 the Org-mode buffer. E.g., @code{:results output silent}.
11702 @item @code{replace}
11703 The default value. Any existing results will be removed, and the new results
11704 will be inserted into the Org-mode buffer in their place. E.g.,
11705 @code{:results output replace}.
11706 @item @code{append}
11707 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
11708 be appended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
11709 inserted as with @code{replace}.
11710 @item @code{prepend}
11711 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
11712 be prepended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
11713 inserted as with @code{replace}.
11714 @end itemize
11715
11716 @node file, dir, results, Specific header arguments
11717 @subsubsection @code{:file}
11718
11719 The header argument @code{:file} is used to specify a path for file output.
11720 An Org-mode style @code{file:} link is inserted into the buffer as the result
11721 (see @ref{Link format}). Common examples are graphical output from R,
11722 gnuplot, ditaa and LaTeX code blocks.
11723
11724 Note that for some languages, including R, gnuplot, LaTeX and ditaa,
11725 graphical output is sent to the specified file without the file being
11726 referenced explicitly in the code block. See the documentation for the
11727 individual languages for details. In contrast, general purpose languages such
11728 as python and ruby require that the code explicitly create output
11729 corresponding to the path indicated by @code{:file}.
11730
11731
11732 @node dir, exports, file, Specific header arguments
11733 @subsubsection @code{:dir} and remote execution
11734
11735 While the @code{:file} header argument can be used to specify the path to the
11736 output file, @code{:dir} specifies the default directory during code block
11737 execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with the current
11738 buffer is used. In other words, supplying @code{:dir path} temporarily has
11739 the same effect as changing the current directory with @kbd{M-x cd path}, and
11740 then not supplying @code{:dir}. Under the surface, @code{:dir} simply sets
11741 the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}.
11742
11743 When using @code{:dir}, you should supply a relative path for file output
11744 (e.g. @code{:file myfile.jpg} or @code{:file results/myfile.jpg}) in which
11745 case that path will be interpreted relative to the default directory.
11746
11747 In other words, if you want your plot to go into a folder called Work in your
11748 home directory, you could use
11749
11750 @example
11751 #+begin_src R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work
11752 matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l")
11753 #+end_src
11754 @end example
11755
11756 @subsubheading Remote execution
11757 A directory on a remote machine can be specified using tramp file syntax, in
11758 which case the code will be evaluated on the remote machine. An example is
11759
11760 @example
11761 #+begin_src R :file plot.png :dir /dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:
11762 plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE))
11763 #+end_src
11764 @end example
11765
11766 Text results will be returned to the local Org-mode buffer as usual, and file
11767 output will be created on the remote machine with relative paths interpreted
11768 relative to the remote directory. An Org-mode link to the remote file will be
11769 created.
11770
11771 So, in the above example a plot will be created on the remote machine,
11772 and a link of the following form will be inserted in the org buffer:
11773
11774 @example
11775 [[file:/scp:dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]]
11776 @end example
11777
11778 Most of this functionality follows immediately from the fact that @code{:dir}
11779 sets the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}, thanks to
11780 tramp. Those using XEmacs, or GNU Emacs prior to version 23 may need to
11781 install tramp separately in order for the these features to work correctly.
11782
11783 @subsubheading Further points
11784
11785 @itemize @bullet
11786 @item
11787 If @code{:dir} is used in conjunction with @code{:session}, although it will
11788 determine the starting directory for a new session as expected, no attempt is
11789 currently made to alter the directory associated with an existing session.
11790 @item
11791 @code{:dir} should typically not be used to create files during export with
11792 @code{:exports results} or @code{:exports both}. The reason is that, in order
11793 to retain portability of exported material between machines, during export
11794 links inserted into the buffer will *not* be expanded against @code{default
11795 directory}. Therefore, if @code{default-directory} is altered using
11796 @code{:dir}, it is probable that the file will be created in a location to
11797 which the link does not point.
11798 @end itemize
11799
11800 @node exports, tangle, dir, Specific header arguments
11801 @subsubsection @code{:exports}
11802
11803 The @code{:exports} header argument specifies what should be included in HTML
11804 or LaTeX exports of the Org-mode file.
11805
11806 @itemize @bullet
11807 @item @code{code}
11808 The default. The body of code is included into the exported file. E.g.,
11809 @code{:exports code}.
11810 @item @code{results}
11811 The result of evaluating the code is included in the exported file. E.g.,
11812 @code{:exports results}.
11813 @item @code{both}
11814 Both the code and results are included in the exported file. E.g.,
11815 @code{:exports both}.
11816 @item @code{none}
11817 Nothing is included in the exported file. E.g., @code{:exports none}.
11818 @end itemize
11819
11820 @node tangle, comments, exports, Specific header arguments
11821 @subsubsection @code{:tangle}
11822
11823 The @code{:tangle} header argument specifies whether or not the code
11824 block should be included in tangled extraction of source code files.
11825
11826 @itemize @bullet
11827 @item @code{yes}
11828 The code block is exported to a source code file named after the
11829 basename (name w/o extension) of the Org-mode file. E.g., @code{:tangle
11830 yes}.
11831 @item @code{no}
11832 The default. The code block is not exported to a source code file.
11833 E.g., @code{:tangle no}.
11834 @item other
11835 Any other string passed to the @code{:tangle} header argument is interpreted
11836 as a file basename to which the block will be exported. E.g., @code{:tangle
11837 basename}.
11838 @end itemize
11839
11840 @node comments, no-expand, tangle, Specific header arguments
11841 @subsubsection @code{:comments}
11842 By default code blocks are tangled to source-code files without any insertion
11843 of comments beyond those which may already exist in the body of the code
11844 block. The @code{:comments} header argument can be set to ``yes''
11845 e.g. @code{:comments yes} to enable the insertion of comments around code
11846 blocks during tangling. The inserted comments contain pointers back to the
11847 original Org file from which the comment was tangled.
11848
11849 @node no-expand, session, comments, Specific header arguments
11850 @subsubsection @code{:no-expand}
11851
11852 By default, code blocks are expanded with @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
11853 during tangling. This has the effect of assigning values to variables
11854 specified with @code{:var} (see @ref{var}), and of replacing ``noweb''
11855 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) with their targets. The
11856 @code{:no-expand} header argument can be used to turn off this behavior.
11857
11858 @node session, noweb, no-expand, Specific header arguments
11859 @subsubsection @code{:session}
11860
11861 The @code{:session} header argument starts a session for an interpreted
11862 language where state is preserved.
11863
11864 By default, a session is not started.
11865
11866 A string passed to the @code{:session} header argument will give the session
11867 a name. This makes it possible to run concurrent sessions for each
11868 interpreted language.
11869
11870 @node noweb, cache, session, Specific header arguments
11871 @subsubsection @code{:noweb}
11872
11873 The @code{:noweb} header argument controls expansion of ``noweb'' style (see
11874 @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) references in a code block. This header
11875 argument can have one of two values: @code{yes} or @code{no}.
11876
11877 @itemize @bullet
11878 @item @code{no}
11879 The default. No ``noweb'' syntax specific action is taken on evaluating
11880 code blocks, However, noweb references will still be expanded during
11881 tangling.
11882 @item @code{yes}
11883 All ``noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
11884 expanded before the block is evaluated.
11885 @end itemize
11886
11887 @subsubheading Noweb prefix lines
11888 Noweb insertions are now placed behind the line prefix of the
11889 @code{<<reference>>}.
11890 This behavior is illustrated in the following example. Because the
11891 @code{<<example>>} noweb reference appears behind the SQL comment syntax,
11892 each line of the expanded noweb reference will be commented.
11893
11894 This code block:
11895
11896 @example
11897 -- <<example>>
11898 @end example
11899
11900
11901 expands to:
11902
11903 @example
11904 -- this is the
11905 -- multi-line body of example
11906 @end example
11907
11908 Note that noweb replacement text that does not contain any newlines will not
11909 be affected by this change, so it is still possible to use inline noweb
11910 references.
11911
11912 @node cache, hlines, noweb, Specific header arguments
11913 @subsubsection @code{:cache}
11914
11915 The @code{:cache} header argument controls the use of in-buffer caching of
11916 the results of evaluating code blocks. It can be used to avoid re-evaluating
11917 unchanged code blocks. This header argument can have one of two
11918 values: @code{yes} or @code{no}.
11919
11920 @itemize @bullet
11921 @item @code{no}
11922 The default. No caching takes place, and the code block will be evaluated
11923 every time it is called.
11924 @item @code{yes}
11925 Every time the code block is run a sha1 hash of the code and arguments
11926 passed to the block will be generated. This hash is packed into the
11927 @code{#+results:} line and will be checked on subsequent
11928 executions of the code block. If the code block has not
11929 changed since the last time it was evaluated, it will not be re-evaluated.
11930 @end itemize
11931
11932 @node hlines, colnames, cache, Specific header arguments
11933 @subsubsection @code{:hlines}
11934
11935 Tables are frequently represented with one or more horizontal lines, or
11936 hlines. The @code{:hlines} argument to a code block accepts the
11937 values @code{yes} or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
11938
11939 @itemize @bullet
11940 @item @code{no}
11941 Strips horizontal lines from the input table. In most languages this is the
11942 desired effect because an @code{hline} symbol is interpreted as an unbound
11943 variable and raises an error. Setting @code{:hlines no} or relying on the
11944 default value yields the following results.
11945
11946 @example
11947 #+tblname: many-cols
11948 | a | b | c |
11949 |---+---+---|
11950 | d | e | f |
11951 |---+---+---|
11952 | g | h | i |
11953
11954 #+source: echo-table
11955 #+begin_src python :var tab=many-cols
11956 return tab
11957 #+end_src
11958
11959 #+results: echo-table
11960 | a | b | c |
11961 | d | e | f |
11962 | g | h | i |
11963 @end example
11964
11965 @item @code{yes}
11966 Leaves hlines in the table. Setting @code{:hlines yes} has this effect.
11967
11968 @example
11969 #+tblname: many-cols
11970 | a | b | c |
11971 |---+---+---|
11972 | d | e | f |
11973 |---+---+---|
11974 | g | h | i |
11975
11976 #+source: echo-table
11977 #+begin_src python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes
11978 return tab
11979 #+end_src
11980
11981 #+results: echo-table
11982 | a | b | c |
11983 |---+---+---|
11984 | d | e | f |
11985 |---+---+---|
11986 | g | h | i |
11987 @end example
11988 @end itemize
11989
11990 @node colnames, rownames, hlines, Specific header arguments
11991 @subsubsection @code{:colnames}
11992
11993 The @code{:colnames} header argument accepts the values @code{yes},
11994 @code{no}, or @code{nil} for unassigned. The default value is @code{nil}.
11995
11996 @itemize @bullet
11997 @item @code{nil}
11998 If an input table looks like it has column names
11999 (because its second row is an hline), then the column
12000 names will be removed from the table before
12001 processing, then reapplied to the results.
12002
12003 @example
12004 #+tblname: less-cols
12005 | a |
12006 |---|
12007 | b |
12008 | c |
12009
12010 #+srcname: echo-table-again
12011 #+begin_src python :var tab=less-cols
12012 return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab]
12013 #+end_src
12014
12015 #+results: echo-table-again
12016 | a |
12017 |----|
12018 | b* |
12019 | c* |
12020 @end example
12021
12022 @item @code{no}
12023 No column name pre-processing takes place
12024
12025 @item @code{yes}
12026 Column names are removed and reapplied as with @code{nil} even if the table
12027 does not ``look like'' it has column names (i.e. the second row is not an
12028 hline)
12029 @end itemize
12030
12031 @node rownames, shebang, colnames, Specific header arguments
12032 @subsubsection @code{:rownames}
12033
12034 The @code{:rownames} header argument can take on the values @code{yes}
12035 or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
12036
12037 @itemize @bullet
12038 @item @code{no}
12039 No row name pre-processing will take place.
12040
12041 @item @code{yes}
12042 The first column of the table is removed from the table before processing,
12043 and is then reapplied to the results.
12044
12045 @example
12046 #+tblname: with-rownames
12047 | one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 |
12048 | two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
12049
12050 #+srcname: echo-table-once-again
12051 #+begin_src python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes
12052 return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab]
12053 #+end_src
12054
12055 #+results: echo-table-once-again
12056 | one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 |
12057 | two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 |
12058 @end example
12059 @end itemize
12060
12061 @node shebang, eval, rownames, Specific header arguments
12062 @subsubsection @code{:shebang}
12063
12064 Setting the @code{:shebang} header argument to a string value
12065 (e.g. @code{:shebang "#!/bin/bash"}) causes the string to be inserted as the
12066 first line of any tangled file holding the code block, and the file
12067 permissions of the tangled file are set to make it executable.
12068
12069 @node eval, , shebang, Specific header arguments
12070 @subsubsection @code{:eval}
12071 The @code{:eval} header argument can be used to limit the evaluation of
12072 specific code blocks. @code{:eval} accepts two arguments ``never'' and
12073 ``query''. @code{:eval never} will ensure that a code block is never
12074 evaluated, this can be useful for protecting against the evaluation of
12075 dangerous code blocks. @code{:eval query} will require a query for every
12076 execution of a code block regardless of the value of the
12077 @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable.
12078
12079 @node Results of evaluation, Noweb reference syntax, Header arguments, Working With Source Code
12080 @section Results of evaluation
12081 @cindex code block, results of evaluation
12082 @cindex source code, results of evaluation
12083
12084 The way in which results are handled depends on whether a session is invoked,
12085 as well as on whether @code{:results value} or @code{:results output} is
12086 used. The following table shows the possibilities:
12087
12088 @multitable @columnfractions 0.26 0.33 0.41
12089 @item @tab @b{Non-session} @tab @b{Session}
12090 @item @code{:results value} @tab value of last expression @tab value of last expression
12091 @item @code{:results output} @tab contents of STDOUT @tab concatenation of interpreter output
12092 @end multitable
12093
12094 Note: With @code{:results value}, the result in both @code{:session} and
12095 non-session is returned to Org-mode as a table (a one- or two-dimensional
12096 vector of strings or numbers) when appropriate.
12097
12098 @subsection Non-session
12099 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
12100 This is the default. Internally, the value is obtained by wrapping the code
12101 in a function definition in the external language, and evaluating that
12102 function. Therefore, code should be written as if it were the body of such a
12103 function. In particular, note that python does not automatically return a
12104 value from a function unless a @code{return} statement is present, and so a
12105 @samp{return} statement will usually be required in python.
12106
12107 This is the only one of the four evaluation contexts in which the code is
12108 automatically wrapped in a function definition.
12109
12110 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
12111 The code is passed to the interpreter as an external process, and the
12112 contents of the standard output stream are returned as text. (In certain
12113 languages this also contains the error output stream; this is an area for
12114 future work.)
12115
12116 @subsection @code{:session}
12117 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
12118 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
12119 inferior process. The result returned is the result of the last evaluation
12120 performed by the interpreter. (This is obtained in a language-specific
12121 manner: the value of the variable @code{_} in python and ruby, and the value
12122 of @code{.Last.value} in R).
12123
12124 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
12125 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
12126 inferior process. The result returned is the concatenation of the sequence of
12127 (text) output from the interactive interpreter. Notice that this is not
12128 necessarily the same as what would be sent to @code{STDOUT} if the same code
12129 were passed to a non-interactive interpreter running as an external
12130 process. For example, compare the following two blocks:
12131
12132 @example
12133 #+begin_src python :results output
12134 print "hello"
12135 2
12136 print "bye"
12137 #+end_src
12138
12139 #+resname:
12140 : hello
12141 : bye
12142 @end example
12143
12144 In non-session mode, the '2' is not printed and does not appear.
12145 @example
12146 #+begin_src python :results output :session
12147 print "hello"
12148 2
12149 print "bye"
12150 #+end_src
12151
12152 #+resname:
12153 : hello
12154 : 2
12155 : bye
12156 @end example
12157
12158 But in @code{:session} mode, the interactive interpreter receives input '2'
12159 and prints out its value, '2'. (Indeed, the other print statements are
12160 unnecessary here).
12161
12162 @node Noweb reference syntax, Key bindings and useful functions, Results of evaluation, Working With Source Code
12163 @section Noweb reference syntax
12164 @cindex code block, noweb reference
12165 @cindex syntax, noweb
12166 @cindex source code, noweb reference
12167
12168 The ``noweb'' (see @uref{http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/}) Literate
12169 Programming system allows named blocks of code to be referenced by using the
12170 familiar Noweb syntax:
12171
12172 @example
12173 <<code-block-name>>
12174 @end example
12175
12176 When a code block is tangled or evaluated, whether or not ``noweb''
12177 references are expanded depends upon the value of the @code{:noweb} header
12178 argument. If @code{:noweb yes}, then a Noweb reference is expanded before
12179 evaluation. If @code{:noweb no}, the default, then the reference is not
12180 expanded before evaluation.
12181
12182 Note: the default value, @code{:noweb no}, was chosen to ensure that
12183 correct code is not broken in a language, such as Ruby, where
12184 @code{<<arg>>} is a syntactically valid construct. If @code{<<arg>>} is not
12185 syntactically valid in languages that you use, then please consider setting
12186 the default value.
12187
12188 @node Key bindings and useful functions, Batch execution, Noweb reference syntax, Working With Source Code
12189 @section Key bindings and useful functions
12190 @cindex code block, key bindings
12191
12192 Many common Org-mode key sequences are re-bound depending on
12193 the context.
12194
12195 Within a code block, the following key bindings
12196 are active:
12197
12198 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12199 @kindex C-c C-c
12200 @item @kbd{C-c C-c} @tab org-babel-execute-src-block
12201 @kindex C-c C-o
12202 @item @kbd{C-c C-o} @tab org-babel-open-src-block-result
12203 @kindex C-up
12204 @item @kbd{C-@key{up}} @tab org-babel-load-in-session
12205 @kindex M-down
12206 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab org-babel-pop-to-session
12207 @end multitable
12208
12209 In an Org-mode buffer, the following key bindings are active:
12210
12211 @multitable @columnfractions 0.45 0.55
12212 @kindex C-c C-v a
12213 @kindex C-c C-v C-a
12214 @item @kbd{C-c C-v a} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab org-babel-sha1-hash
12215 @kindex C-c C-v b
12216 @kindex C-c C-v C-b
12217 @item @kbd{C-c C-v b} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab org-babel-execute-buffer
12218 @kindex C-c C-v f
12219 @kindex C-c C-v C-f
12220 @item @kbd{C-c C-v f} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab org-babel-tangle-file
12221 @kindex C-c C-v g
12222 @item @kbd{C-c C-v g} @tab org-babel-goto-named-source-block
12223 @kindex C-c C-v h
12224 @item @kbd{C-c C-v h} @tab org-babel-describe-bindings
12225 @kindex C-c C-v l
12226 @kindex C-c C-v C-l
12227 @item @kbd{C-c C-v l} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab org-babel-lob-ingest
12228 @kindex C-c C-v p
12229 @kindex C-c C-v C-p
12230 @item @kbd{C-c C-v p} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab org-babel-expand-src-block
12231 @kindex C-c C-v s
12232 @kindex C-c C-v C-s
12233 @item @kbd{C-c C-v s} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab org-babel-execute-subtree
12234 @kindex C-c C-v t
12235 @kindex C-c C-v C-t
12236 @item @kbd{C-c C-v t} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab org-babel-tangle
12237 @kindex C-c C-v z
12238 @kindex C-c C-v C-z
12239 @item @kbd{C-c C-v z} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab org-babel-switch-to-session
12240 @end multitable
12241
12242 @c When possible these keybindings were extended to work when the control key is
12243 @c kept pressed, resulting in the following additional keybindings.
12244
12245 @c @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12246 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab org-babel-sha1-hash
12247 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab org-babel-execute-buffer
12248 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab org-babel-tangle-file
12249 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab org-babel-lob-ingest
12250 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab org-babel-expand-src-block
12251 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab org-babel-execute-subtree
12252 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab org-babel-tangle
12253 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab org-babel-switch-to-session
12254 @c @end multitable
12255
12256 @node Batch execution, , Key bindings and useful functions, Working With Source Code
12257 @section Batch execution
12258 @cindex code block, batch execution
12259 @cindex source code, batch execution
12260
12261 It is possible to call functions from the command line. This shell
12262 script calls @code{org-babel-tangle} on every one of its arguments.
12263
12264 Be sure to adjust the paths to fit your system.
12265
12266 @example
12267 #!/bin/sh
12268 # -*- mode: shell-script -*-
12269 #
12270 # tangle a file with org-mode
12271 #
12272 DIR=`pwd`
12273 FILES=""
12274
12275 # wrap each argument in the code required to call tangle on it
12276 for i in $@@; do
12277 FILES="$FILES \"$i\""
12278 done
12279
12280 emacsclient \
12281 --eval "(progn
12282 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/lisp/\"))
12283 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/contrib/lisp/\"))
12284 (require 'org)(require 'org-exp)(require 'ob)(require 'ob-tangle)
12285 (mapc (lambda (file)
12286 (find-file (expand-file-name file \"$DIR\"))
12287 (org-babel-tangle)
12288 (kill-buffer)) '($FILES)))"
12289 @end example
12290
12291 @node Miscellaneous, Hacking, Working With Source Code, Top
12292 @chapter Miscellaneous
12293
12294 @menu
12295 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
12296 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
12297 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
12298 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
12299 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
12300 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
12301 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
12302 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
12303 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
12304 @end menu
12305
12306
12307 @node Completion, Speed keys, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
12308 @section Completion
12309 @cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
12310 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
12311 @cindex completion, of dictionary words
12312 @cindex completion, of option keywords
12313 @cindex completion, of tags
12314 @cindex completion, of property keys
12315 @cindex completion, of link abbreviations
12316 @cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
12317 @cindex TODO keywords completion
12318 @cindex dictionary word completion
12319 @cindex option keyword completion
12320 @cindex tag completion
12321 @cindex link abbreviations, completion of
12322
12323 Emacs would not be Emacs without completion, and Org-mode uses it whenever it
12324 makes sense. If you prefer an @i{iswitchb}- or @i{ido}-like interface for
12325 some of the completion prompts, you can specify your preference by setting at
12326 most one of the variables @code{org-completion-use-iswitchb}
12327 @code{org-completion-use-ido}.
12328
12329 Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
12330 not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
12331 the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
12332
12333 @table @kbd
12334 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
12335 @item M-@key{TAB}
12336 Complete word at point
12337 @itemize @bullet
12338 @item
12339 At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
12340 @item
12341 After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
12342 @item
12343 After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
12344 can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
12345 @item
12346 After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
12347 from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
12348 @samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
12349 dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
12350 @item
12351 After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
12352 of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
12353 buffer.
12354 @item
12355 After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
12356 @item
12357 After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
12358 @samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org-mode. When the
12359 option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
12360 will insert example settings for this keyword.
12361 @item
12362 In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
12363 i.e. valid keys for this line.
12364 @item
12365 Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
12366 @end itemize
12367 @end table
12368
12369 @node Speed keys, Code evaluation security, Completion, Miscellaneous
12370 @section Speed keys
12371 @cindex speed keys
12372 @vindex org-use-speed-commands
12373 @vindex org-speed-commands-user
12374
12375 Single keys can be made to execute commands when the cursor is at the
12376 beginning of a headline, i.e. before the first star. Configure the variable
12377 @code{org-use-speed-commands} to activate this feature. There is a
12378 pre-defined list of commands, and you can add more such commands using the
12379 variable @code{org-speed-commands-user}. Speed keys do not only speed up
12380 navigation and other commands, but they also provide an alternative way to
12381 execute commands bound to keys that are not or not easily available on a tty,
12382 or on a small mobile device with a limited keyboard.
12383
12384 To see which commands are available, activate the feature and press @kbd{?}
12385 with the cursor at the beginning of a headline.
12386
12387 @node Code evaluation security, Customization, Speed keys, Miscellaneous
12388 @section Code evaluation and security issues
12389
12390 Org provides tool to work with the code snippets, including evaluating them.
12391
12392 Running code on your machine always comes with a security risk. Badly
12393 written or malicious code can be executed on purpose or by accident. Org has
12394 default settings which will only evaluate such code if you give explicit
12395 permission to do so, and as a casual user of these features you should leave
12396 these precautions intact.
12397
12398 For people who regularly work with such code, the confirmation prompts can
12399 become annoying, and you might want to turn them off. This can be done, but
12400 you must be aware of the risks that are involved.
12401
12402 Code evaluation can happen under the following circumstances:
12403
12404 @table @i
12405 @item Source code blocks
12406 Source code blocks can be evaluated during export, or when pressing @kbd{C-c
12407 C-c} in the block. The most important thing to realize here is that Org mode
12408 files which contain code snippets are in a certain sense like executable
12409 files. So you should accept them and load them into Emacs only from trusted
12410 sources - just like you would do with a program you install on your computer.
12411
12412 Make sure you know what you are doing before customizing the variables
12413 which take of the default security brakes.
12414
12415 @defopt org-confirm-babel-evaluate
12416 When set to t user is queried before code block evaluation
12417 @end defopt
12418
12419 @item Following @code{shell} and @code{elisp} links
12420 Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (@pxref{External
12421 links}). These links can be problematic because the code to be evaluated his
12422 not visible.
12423
12424 @defopt org-confirm-shell-link-function
12425 Function to queries user about shell link execution.
12426 @end defopt
12427 @defopt org-confirm-elisp-link-function
12428 Functions to query user for Emacs Lisp link execution.
12429 @end defopt
12430
12431 @item Following @code{shell} and @code{elisp} links
12432 Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (@pxref{External
12433 links}). These links can be problematic because the code to be evaluated his
12434 not visible. @b{Security advice:} Do not use these links, use source code
12435 blocks which make the associated actions much more transparent.
12436
12437 @item Formulas in tables
12438 Formulas in tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}) are code that is evaluated
12439 either by the @i{calc} interpreter, or by the @i{Emacs Lisp} interpreter.
12440 @end table
12441
12442 @node Customization, In-buffer settings, Code evaluation security, Miscellaneous
12443 @section Customization
12444 @cindex customization
12445 @cindex options, for customization
12446 @cindex variables, for customization
12447
12448 There are more than 180 variables that can be used to customize
12449 Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
12450 describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
12451 variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select
12452 @code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
12453 settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
12454 lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
12455
12456 @node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
12457 @section Summary of in-buffer settings
12458 @cindex in-buffer settings
12459 @cindex special keywords
12460
12461 Org-mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
12462 per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
12463 keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
12464 setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
12465 lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
12466 the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
12467 buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
12468 activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
12469 when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
12470
12471 @vindex org-archive-location
12472 @table @kbd
12473 @item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
12474 This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
12475 all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
12476 of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
12477 The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
12478 @item #+CATEGORY:
12479 This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
12480 for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
12481 end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
12482 @item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
12483 @cindex property, COLUMNS
12484 Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
12485 columns view is invoked in locations where no @code{COLUMNS} property
12486 applies.
12487 @item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
12488 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
12489 @vindex org-table-formula
12490 Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
12491 line set the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
12492 The global version of this variable is
12493 @code{org-table-formula-constants}.
12494 @item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
12495 Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
12496 top-level entries.
12497 @item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
12498 @vindex org-drawers
12499 Set the file-local set of drawers. The corresponding global variable is
12500 @code{org-drawers}.
12501 @item #+LINK: linkword replace
12502 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
12503 These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
12504 @xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
12505 @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
12506 @item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
12507 @vindex org-highest-priority
12508 @vindex org-lowest-priority
12509 @vindex org-default-priority
12510 This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
12511 must be either letters A-Z or numbers 0-9. The highest priority must
12512 have a lower ASCII number that the lowest priority.
12513 @item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
12514 This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
12515 buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
12516 @cindex #+SETUPFILE
12517 @item #+SETUPFILE: file
12518 This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
12519 entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
12520 (i.e. when starting Org-mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
12521 settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
12522 as if they had been included in the buffer. In particular, the file can be
12523 any other Org-mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
12524 cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
12525 @item #+STARTUP:
12526 @cindex #+STARTUP:
12527 This line sets options to be used at startup of Org-mode, when an
12528 Org file is being visited.
12529
12530 The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline
12531 tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is
12532 @code{org-startup-folded}, with a default value @code{t}, which means
12533 @code{overview}.
12534 @vindex org-startup-folded
12535 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
12536 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
12537 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
12538 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
12539 @example
12540 overview @r{top-level headlines only}
12541 content @r{all headlines}
12542 showall @r{no folding of any entries}
12543 showeverything @r{show even drawer contents}
12544 @end example
12545
12546 @vindex org-startup-indented
12547 @cindex @code{indent}, STARTUP keyword
12548 @cindex @code{noindent}, STARTUP keyword
12549 Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
12550 @code{org-startup-indented}@footnote{Emacs 23 and Org-mode 6.29 are required}
12551 @example
12552 indent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned on}
12553 noindent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned off}
12554 @end example
12555
12556 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
12557 Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
12558 is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
12559 variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
12560 @code{nil}.
12561 @cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
12562 @cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
12563 @example
12564 align @r{align all tables}
12565 noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
12566 @end example
12567 @vindex org-log-done
12568 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
12569 @vindex org-log-repeat
12570 Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be
12571 configured using these options (see variables @code{org-log-done},
12572 @code{org-log-note-clock-out} and @code{org-log-repeat})
12573 @cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
12574 @cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
12575 @cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
12576 @cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
12577 @cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
12578 @cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
12579 @cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
12580 @cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
12581 @cindex @code{logreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
12582 @cindex @code{lognotereschedule}, STARTUP keyword
12583 @cindex @code{nologreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
12584 @cindex @code{logredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
12585 @cindex @code{lognoteredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
12586 @cindex @code{nologredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
12587 @cindex @code{logrefile}, STARTUP keyword
12588 @cindex @code{lognoterefile}, STARTUP keyword
12589 @cindex @code{nologrefile}, STARTUP keyword
12590 @example
12591 logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
12592 lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
12593 nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
12594 logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
12595 lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
12596 nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
12597 lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
12598 nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
12599 logreschedule @r{record a timestamp when scheduling time changes}
12600 lognotereschedule @r{record a note when scheduling time changes}
12601 nologreschedule @r{do not record when a scheduling date changes}
12602 logredeadline @r{record a timestamp when deadline changes}
12603 lognoteredeadline @r{record a note when deadline changes}
12604 nologredeadline @r{do not record when a deadline date changes}
12605 logrefile @r{record a timestamp when refiling}
12606 lognoterefile @r{record a note when refiling}
12607 nologrefile @r{do not record when refiling}
12608 @end example
12609 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
12610 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
12611 Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
12612 indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
12613 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
12614 default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
12615 @cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
12616 @cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
12617 @cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
12618 @cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
12619 @example
12620 hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
12621 showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
12622 indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
12623 noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
12624 odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
12625 oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
12626 @end example
12627 @vindex org-put-time-stamp-overlays
12628 @vindex org-time-stamp-overlay-formats
12629 To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
12630 @code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
12631 @code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
12632 @cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
12633 @example
12634 customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
12635 @end example
12636 @vindex constants-unit-system
12637 The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
12638 @code{constants-unit-system}).
12639 @cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
12640 @cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
12641 @example
12642 constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
12643 constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
12644 @end example
12645 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
12646 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
12647 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
12648 To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
12649 corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline},
12650 @code{org-footnote-auto-label}, and @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.
12651 @cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
12652 @cindex @code{nofninline}, STARTUP keyword
12653 @cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
12654 @cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
12655 @cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
12656 @cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
12657 @cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
12658 @cindex @code{fnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
12659 @cindex @code{nofnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
12660 @example
12661 fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
12662 fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
12663 fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
12664 fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
12665 fnauto @r{create [fn:1]-like labels automatically (default)}
12666 fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
12667 fnplain @r{create [1]-like labels automatically}
12668 fnadjust @r{automatically renumber and sort footnotes}
12669 nofnadjust @r{do not renumber and sort automatically}
12670 @end example
12671 @cindex org-hide-block-startup
12672 To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is
12673 @code{org-hide-block-startup}.
12674 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
12675 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
12676 @example
12677 hideblocks @r{Hide all begin/end blocks on startup}
12678 nohideblocks @r{Do not hide blocks on startup}
12679 @end example
12680 @cindex org-pretty-entities
12681 The the display of entities as UTF8 characters is governed by the variable
12682 @code{org-pretty-entities} and the keywords
12683 @cindex @code{entitiespretty}, STARTUP keyword
12684 @cindex @code{entitiesplain}, STARTUP keyword
12685 @example
12686 entitiespretty @r{Show entities as UTF8 characters where possible}
12687 entitiesplain @r{Leave entities plain}
12688 @end example
12689 @item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
12690 @vindex org-tag-alist
12691 These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
12692 this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
12693 keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
12694 @item #+TBLFM:
12695 This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
12696 @item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+DATE:,
12697 @itemx #+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:, #+XSLT:,
12698 @itemx #+DESCRIPTION:, #+KEYWORDS:,
12699 @itemx #+LATEX_HEADER:, #+STYLE:, #+LINK_UP:, #+LINK_HOME:,
12700 @itemx #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:
12701 These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
12702 @ref{Export options}.
12703 @item #+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
12704 @vindex org-todo-keywords
12705 These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
12706 current file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-todo-keywords}.
12707 @end table
12708
12709 @node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
12710 @section The very busy C-c C-c key
12711 @kindex C-c C-c
12712 @cindex C-c C-c, overview
12713
12714 The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
12715 mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
12716 this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
12717 other circumstances it means something like @emph{``Hey Org, look
12718 here and update according to what you see here''}. Here is a summary of
12719 what this means in different contexts.
12720
12721 @itemize @minus
12722 @item
12723 If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
12724 tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
12725 @item
12726 If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
12727 triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
12728 information.
12729 @item
12730 If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
12731 works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
12732 @item
12733 If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
12734 the entire table.
12735 @item
12736 If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file it.
12737 With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
12738 default location.
12739 @item
12740 If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
12741 corresponding links in this buffer.
12742 @item
12743 If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
12744 drawer, offer property commands.
12745 @item
12746 If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
12747 definition, and vice versa.
12748 @item
12749 If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it.
12750 @item
12751 If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
12752 of the checkbox.
12753 @item
12754 If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
12755 ordered list.
12756 @item
12757 If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamic block, the
12758 block is updated.
12759 @end itemize
12760
12761 @node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
12762 @section A cleaner outline view
12763 @cindex hiding leading stars
12764 @cindex dynamic indentation
12765 @cindex odd-levels-only outlines
12766 @cindex clean outline view
12767
12768 Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines start with a
12769 potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines is not
12770 indented. While this is no problem when writing a @emph{book-like} document
12771 where the outline headings are really section headings, in a more
12772 @emph{list-oriented} outline, indented structure is a lot cleaner:
12773
12774 @example
12775 @group
12776 * Top level headline | * Top level headline
12777 ** Second level | * Second level
12778 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
12779 some text | some text
12780 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
12781 more text | more text
12782 * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
12783 @end group
12784 @end example
12785
12786 @noindent
12787
12788 If you are using at least Emacs 23.2@footnote{Emacs 23.1 can actually crash
12789 with @code{org-indent-mode}} and version 6.29 of Org, this kind of view can
12790 be achieved dynamically at display time using @code{org-indent-mode}. In
12791 this minor mode, all lines are prefixed for display with the necessary amount
12792 of space@footnote{@code{org-indent-mode} also sets the @code{wrap-prefix}
12793 property, such that @code{visual-line-mode} (or purely setting
12794 @code{word-wrap}) wraps long lines (including headlines) correctly indented.
12795 }. Also headlines are prefixed with additional stars, so that the amount of
12796 indentation shifts by two@footnote{See the variable
12797 @code{org-indent-indentation-per-level}.} spaces per level. All headline
12798 stars but the last one are made invisible using the @code{org-hide}
12799 face@footnote{Turning on @code{org-indent-mode} sets
12800 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} to @code{t} and @code{org-adapt-indentation} to
12801 @code{nil}.} - see below under @samp{2.} for more information on how this
12802 works. You can turn on @code{org-indent-mode} for all files by customizing
12803 the variable @code{org-startup-indented}, or you can turn it on for
12804 individual files using
12805
12806 @example
12807 #+STARTUP: indent
12808 @end example
12809
12810 If you want a similar effect in earlier version of Emacs and/or Org, or if
12811 you want the indentation to be hard space characters so that the plain text
12812 file looks as similar as possible to the Emacs display, Org supports you in
12813 the following way:
12814
12815 @enumerate
12816 @item
12817 @emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
12818 You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
12819 with the headline, like
12820
12821 @example
12822 *** 3rd level
12823 more text, now indented
12824 @end example
12825
12826 @vindex org-adapt-indentation
12827 Org supports this with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure
12828 editing@footnote{See also the variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.},
12829 preserving or adapting the indentation as appropriate.
12830
12831 @item
12832 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
12833 @emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
12834 all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
12835 the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
12836 with
12837
12838 @example
12839 #+STARTUP: hidestars
12840 #+STARTUP: showstars
12841 @end example
12842
12843 With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
12844
12845 @example
12846 @group
12847 * Top level headline
12848 * Second level
12849 * 3rd level
12850 ...
12851 @end group
12852 @end example
12853
12854 @noindent
12855 @vindex org-hide @r{(face)}
12856 The leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they are only
12857 fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the background color as
12858 font color. If you are not using either white or black background, you may
12859 have to customize this face to get the wanted effect. Another possibility is
12860 to set this font such that the extra stars are @i{almost} invisible, for
12861 example using the color @code{grey90} on a white background.
12862
12863 @item
12864 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
12865 Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
12866 levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
12867 to the next@footnote{When you need to specify a level for a property search
12868 or refile targets, @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars, etc@.}. In this
12869 way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of this section. In order
12870 to make the structure editing and export commands handle this convention
12871 correctly, configure the variable @code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on
12872 a per-file basis with one of the following lines:
12873
12874 @example
12875 #+STARTUP: odd
12876 #+STARTUP: oddeven
12877 @end example
12878
12879 You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
12880 double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
12881 RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
12882 org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
12883 @end enumerate
12884
12885 @node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
12886 @section Using Org on a tty
12887 @cindex tty key bindings
12888
12889 Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default many of
12890 Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
12891 accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
12892 @key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
12893 together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
12894 these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
12895 alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
12896 more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
12897 customized workaround suits you better. For example, changing a timestamp
12898 is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
12899 tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
12900
12901 @multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.1 0.2
12902 @item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Speed key} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
12903 @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C} @tab
12904 @item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
12905 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab @kbd{L} @tab
12906 @item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{r} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
12907 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab @kbd{R} @tab
12908 @item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
12909 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab @kbd{U} @tab
12910 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
12911 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab @kbd{D} @tab
12912 @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
12913 @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
12914 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
12915 @item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
12916 @item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
12917 @item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
12918 @item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
12919 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
12920 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
12921 @end multitable
12922
12923
12924 @node Interaction, , TTY keys, Miscellaneous
12925 @section Interaction with other packages
12926 @cindex packages, interaction with other
12927 Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
12928 with other code out there.
12929
12930 @menu
12931 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
12932 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
12933 @end menu
12934
12935 @node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
12936 @subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
12937
12938 @table @asis
12939 @cindex @file{calc.el}
12940 @cindex Gillespie, Dave
12941 @item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
12942 Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
12943 functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
12944 checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
12945 @code{calc-eval} which will have been autoloaded during setup if Calc has
12946 been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
12947 distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
12948 packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
12949 , Embedded Mode, Calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
12950 @item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
12951 @cindex @file{constants.el}
12952 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
12953 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
12954 In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
12955 names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
12956 constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
12957 the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
12958 and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
12959 @samp{Mega}, etc@. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
12960 at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
12961 the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
12962 setup. See the installation instructions in the file
12963 @file{constants.el}.
12964 @item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
12965 @cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
12966 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
12967 Org-mode can make use of the CDLa@TeX{} package to efficiently enter
12968 La@TeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
12969 @item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
12970 @cindex @file{imenu.el}
12971 Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org-mode
12972 supports Imenu---all you need to do to get the index is the following:
12973 @lisp
12974 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
12975 (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
12976 @end lisp
12977 @vindex org-imenu-depth
12978 By default the index is two levels deep---you can modify the depth using
12979 the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
12980 @item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
12981 @cindex @file{remember.el}
12982 @cindex Wiegley, John
12983 Org used to use this package for capture, but no longer does.
12984 @item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
12985 @cindex @file{speedbar.el}
12986 @cindex Ludlam, Eric M.
12987 Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
12988 index items in files. Org-mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
12989 drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows you to
12990 restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
12991 the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
12992 @cindex @file{table.el}
12993 @item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
12994 @kindex C-c C-c
12995 @cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
12996 @cindex @file{table.el}
12997 @cindex Ota, Takaaki
12998
12999 Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and row-spanning,
13000 and alignment can be created using the Emacs table package by Takaaki Ota
13001 (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table}, and also part of Emacs 22).
13002 Org-mode will recognize these tables and export them properly. Because of
13003 interference with other Org-mode functionality, you unfortunately cannot edit
13004 these tables directly in the buffer. Instead, you need to use the command
13005 @kbd{C-c '} to edit them, similar to source code snippets.
13006
13007 @table @kbd
13008 @kindex C-c '
13009 @item C-c '
13010 Edit a @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a table.el table.
13011 @c
13012 @kindex C-c ~
13013 @item C-c ~
13014 Insert a @file{table.el} table. If there is already a table at point, this
13015 command converts it between the @file{table.el} format and the Org-mode
13016 format. See the documentation string of the command
13017 @code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
13018 possible.
13019 @end table
13020 @file{table.el} is part of Emacs since Emacs 22.
13021 @item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
13022 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
13023 @cindex Baur, Steven L.
13024 Org-mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package.
13025 However, Org-mode also has its own footnote support (@pxref{Footnotes}),
13026 which makes using @file{footnote.el} unnecessary.
13027 @end table
13028
13029 @node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
13030 @subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org-mode
13031
13032 @table @asis
13033
13034 @cindex @code{shift-selection-mode}
13035 @vindex org-support-shift-select
13036 In Emacs 23, @code{shift-selection-mode} is on by default, meaning that
13037 cursor motions combined with the shift key should start or enlarge regions.
13038 This conflicts with the use of @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands in Org to change
13039 timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types if the cursor is
13040 at such a location. By default, @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands outside
13041 special contexts don't do anything, but you can customize the variable
13042 @code{org-support-shift-select}. Org-mode then tries to accommodate shift
13043 selection by (i) using it outside of the special contexts where special
13044 commands apply, and by (ii) extending an existing active region even if the
13045 cursor moves across a special context.
13046
13047 @item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
13048 @cindex @file{CUA.el}
13049 @cindex Storm, Kim. F.
13050 @vindex org-replace-disputed-keys
13051 Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by CUA mode
13052 (as well as @code{pc-select-mode} and @code{s-region-mode}) to select and extend the
13053 region. In fact, Emacs 23 has this built-in in the form of
13054 @code{shift-selection-mode}, see previous paragraph. If you are using Emacs
13055 23, you probably don't want to use another package for this purpose. However,
13056 if you prefer to leave these keys to a different package while working in
13057 Org-mode, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set,
13058 Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda
13059 buffer (but not during date selection).
13060
13061 @example
13062 S-UP -> M-p S-DOWN -> M-n
13063 S-LEFT -> M-- S-RIGHT -> M-+
13064 C-S-LEFT -> M-S-- C-S-RIGHT -> M-S-+
13065 @end example
13066
13067 @vindex org-disputed-keys
13068 Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
13069 to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
13070 @code{org-disputed-keys}.
13071
13072 @item @file{yasnippet.el}
13073 @cindex @file{yasnippet.el}
13074 The way Org-mode binds the TAB key (binding to @code{[tab]} instead of
13075 @code{"\t"}) overrules yasnippets' access to this key. The following code
13076 fixed this problem:
13077
13078 @lisp
13079 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
13080 (lambda ()
13081 (org-set-local 'yas/trigger-key [tab])
13082 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-group)))
13083 @end lisp
13084
13085 @item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
13086 @cindex @file{windmove.el}
13087 This package also uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
13088 in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you want make
13089 the windmove function active in locations where Org-mode does not have
13090 special functionality on @kbd{S-@key{cursor}}, add this to your
13091 configuration:
13092
13093 @lisp
13094 ;; Make windmove work in org-mode:
13095 (add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up)
13096 (add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left)
13097 (add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down)
13098 (add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right)
13099 @end lisp
13100
13101 @item @file{viper.el} by Michael Kifer
13102 @cindex @file{viper.el}
13103 @kindex C-c /
13104 Viper uses @kbd{C-c /} and therefore makes this key not access the
13105 corresponding Org-mode command @code{org-sparse-tree}. You need to find
13106 another key for this command, or override the key in
13107 @code{viper-vi-global-user-map} with
13108
13109 @lisp
13110 (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
13111 @end lisp
13112
13113 @end table
13114
13115
13116 @node Hacking, MobileOrg, Miscellaneous, Top
13117 @appendix Hacking
13118 @cindex hacking
13119
13120 This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
13121 Org.
13122
13123 @menu
13124 * Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
13125 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
13126 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
13127 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
13128 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for La@TeX{} and other programs
13129 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
13130 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
13131 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
13132 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
13133 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
13134 @end menu
13135
13136 @node Hooks, Add-on packages, Hacking, Hacking
13137 @section Hooks
13138 @cindex hooks
13139
13140 Org has a large number of hook variables that can be used to add
13141 functionality. This appendix about hacking is going to illustrate the
13142 use of some of them. A complete list of all hooks with documentation is
13143 maintained by the Worg project and can be found at
13144 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-configs/org-hooks.php}.
13145
13146 @node Add-on packages, Adding hyperlink types, Hooks, Hacking
13147 @section Add-on packages
13148 @cindex add-on packages
13149
13150 A large number of add-on packages have been written by various authors.
13151 These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed
13152 packages with the separate release available at the Org-mode home page at
13153 @uref{http://orgmode.org}. The list of contributed packages, along with
13154 documentation about each package, is maintained by the Worg project at
13155 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/}.
13156
13157
13158
13159 @node Adding hyperlink types, Context-sensitive commands, Add-on packages, Hacking
13160 @section Adding hyperlink types
13161 @cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
13162
13163 Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
13164 (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, Org
13165 provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file,
13166 @file{org-man.el}, that will add support for creating links like
13167 @samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
13168 Emacs:
13169
13170 @lisp
13171 ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
13172
13173 (require 'org)
13174
13175 (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
13176 (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
13177
13178 (defcustom org-man-command 'man
13179 "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
13180 :group 'org-link
13181 :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
13182
13183 (defun org-man-open (path)
13184 "Visit the manpage on PATH.
13185 PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
13186 (funcall org-man-command path))
13187
13188 (defun org-man-store-link ()
13189 "Store a link to a manpage."
13190 (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
13191 ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
13192 (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
13193 (link (concat "man:" page))
13194 (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
13195 (org-store-link-props
13196 :type "man"
13197 :link link
13198 :description description))))
13199
13200 (defun org-man-get-page-name ()
13201 "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
13202 ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
13203 (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
13204 (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
13205 (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
13206
13207 (provide 'org-man)
13208
13209 ;;; org-man.el ends here
13210 @end lisp
13211
13212 @noindent
13213 You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
13214
13215 @lisp
13216 (require 'org-man)
13217 @end lisp
13218
13219 @noindent
13220 Let's go through the file and see what it does.
13221 @enumerate
13222 @item
13223 It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
13224 loaded.
13225 @item
13226 The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
13227 with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
13228 that will be called to follow such a link.
13229 @item
13230 @vindex org-store-link-functions
13231 The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
13232 order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
13233 buffer displaying a man page.
13234 @end enumerate
13235
13236 The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
13237 First there is a customization variable that determines which Emacs
13238 command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
13239 @code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
13240 defined. It gets the link path as an argument---in this case the link
13241 path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
13242 value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
13243
13244 Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
13245 to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, this function will be called to
13246 try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
13247 create the link for this buffer type; we do this by checking the value
13248 of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
13249 return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
13250 manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
13251 @samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
13252 and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
13253 can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
13254 the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
13255 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
13256
13257 When is makes sense for your new link type, you may also define a function
13258 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g. completion)
13259 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
13260 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
13261
13262 @node Context-sensitive commands, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
13263 @section Context-sensitive commands
13264 @cindex context-sensitive commands, hooks
13265 @cindex add-ons, context-sensitive commands
13266 @vindex org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook
13267
13268 Org has several commands that act differently depending on context. The most
13269 important example it the @kbd{C-c C-c} (@pxref{The very busy C-c C-c key}).
13270 Also the @kbd{M-cursor} and @kbd{M-S-cursor} keys have this property.
13271
13272 Add-ons can tap into this functionality by providing a function that detects
13273 special context for that add-on and executes functionality appropriate for
13274 the context. Here is an example from Dan Davison's @file{org-R.el} which
13275 allows you to evaluate commands based on the @file{R} programming language. For
13276 this package, special contexts are lines that start with @code{#+R:} or
13277 @code{#+RR:}.
13278
13279 @lisp
13280 (defun org-R-apply-maybe ()
13281 "Detect if this is context for org-R and execute R commands."
13282 (if (save-excursion
13283 (beginning-of-line 1)
13284 (looking-at "#\\+RR?:"))
13285 (progn (call-interactively 'org-R-apply)
13286 t) ;; to signal that we took action
13287 nil)) ;; to signal that we did not
13288
13289 (add-hook 'org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook 'org-R-apply-maybe)
13290 @end lisp
13291
13292 The function first checks if the cursor is in such a line. If that is the
13293 case, @code{org-R-apply} is called and the function returns @code{t} to
13294 signal that action was taken, and @kbd{C-c C-c} will stop looking for other
13295 contexts. If the function finds it should do nothing locally, it returns @code{nil} so that other, similar functions can have a try.
13296
13297
13298 @node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Context-sensitive commands, Hacking
13299 @section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
13300 @cindex tables, in other modes
13301 @cindex lists, in other modes
13302 @cindex Orgtbl mode
13303
13304 Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
13305 frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
13306 specific languages, for example La@TeX{}. However, this is extremely
13307 hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
13308 and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl-mode table
13309 editor.
13310
13311 This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
13312 table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
13313 function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
13314 @i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
13315 the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
13316 for a very flexible system.
13317
13318 Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists, in Orgstruct mode. You
13319 can use Org's facilities to edit and structure lists by turning
13320 @code{orgstruct-mode} on, then locally exporting such lists in another format
13321 (HTML, La@TeX{} or Texinfo.)
13322
13323
13324 @menu
13325 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
13326 * A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
13327 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
13328 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
13329 @end menu
13330
13331 @node Radio tables, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
13332 @subsection Radio tables
13333 @cindex radio tables
13334
13335 To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
13336 lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
13337 Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
13338 between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
13339
13340 @example
13341 /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
13342 /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
13343 @end example
13344
13345 @noindent
13346 Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
13347 Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
13348 example:
13349 @cindex #+ORGTBL
13350 @example
13351 #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
13352 @end example
13353
13354 @noindent
13355 @code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
13356 in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
13357 that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
13358 arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
13359 passed as a property list to the translation function for
13360 interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
13361 acted upon before the translation function is called:
13362
13363 @table @code
13364 @item :skip N
13365 Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
13366 this parameter!
13367
13368 @item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
13369 List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
13370 calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
13371 Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
13372 removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
13373 additional columns.
13374 @end table
13375
13376 @noindent
13377 The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
13378 without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
13379 compilation of a C file or processing of a La@TeX{} file. There are a
13380 number of different solutions:
13381
13382 @itemize @bullet
13383 @item
13384 The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
13385 language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
13386 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
13387 @item
13388 Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
13389 statement, for example @samp{\bye} in @TeX{} and @samp{\end@{document@}}
13390 in La@TeX{}.
13391 @item
13392 You can just comment the table line-by-line whenever you want to process
13393 the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
13394 only sounds tedious---the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment}
13395 makes this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
13396 key.
13397 @end itemize
13398
13399 @node A LaTeX example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
13400 @subsection A La@TeX{} example of radio tables
13401 @cindex La@TeX{}, and Orgtbl mode
13402
13403 The best way to wrap the source table in La@TeX{} is to use the
13404 @code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
13405 activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
13406 header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
13407 default this works only for La@TeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
13408 variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other
13409 modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will
13410 be prompted for a table name, let's say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
13411 will then get the following template:
13412
13413 @cindex #+ORGTBL, SEND
13414 @example
13415 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13416 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13417 \begin@{comment@}
13418 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
13419 | | |
13420 \end@{comment@}
13421 @end example
13422
13423 @noindent
13424 @vindex La@TeX{}-verbatim-environments
13425 The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
13426 @code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into La@TeX{} and to put it
13427 into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
13428 fill in the table, feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
13429 the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
13430 this may cause problems with font-lock in La@TeX{} mode. As shown in the
13431 example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
13432 @code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
13433 expressions. If you are using AUC@TeX{} with the font-latex library, a
13434 much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
13435 variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
13436
13437 @example
13438 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13439 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13440 \begin@{comment@}
13441 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
13442 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
13443 |-------+------+---------+---------|
13444 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
13445 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
13446 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
13447 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
13448 % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
13449 \end@{comment@}
13450 @end example
13451
13452 @noindent
13453 When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
13454 table inserted between the two marker lines.
13455
13456 Now let's assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
13457 want to control how columns are aligned, etc@. In this case we make sure
13458 that the table translator skips the first 2 lines of the source
13459 table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e. to not produce
13460 header and footer commands of the target table:
13461
13462 @example
13463 \begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
13464 Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
13465 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13466 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13467 \end@{tabular@}
13468 %
13469 \begin@{comment@}
13470 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
13471 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
13472 |-------+------+---------+---------|
13473 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
13474 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
13475 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
13476 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
13477 \end@{comment@}
13478 @end example
13479
13480 The La@TeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
13481 Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
13482 and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
13483 interprets the following parameters (see also @pxref{Translator functions}):
13484
13485 @table @code
13486 @item :splice nil/t
13487 When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
13488 tabular environment. Default is nil.
13489
13490 @item :fmt fmt
13491 A format to be used to wrap each field, it should contain @code{%s} for the
13492 original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
13493 you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
13494 column numbers and formats. for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
13495 A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
13496 function must return a formatted string.
13497
13498 @item :efmt efmt
13499 Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
13500 have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
13501 @code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
13502 may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
13503 @code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
13504 @code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
13505 applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
13506 supplied instead of strings.
13507 @end table
13508
13509 @node Translator functions, Radio lists, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
13510 @subsection Translator functions
13511 @cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
13512 @cindex translator function
13513
13514 Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
13515 (comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
13516 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
13517 Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
13518 code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
13519 translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
13520 itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
13521 @code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
13522 hands processing over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
13523
13524 @lisp
13525 @group
13526 (defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
13527 "Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
13528 (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
13529 org-table-last-alignment ""))
13530 (params2
13531 (list
13532 :tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
13533 :tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
13534 :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
13535 :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
13536 (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
13537 @end group
13538 @end lisp
13539
13540 As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
13541 @var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
13542 (variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e. the
13543 ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
13544 would like to use the La@TeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
13545 be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
13546 overrule the default with
13547
13548 @example
13549 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
13550 @end example
13551
13552 For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
13553 analogy with the La@TeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
13554 directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
13555 with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
13556 started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!}, and where the field
13557 separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
13558 a single line!):
13559
13560 @example
13561 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
13562 :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
13563 @end example
13564
13565 @noindent
13566 Please check the documentation string of the function
13567 @code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
13568 that function, and remember that you can pass each of them into
13569 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
13570 using the generic function.
13571
13572 Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
13573 things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
13574 two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
13575 line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
13576 argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
13577 @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
13578 containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
13579 translator, please post it on @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
13580 others can benefit from your work.
13581
13582 @node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
13583 @subsection Radio lists
13584 @cindex radio lists
13585 @cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
13586
13587 Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way than sending and
13588 receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}). As for radio tables, you can
13589 insert radio lists templates in HTML, La@TeX{} and Texinfo modes by calling
13590 @code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
13591
13592 Here are the differences with radio tables:
13593
13594 @itemize @minus
13595 @item
13596 Orgstruct mode must be active.
13597 @item
13598 Use the @code{ORGLST} keyword instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
13599 @item
13600 The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
13601 parameters.
13602 @item
13603 @kbd{C-c C-c} will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
13604 @end itemize
13605
13606 Here is a La@TeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
13607 La@TeX{} file:
13608
13609 @cindex #+ORGLST
13610 @example
13611 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
13612 % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
13613 \begin@{comment@}
13614 #+ORGLST: SEND to-buy org-list-to-latex
13615 - a new house
13616 - a new computer
13617 + a new keyboard
13618 + a new mouse
13619 - a new life
13620 \end@{comment@}
13621 @end example
13622
13623 Pressing `C-c C-c' on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
13624 La@TeX{} list between the two marker lines.
13625
13626 @node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
13627 @section Dynamic blocks
13628 @cindex dynamic blocks
13629
13630 Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
13631 specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
13632 A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
13633 command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
13634
13635 Dynamic block are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
13636 to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
13637 the content of the block.
13638
13639 #+BEGIN:dynamic block
13640 @example
13641 #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
13642
13643 #+END:
13644 @end example
13645
13646 Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
13647
13648 @table @kbd
13649 @kindex C-c C-x C-u
13650 @item C-c C-x C-u
13651 Update dynamic block at point.
13652 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u
13653 @item C-u C-c C-x C-u
13654 Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
13655 @end table
13656
13657 Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
13658 END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
13659 writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
13660 to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
13661 extra parameter @code{:content}.
13662
13663 For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
13664 @code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
13665 with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
13666 of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
13667 run:
13668
13669 @example
13670 #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
13671
13672 #+END:
13673 @end example
13674
13675 @noindent
13676 The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
13677
13678 @lisp
13679 (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
13680 (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
13681 (insert "Last block update at: "
13682 (format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
13683 @end lisp
13684
13685 If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
13686 you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
13687 example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
13688 written in a way such that it does nothing in buffers that are not in
13689 @code{org-mode}.
13690
13691 @node Special agenda views, Extracting agenda information, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
13692 @section Special agenda views
13693 @cindex agenda views, user-defined
13694
13695 Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the
13696 selection made by any of the agenda views. You may specify a function
13697 that is used at each match to verify if the match should indeed be part
13698 of the agenda view, and if not, how much should be skipped.
13699
13700 Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
13701 tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
13702 marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
13703 PROJECT. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
13704 PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
13705 the subtree belonging to the project line.
13706
13707 To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
13708 the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
13709 indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
13710 tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
13711 search should continue from there.
13712
13713 @lisp
13714 (defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
13715 "Skip trees that are not waiting"
13716 (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
13717 (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
13718 nil ; tag found, do not skip
13719 subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
13720 @end lisp
13721
13722 Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
13723 like this:
13724
13725 @lisp
13726 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
13727 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
13728 ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
13729 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
13730 @end lisp
13731
13732 @vindex org-agenda-overriding-header
13733 Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
13734 meaningful header in the agenda view.
13735
13736 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
13737 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
13738 A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
13739 entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
13740 your custom search function, simply do a search for
13741 @samp{LEVEL>0}@footnote{Note that, when using @code{org-odd-levels-only}, a
13742 level number corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of
13743 stars.}, and then use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries
13744 you really want to have.
13745
13746 You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
13747 particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
13748 and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
13749
13750 @table @code
13751 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
13752 Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
13753 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
13754 Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
13755 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
13756 Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
13757 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
13758 Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
13759 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))
13760 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING.
13761 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)
13762 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state.
13763 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)
13764 Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled.
13765 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'regexp "regular expression")
13766 Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
13767 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'notregexp "regular expression")
13768 Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
13769 @item '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
13770 Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
13771 @end table
13772
13773 Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
13774 like this, even without defining a special function:
13775
13776 @lisp
13777 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
13778 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
13779 ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
13780 'regexp ":waiting:"))
13781 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
13782 @end lisp
13783
13784 @node Extracting agenda information, Using the property API, Special agenda views, Hacking
13785 @section Extracting agenda information
13786 @cindex agenda, pipe
13787 @cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
13788
13789 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
13790 Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
13791 line in Emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
13792 directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
13793 processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
13794 @code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
13795 ASCII text to STDOUT. The command takes a single string as parameter.
13796 If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
13797 you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
13798 key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
13799 current TODO list, you could use
13800
13801 @example
13802 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
13803 @end example
13804
13805 If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
13806 tags/TODO match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
13807 (all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
13808 @samp{NewYork}), you could use
13809
13810 @example
13811 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
13812 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
13813 @end example
13814
13815 @noindent
13816 You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
13817
13818 @example
13819 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
13820 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
13821 org-agenda-ndays 30 \
13822 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
13823 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
13824 | lpr
13825 @end example
13826
13827 @noindent
13828 which will produce a 30-day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
13829 @file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
13830
13831 If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
13832 can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
13833 list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
13834 contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
13835 are:
13836
13837 @example
13838 category @r{The category of the item}
13839 head @r{The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY}
13840 type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
13841 todo @r{selected in TODO match}
13842 tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
13843 diary @r{imported from diary}
13844 deadline @r{a deadline}
13845 scheduled @r{scheduled}
13846 timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
13847 closed @r{entry was closed on date}
13848 upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
13849 past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
13850 block @r{entry has date block including date}
13851 todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
13852 tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
13853 date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
13854 time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
13855 extra @r{String with extra planning info}
13856 priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
13857 priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
13858 @end example
13859
13860 @noindent
13861 Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
13862 led to the selection of the item.
13863
13864 A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post-processing script.
13865 For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
13866 Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
13867
13868 @example
13869 #!/usr/bin/perl
13870
13871 # define the Emacs command to run
13872 $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
13873
13874 # run it and capture the output
13875 $agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
13876
13877 # loop over all lines
13878 foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
13879 # get the individual values
13880 ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
13881 $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
13882 # process and print
13883 print "[ ] $head\n";
13884 @}
13885 @end example
13886
13887 @node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Extracting agenda information, Hacking
13888 @section Using the property API
13889 @cindex API, for properties
13890 @cindex properties, API
13891
13892 Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
13893 properties.
13894
13895 @defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
13896 Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.@*
13897 This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
13898 scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
13899 entry. The return value is an alist, keys may occur multiple times
13900 if the property key was used several times.@*
13901 POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used.
13902 If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
13903 `special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
13904 @end defun
13905 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
13906 @defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
13907 Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM. By default,
13908 this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If INHERIT
13909 is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, then also check
13910 higher levels of the hierarchy. If INHERIT is the symbol
13911 @code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
13912 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects PROPERTY for inheritance.
13913 @end defun
13914
13915 @defun org-entry-delete pom property
13916 Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
13917 @end defun
13918
13919 @defun org-entry-put pom property value
13920 Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
13921 @end defun
13922
13923 @defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
13924 Get all property keys in the current buffer.
13925 @end defun
13926
13927 @defun org-insert-property-drawer
13928 Insert a property drawer at point.
13929 @end defun
13930
13931 @defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
13932 Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES. VALUES should be a list of
13933 strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators.
13934 @end defun
13935
13936 @defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
13937 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
13938 values and return the values as a list of strings.
13939 @end defun
13940
13941 @defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
13942 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
13943 values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
13944 @end defun
13945
13946 @defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
13947 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
13948 values and make sure that VALUE is @emph{not} in this list.
13949 @end defun
13950
13951 @defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
13952 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
13953 values and check if VALUE is in this list.
13954 @end defun
13955
13956 @defopt org-property-allowed-value-functions
13957 Hook for functions supplying allowed values for specific.
13958 The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property, and
13959 return a flat list of allowed values. If @samp{:ETC} is one of
13960 the values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values
13961 to be entered. The functions must return @code{nil} if they are not
13962 responsible for this property.
13963 @end defopt
13964
13965 @node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
13966 @section Using the mapping API
13967 @cindex API, for mapping
13968 @cindex mapping entries, API
13969
13970 Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
13971 certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
13972 views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
13973 functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
13974 is:
13975
13976 @defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
13977 Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
13978
13979 FUNC is a function or a Lisp form. The function will be called without
13980 arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline.
13981 The return values of all calls to the function will be collected and
13982 returned as a list.
13983
13984 The call to FUNC will be wrapped into a save-excursion form, so FUNC
13985 does not need to preserve point. After evaluation, the cursor will be
13986 moved to the end of the line (presumably of the headline of the
13987 processed entry) and search continues from there. Under some
13988 circumstances, this may not produce the wanted results. For example,
13989 if you have removed (e.g. archived) the current (sub)tree it could
13990 mean that the next entry will be skipped entirely. In such cases, you
13991 can specify the position from where search should continue by making
13992 FUNC set the variable `org-map-continue-from' to the desired buffer
13993 position.
13994
13995 MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match view.
13996 Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered during
13997 the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all headlines will be
13998 visited by the iteration.
13999
14000 SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
14001
14002 @example
14003 nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
14004 tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
14005 file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
14006 file-with-archives
14007 @r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
14008 agenda @r{all agenda files}
14009 agenda-with-archives
14010 @r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
14011 (file1 file2 ...)
14012 @r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
14013 @end example
14014 @noindent
14015 The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
14016 the scanner. The following items can be given here:
14017
14018 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
14019 @example
14020 archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
14021 comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
14022 function or Lisp form
14023 @r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
14024 @r{so whenever the function returns t, FUNC}
14025 @r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
14026 @r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
14027 @end example
14028 @end defun
14029
14030 The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
14031 It can use the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
14032 information about the entry, or in order to change metadata in the entry.
14033 Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
14034
14035 @defun org-todo &optional arg
14036 Change the TODO state of the entry, see the docstring of the functions for
14037 the many possible values for the argument ARG.
14038 @end defun
14039
14040 @defun org-priority &optional action
14041 Change the priority of the entry, see the docstring of this function for the
14042 possible values for ACTION.
14043 @end defun
14044
14045 @defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
14046 Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either @code{on}
14047 or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off.
14048 @end defun
14049
14050 @defun org-promote
14051 Promote the current entry.
14052 @end defun
14053
14054 @defun org-demote
14055 Demote the current entry.
14056 @end defun
14057
14058 Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
14059 a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
14060 Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
14061
14062 @lisp
14063 (org-map-entries
14064 '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
14065 "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
14066 @end lisp
14067
14068 The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
14069 @code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
14070
14071 @lisp
14072 (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
14073 @end lisp
14074
14075 @node MobileOrg, History and Acknowledgments, Hacking, Top
14076 @appendix MobileOrg
14077 @cindex iPhone
14078 @cindex MobileOrg
14079
14080 @uref{http://mobileorg.ncogni.to/, MobileOrg} is an application for the
14081 @i{iPhone/iPod Touch} series of devices, developed by Richard Moreland.
14082 @i{MobileOrg} offers offline viewing and capture support for an Org-mode
14083 system rooted on a ``real'' computer. It does also allow you to record
14084 changes to existing entries. Android users should check out
14085 @uref{http://wiki.github.com/matburt/mobileorg-android/, MobileOrg Android}
14086 by Matt Jones.
14087
14088 This appendix describes the support Org has for creating agenda views in a
14089 format that can be displayed by @i{MobileOrg}, and for integrating notes
14090 captured and changes made by @i{MobileOrg} into the main system.
14091
14092 For changing tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, you should have set up the
14093 customization variables @code{org-todo-keywords} and @code{org-tags-alist} to
14094 cover all important tags and TODO keywords, even if individual files use only
14095 part of these. MobileOrg will also offer you states and tags set up with
14096 in-buffer settings, but it will understand the logistics of TODO state
14097 @i{sets} (@pxref{Per-file keywords}) and @i{mutually exclusive} tags
14098 (@pxref{Setting tags}) only for those set in these variables.
14099
14100 @menu
14101 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
14102 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
14103 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
14104 @end menu
14105
14106 @node Setting up the staging area, Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg, MobileOrg
14107 @section Setting up the staging area
14108
14109 MobileOrg needs to interact with Emacs through directory on a
14110 server@footnote{If you are using a public server, you might prefer to encrypt
14111 the files on the server. This can be done with Org-mode 6.35 and, hopefully,
14112 with MobileOrg 1.4 (please check before trying to use this). On the Emacs
14113 side, configure the variables @code{org-mobile-use-encryption} and
14114 @code{org-mobile-encryption-password}.}. The easiest way to create that
14115 directory is to use a free @uref{http://dropbox.com,Dropbox.com}
14116 account@footnote{If you cannot use Dropbox, or if your version of MobileOrg
14117 does not support it, you can use a webdav server. For more information,
14118 check out the the documentation of MobileOrg and also this
14119 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.php#mobileorg_webdav, FAQ entry}.}.
14120 When MobileOrg first connects to your Dropbox, it will create a directory
14121 @i{MobileOrg} inside the Dropbox. After the directory has been created, tell
14122 Emacs about it:
14123
14124 @lisp
14125 (setq org-mobile-directory "~/Dropbox/MobileOrg")
14126 @end lisp
14127
14128 Org-mode has commands to put files for @i{MobileOrg} into that directory,
14129 and to read captured notes from there.
14130
14131 @node Pushing to MobileOrg, Pulling from MobileOrg, Setting up the staging area, MobileOrg
14132 @section Pushing to MobileOrg
14133
14134 This operation copies all files currently listed in @code{org-mobile-files}
14135 to the directory @code{org-mobile-directory}. By default this list contains
14136 all agenda files (as listed in @code{org-agenda-files}), but additional files
14137 can be included by customizing @code{org-mobiles-files}. File names will be
14138 staged with path relative to @code{org-directory}, so all files should be
14139 inside this directory. The push operation also creates a special Org file
14140 @file{agendas.org} with all custom agenda view defined by the
14141 user@footnote{While creating the agendas, Org-mode will force (see the
14142 variable @code{org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items}) ID properties on all
14143 referenced entries, so that these entries can be uniquely
14144 identified if @i{MobileOrg} flags them for further action.}. Finally, Org
14145 writes the file @file{index.org}, containing links to all other files.
14146 @i{MobileOrg} first reads this file from the server, and then downloads all
14147 agendas and Org files listed in it. To speed up the download, MobileOrg will
14148 only read files whose checksums@footnote{stored automatically in the file
14149 @file{checksums.dat}} have changed.
14150
14151 @node Pulling from MobileOrg, , Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg
14152 @section Pulling from MobileOrg
14153
14154 When @i{MobileOrg} synchronizes with the server, it not only pulls the Org
14155 files for viewing. It also appends captured entries and pointers to flagged
14156 and changed entries to the file @file{mobileorg.org} on the server. Org has
14157 a @emph{pull} operation that integrates this information into an inbox file
14158 and operates on the pointers to flagged entries. Here is how it works:
14159
14160 @enumerate
14161 @item
14162 Org moves all entries found in
14163 @file{mobileorg.org}@footnote{@file{mobileorg.org} will be empty after this
14164 operation.} and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable
14165 @code{org-mobile-inbox-for-pull}. Each captured entry and each editing event
14166 will be a top-level entry in the inbox file.
14167 @item
14168 After moving the entries, Org will attempt to implement the changes made in
14169 @i{MobileOrg}. Some changes are applied directly and without user
14170 interaction. Examples are all changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body
14171 text that can be cleanly applied. Entries that have been flagged for further
14172 action will receive a tag @code{:FLAGGED:}, so that they can be easily found
14173 again. When there is a problem finding an entry or applying the change, the
14174 pointer entry will remain in the inbox and will be marked with an error
14175 message. You need to later resolve these issues by hand.
14176 @item
14177 Org will then generate an agenda view with all flagged entries. The user
14178 should then go through these entries and do whatever actions are necessary.
14179 If a note has been stored while flagging an entry in @i{MobileOrg}, that note
14180 will be displayed in the echo area when the cursor is on the corresponding
14181 agenda line.
14182 @table @kbd
14183 @kindex ?
14184 @item ?
14185 Pressing @kbd{?} in that special agenda will display the full flagging note in
14186 another window and also push it onto the kill ring. So you could use @kbd{?
14187 z C-y C-c C-c} to store that flagging note as a normal note in the entry.
14188 Pressing @kbd{?} twice in succession will offer to remove the
14189 @code{:FLAGGED:} tag along with the recorded flagging note (which is stored
14190 in a property). In this way you indicate, that the intended processing for
14191 this flagged entry is finished.
14192 @end table
14193 @end enumerate
14194
14195 @kindex C-c a ?
14196 If you are not able to process all flagged entries directly, you can always
14197 return to this agenda view using @kbd{C-c a ?}. Note, however, that there is
14198 a subtle difference. The view created automatically by @kbd{M-x
14199 org-mobile-pull @key{RET}} is guaranteed to search all files that have been
14200 addressed by the last pull. This might include a file that is not currently
14201 in your list of agenda files. If you later use @kbd{C-c a ?} to regenerate
14202 the view, only the current agenda files will be searched.
14203
14204 @node History and Acknowledgments, Main Index, MobileOrg, Top
14205 @appendix History and acknowledgments
14206 @cindex acknowledgments
14207 @cindex history
14208 @cindex thanks
14209
14210 Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the Emacs
14211 Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects, and using
14212 Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to remember eleven
14213 different commands with two or three keys per command, only to hide and show
14214 parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely unacceptable to me. Also,
14215 when using outlines to take notes, I constantly wanted to restructure the
14216 tree, organizing it parallel to my thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility
14217 cycling} and @emph{structure editing} were originally implemented in the
14218 package @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
14219 @file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project planning,
14220 the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{timestamps}, and
14221 @emph{table support}. These areas highlighted the two main goals that Org
14222 still has today: to be a new, outline-based, plain text mode with innovative
14223 and intuitive editing features, and to incorporate project planning
14224 functionality directly into a notes file.
14225
14226 Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to
14227 @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
14228 reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
14229 Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
14230 trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
14231 in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
14232 complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
14233 let me know.
14234
14235 Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order:
14236
14237 @table @i
14238 @item Bastien Guerry
14239 Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of them
14240 integrated into the core by now), including the LaTeX exporter and the plain
14241 list parser. His support during the early days, when he basically acted as
14242 co-maintainer, was central to the success of this project. Bastien also
14243 invented Worg, helped establishing the Web presence of Org, and sponsors
14244 hosting costs for the orgmode.org website.
14245 @item Eric Schulte and Dan Davison
14246 Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org-babel system, which turns
14247 Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating code and doing literate
14248 programming and reproducible research.
14249 @item John Wiegley
14250 John has also contributed a number of great ideas and patches
14251 directly to Org, including the attachment system (@file{org-attach.el}),
14252 integration with Apple Mail (@file{org-mac-message.el}), hierarchical
14253 dependencies of TODO items, habit tracking (@file{org-habits.el}), and
14254 encryption (@file{org-crypt.el}). Also, the capture system is really an
14255 extended copy of his great @file{remember.el}.
14256 @item Sebastian Rose
14257 Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the pitiful work
14258 of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this part of Org onto a much
14259 higher level. He also wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
14260 webpages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with
14261 single-key navigation.
14262 @end table
14263
14264 @noindent OK, now to the full list of contributions! Again, please let me
14265 know what I am missing here!
14266
14267 @itemize @bullet
14268
14269 @item
14270 @i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
14271 @item
14272 @i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
14273 @item
14274 @i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
14275 Org-mode website.
14276 @item
14277 @i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
14278 @item
14279 @i{Jan Böcker} wrote @file{org-docview.el}.
14280 @item
14281 @i{Brad Bozarth} showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org-mode files.
14282 @item
14283 @i{Tom Breton} wrote @file{org-choose.el}.
14284 @item
14285 @i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
14286 for Remember, which are now templates for capture.
14287 @item
14288 @i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
14289 specified time.
14290 @item
14291 @i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for Lisp forms into table
14292 calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
14293 @file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
14294 @item
14295 @i{Sacha Chua} suggested copying some linking code from Planner.
14296 @item
14297 @i{Baoqiu Cui} contributed the DocBook exporter.
14298 @item
14299 @i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
14300 came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
14301 them.
14302 @item
14303 @i{Nick Dokos} tracked down several nasty bugs.
14304 @item
14305 @i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
14306 inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
14307 asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
14308 @item
14309 @i{Thomas S. Dye} contributed documentation on Worg and helped integrating
14310 the Org-Babel documentation into the manual.
14311 @item
14312 @i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format,
14313 patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and inspired the agenda.
14314 @item
14315 @i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
14316 HTML agendas.
14317 @item
14318 @i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
14319 @item
14320 @i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
14321 @item
14322 @i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
14323 around a match in a hidden outline tree.
14324 @item
14325 @i{Raimar Finken} wrote @file{org-git-line.el}.
14326 @item
14327 @i{Mikael Fornius} works as a mailing list moderator.
14328 @item
14329 @i{Austin Frank} works as a mailing list moderator.
14330 @item
14331 @i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
14332 @item
14333 @i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
14334 @item
14335 @i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
14336 task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
14337 been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system.
14338 @item
14339 @i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
14340 patches.
14341 @item
14342 @i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
14343 @item
14344 @i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
14345 folded entries, and column view for properties.
14346 @item
14347 @i{Matt Jones} wrote @i{MobileOrg Android}.
14348 @item
14349 @i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
14350 @item
14351 @i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded La@TeX{} and tested it. He also
14352 provided frequent feedback and some patches.
14353 @item
14354 @i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
14355 invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
14356 @item
14357 @i{David Maus} wrote @file{org-atom.el}, maintains the issues file for Org,
14358 and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent replies,
14359 small fixes and patches.
14360 @item
14361 @i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
14362 @item
14363 @i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling.
14364 @item
14365 @i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
14366 basis.
14367 @item
14368 @i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
14369 happy.
14370 @item
14371 @i{Richard Moreland} wrote @i{MobileOrg} for the iPhone.
14372 @item
14373 @i{Rick Moynihan} proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
14374 and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
14375 @item
14376 @i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
14377 @item
14378 @i{Greg Newman} refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
14379 @item
14380 @i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
14381 file links, and TAGS.
14382 @item
14383 @i{Osamu Okano} wrote @file{orgcard2ref.pl}, a perl program to create a text
14384 version of the reference card.
14385 @item
14386 @i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
14387 into Japanese.
14388 @item
14389 @i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
14390 @item
14391 @i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
14392 links, among other things.
14393 @item
14394 @i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
14395 provided frequent feedback.
14396 @item
14397 @i{Martin Pohlack} provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion
14398 into bundles of 20 for undo.
14399 @item
14400 @i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
14401 @item
14402 @i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
14403 control.
14404 @item
14405 @i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He
14406 also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
14407 @item
14408 @i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
14409 @item
14410 @i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
14411 conflict with @file{allout.el}.
14412 @item
14413 @i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with
14414 extensive patches.
14415 @item
14416 @i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
14417 of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
14418 @item
14419 @i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
14420 other things.
14421 @item
14422 @i{Paul Sexton} wrote @file{org-ctags.el}.
14423 @item
14424 Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
14425 @file{organizer-mode.el}.
14426 @item
14427 @i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
14428 examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
14429 @item
14430 @i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
14431 now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
14432 @item
14433 @i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
14434 subtrees.
14435 @item
14436 @i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
14437 @item
14438 @i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
14439 tweaks and features.
14440 @item
14441 @i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
14442 extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
14443 @item
14444 @i{Ulf Stegemann} created the table to translate special symbols to HTML,
14445 LaTeX, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII.
14446 @item
14447 @i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
14448 with links transformation to Org syntax.
14449 @item
14450 @i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
14451 chapter about publishing.
14452 @item
14453 @i{Stefan Vollmar} organized a video-recorded talk at the
14454 Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation of a
14455 concept index for HTML export.
14456 @item
14457 @i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
14458 in HTML output.
14459 @item
14460 @i{Samuel Wales} has provided important feedback and bug reports.
14461 @item
14462 @i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
14463 keyword.
14464 @item
14465 @i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
14466 system.
14467 @item
14468 @i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
14469 linking to Gnus.
14470 @item
14471 @i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
14472 work on a tty.
14473 @item
14474 @i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
14475 and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
14476 @end itemize
14477
14478
14479 @node Main Index, Key Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
14480 @unnumbered Concept index
14481
14482 @printindex cp
14483
14484 @node Key Index, Variable Index, Main Index, Top
14485 @unnumbered Key index
14486
14487 @printindex ky
14488
14489 @node Variable Index, , Key Index, Top
14490 @unnumbered Variable index
14491
14492 This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are
14493 mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use @kbd{M-x
14494 org-customize @key{RET}} and then click yourself through the tree.
14495
14496 @printindex vr
14497
14498 @bye
14499
14500 @ignore
14501 arch-tag: 7893d1Fe-cc57-4d13-b5e5-f494a1CBC7ac
14502 @end ignore
14503
14504 @c Local variables:
14505 @c fill-column: 77
14506 @c End:
14507
14508
14509 @c LocalWords: webdavhost pre